Contents

BMW X5 48i xDrive X5 Series 2009 Owner's Manual PDF

1 of 317
1 of 317

Summary of Content for BMW X5 48i xDrive X5 Series 2009 Owner's Manual PDF

The Ultimate Driving Machine

Owner's Manual for Vehicle

X5 xDrive30i X5 xDrive48i

X5 xDrive35d

X6 xDrive 35i X6 xDrive 50i

Owner's Manual for Vehicle Congratulations, and thank you for choosing a BMW.

Thorough familiarity with your vehicle will provide you with enhanced control and security when you drive it. We therefore have this request:

Please take the time to read this Owner's Manual and familiarize yourself with the information that we have compiled for you before starting off in your new vehicle. It contains important data and instructions intended to assist you in gaining maximum use and satisfaction from your BMW's unique range of technical fea- tures. The manual also contains information on maintenance designed to enhance operating safety and contribute to main- taining the value of your BMW throughout an extended service life.

This manual is supplemented by a Service and Warranty Informa- tion Booklet for US models or a Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models.

We wish you an enjoyable driving experience.

BMW AG

2008 Bayerische Motoren Werke Aktiengesellschaft Munich, Germany Reprinting, including excerpts, only with the written consent of BMW AG, Munich. US English IX/08, 09 08 500 Printed on environmentally friendly paper, bleached without chlorine, suitable for recycling.

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Contents

The fastest way to find specific topics is to use the index, refer to page 296.

Using this Owner's Manual 4 Notes 7 Reporting safety defects

At a glance 10 Cockpit 16 iDrive 23 Voice activation system

Controls 28 Opening and closing 48 Adjusting 61 Transporting children safely 65 Driving 78 Everything under control 91 Technology for comfort, convenience

and safety 110 Lamps 114 Climate 123 Practical interior accessories

Driving tips 138 Things to remember when driving

Navigation 148 Starting navigation system 150 Destination entry 162 Destination guidance 170 What to do if

Entertainment 174 On/Off and settings 178 Radio 184 Satellite radio 187 CD player and CD changer 193 DVD changer 200 AUX-In connection 201 USB audio interface 204 DVD system in rear

Communications 220 Telephoning 235 BMW Assist

Mobility 244 Refueling 249 Wheels and tires 258 Under the hood 263 Maintenance 265 Care 269 Replacing components 279 Giving and receiving assistance

Reference 286 Technical data 291 Short commands of voice activation

system 296 Everything from A to Z

N o

te s

4

Notes

About this Owner's Manual We have made every effort to ensure that you are able to find what you need in this Owner's Manual as quickly as possible. The fastest way to find specific topics is to refer to the detailed index at the back of the manual. If you wish to gain an initial overview of your vehicle, you will find this in the first chapter.

Should you sell your BMW some day, please remember to hand over the Owner's Manual as well; it is an important component of your vehicle.

Additional sources of information If you have additional questions, your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center is always happy to advise you.

You can find information on BMW, e.g. on tech- nology, on the Internet at www.bmwusa.com.

Symbols used Indicates precautions that must be fol- lowed precisely in order to avoid the pos-

sibility of personal injury and serious damage to the vehicle.<

Indicates information that will assist you in gaining the optimum benefit from your

vehicle and enable you to care more effectively for your vehicle.<

Refers to measures that can be taken to help protect the environment.<

< Marks the end of a specific item of informa- tion.

* Indicates special equipment, country- specific equipment and optional accessories, as well as equipment and functions not yet available at the time of printing.

"..." Identifies Control Display texts used to select individual functions.

{...} Verbal instructions to use with the voice activation system.

{{...}} Identifies the answers generated by the voice activation system.

Symbols on vehicle components Indicates that you should consult the rel- evant section of this Owner's Manual for

information on a particular part or assembly.

5

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

The individual vehicle When purchasing your BMW, you have decided in favor of a model with individualized equip- ment and features. This Owner's Manual describes the entire array of options and equip- ment available with a specific BMW model.

Please bear in mind that the manual may con- tain information on accessories and equipment that you have not specified for your own vehicle. Sections describing options and special equip- ment are marked by asterisks * to assist you in identifying possible differences between the descriptions in this manual and your own vehi- cle's equipment.

If equipment in your BMW is not described in this Owner's Manual, please refer to the accom- panying Supplementary Owner's Manuals.

Editorial notice BMW pursues a policy of continuous, ongoing development that is conceived to ensure that our vehicles continue to embody the highest quality and safety standards combined with advanced, state-of-the-art technology. For this reason, it is possible that the features described in this Owner's Manual could differ from those on your vehicle.

For your own safety

Maintenance and repairs Advanced technology, e.g. the use of modern materials and high-performance

electronics, requires specially adapted mainte- nance and repair methods. Therefore, have cor- responding work on your BMW performed only by your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained personnel. If this work is not carried out prop- erly, there is a danger of subsequent damage and related safety hazards.<

N o

te s

6

Parts and accessories For your own safety, use genuine parts and accessories approved by BMW.

When you purchase accessories tested and approved by BMW and Genuine BMW Parts, you simultaneously acquire the assurance that they have been thoroughly tested by BMW to ensure optimum performance when installed on your vehicle. BMW warrants these parts to be free from defects in material and workmanship. BMW will not accept any liability for damage resulting from installation of parts and accesso- ries not approved by BMW. BMW cannot test every product made by other manufacturers to verify if it can be used on a BMW safely and without risk to either the vehi- cle, its operation or its occupants. Genuine BMW Parts, BMW Accessories and other products approved by BMW, together with professional advice on using these items, are available from all BMW Sports Activity Vehi- cle Centers. Installation and operation of non-BMW approved accessories such as alarms, radios, amplifiers, radar detectors, wheels, suspension components, brake dust shields, telephones, including operation of any mobile phone from within the vehicle without using an externally mounted antenna, or transceiver equipment, for instance, CBs, walkie-talkies, ham radios or similar accessories, may cause extensive dam- age to the vehicle, compromise its safety, inter- fere with the vehicle's electrical system, or affect the validity of the BMW Limited Warranty. Refer to your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Cen- ter for additional information.<

Maintenance, replacement, or repair of the emission control devices and sys-

tems may be performed by any automotive repair establishment or individual using any cer- tified automotive part.<

California Proposition 65 Warning California laws require us to issue the following warning:

Engine exhaust and a wide variety of automobile components and parts,

including components found in the interior fur- nishings in a vehicle, contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects and reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids contained in vehicles and certain products of component wear contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. Battery posts, terminals and related accesso- ries contain lead and lead compounds. Wash your hands after handling. Used engine oil contains chemicals that have caused cancer in laboratory animals. Always protect your skin by washing thoroughly with soap and water.<

7

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Service and warranty We recommend that you read this publication thoroughly.

Your BMW is covered by the following warran- ties:

> New Vehicle Limited Warranty

> Rust Perforation Limited Warranty

> Federal Emissions System Defect Warranty

> Federal Emissions Performance Warranty

> California Emission Control System Limited Warranty

Detailed information about these warranties is listed in the Service and Warranty Information Booklet for US models or in the Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models.

Reporting safety defects

For US customers The following applies only to vehicles owned and operated in the US.

If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration, NHTSA, in addition to notifying BMW of North America, LLC, P.O. Box 1227, Westwood, New Jersey 07675-1227, Telephone 1-800-831- 1117.

If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or BMW of North America, LLC.

To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Adminis- trator, NHTSA, 400 Seventh Street, SW., Washington, DC 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov

For Canadian customers Canadian customers who wish to report a safety-related defect to Transport Canada, Defect Investigations and Recalls, may call 1-800-333-0510 toll-free from anywhere in Canada or 1-613-993-9851 from the Ottawa region and from other countries, or contact Transport Canada by mail at: Transport Canada, ASFAD, Place de Ville, Tower C, 330 Sparks Street, Ottawa, ON, K1A 0N5. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.tc.gc.ca

At a glance This overview of buttons, switches and displays is intended to familiarize you with your vehicle's

operating environment. The section will also assist you in becoming acquainted with the

control concepts and options available for operating the various systems.

C o

ck p

it

10

Cockpit

Around the steering wheel: controls and displays

1 Rear window safety switch 42

2 Opening and closing windows 41

3 Folding exterior mirrors in and out* 57

4 Adjusting exterior mirrors 57 Automatic curb monitor* 58

5 Instrument lighting 113

Fog lamps 112

6 Parking lamps 110

Low beams 110

Automatic headlamp control* 110 Adaptive Head Light* 112

7 Head-Up Display* 107

A t

a g

la n

ce

11

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

9 BMW X6: upshifting or downshifting with automatic transmission 71

10 Instrument panel 12

13 Ignition lock 65

14 Buttons on steering wheel

15 Horn, entire surface

18 Releasing hood 258

8 Turn signals 73

High beams, headlamp flasher 73

Roadside parking lamps* 112

Time, date, outside temperature, Check Control 78, 86

Computer 80

11 Windshield wipers 74

Rain sensor 74

BMW X5: rear window wiper 75

12 Starting/stopping engine and switching ignition on/off 65

Telephone*:

> Press: accepting and ending call, starting dialing* for selected phone number and redialing if no phone number is selected

> Press longer: redialing

Volume

Activating/deactivating voice activation system* 23

Changing radio station Selecting music track Scrolling in phone book and in lists with stored phone numbers

Individually programmable 59

Individually programmable 59

Steering wheel heating* 59

16 Steering wheel adjustment 58

17 Cruise control* 75

C o

ck p

it

12

Instrument panel

1 Indicator lamps for turn signals

2 Speedometer

3 Indicator and warning lamps 13

4 Tachometer 79

5 BMW X5: energy control 79 BMW X6: engine oil temperature 79 or energy control 79

6 Display for

> Clock/date 78

> Outside temperature 78

> Indicator and warning lamps 85

> Speed of cruise control* 76

> BMW X5: reserve display for diesel exhaust fluid 246

7 Display for

> Odometer and trip odometer 78

> Computer 80

> Date and remaining travel distance for service requirements 82

> Automatic transmission positions 70

> HDC Hill Descent Control 98

> Check Control message present 85

> Adaptive Drive* 99

> BMW X6: Dynamic Performance Control 97

8 Fuel gauge 80

9 Resetting trip odometer 78 Displaying service requirement 78

A t

a g

la n

ce

13

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

Indicator and warning lamps

The concept

The indicator and warning lamps can light up in different combinations and colors.

Some lamps are tested for proper function by briefly lighting up during starting of the engine or when the ignition is switched on.

Explanatory text messages

Text messages at the bottom edge of the Con- trol Display explain the meaning of the dis- played indicator and warning lamps.

Additional information, e.g. on the cause of a malfunction and on the corresponding need to take action can be displayed via the Check Con- trol, refer to page 85.

In the case of corresponding urgency, this infor- mation is displayed immediately when the related lamp lights up.

Indicator lamps without text messages The following indicator lamps indicate that cer- tain functions are activated:

With parking brake set 67

With parking brake set for Canadian models

Fog lamps 112

High beams/headlamp flasher 112

Lamp flashes: DSC or DTC controls the drive and braking forces for maintaining vehicle stability 97

Exhaust-gas values 264

Exhaust values for Canadian models

C o

ck p

it

14

Around the center console: controls and displays

A t

a g

la n

ce

15

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

1 Microphone for hands-free mode for telephone* and for voice activation system* 23

2 Initiatingan emergency request 279

3 Reading lamps 113

4 Glass sunroof 42, 45

5 Interior lamps 113

6 Passenger airbag status lamp 105

7 Control Display 16 Displays for menu navigation

8 Hazard warning flashers

9 Central locking system 29

10 Opening glove compartment 126

11 Automatic climate control with 2-zone control 115 Automatic climate control with 4-zone control* 119

12 Ejecting audio CD

13 Changing

> radio station 174

> track 174

14 Selecting radio, CD and CD changer

15 Selecting AM or FM waveband

16 Ejecting navigation DVD with navigation system* 148

18 Controller 16 Turn, press or move horizontally in four directions

19 Opening start menu on Control Display 17

20 Automatic Hold 67

21 Parking brake 67

22 Adaptive Drive* 99

23 Programmable memory buttons 21

24 Switching Entertainment sound output on/off and adjusting volume 174

Manual air distribution 116

Automatic air distribution and volume 115

Cooling function 117

AUC Automatic recirculated-air control 117

Maximum cooling 117

Air volume 116 Residual heat utilization 118

Defrosting windows and removing condensation 116

Rear window defroster 116

Seat heating* 55, 56

Active seat ventilation* 56

17 Opening liftgate 33, 35

Active seat* 57

PDC Park Distance Control* 91 Rear view camera* 93

DTC Dynamic Traction Control 97

HDC Hill Descent Control 98

iD ri

ve

16

iDrive

iDrive combines the functions of a large number of switches. This allows these functions to be operated from a central position. The following section provides an introduction to basic menu

navigation. The control of the individual func- tions is described in connection with the rele- vant equipment.

Controls

1 Control Display

2 button Opening start menu

3 Controller With the controller you can select menu items and make settings:

> move in four directions, arrows 4

> turn, arrow 5

> press, arrow 6

To avoid posing an unnecessary hazard due to inattention, both to your own vehi-

cle's occupants and to other road users: never attempt to use the controls or make entries unless traffic and road conditions allow.<

A t

a g

la n

ce

17

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

Menu overview

Communication > Telephone* > BMW Assist* or BMW TeleServices*

Navigation or onboard information > Navigation system* > Onboard information, e.g. for displaying

the average fuel consumption

Entertainment > Radio

> CD player and CD changer* > External audio device

Climate > Vent settings

> Seat heater distribution* > Automatic programs

> Parked-car ventilation*

menu > Switching off Control Display

> Tone and display settings

> Settings for traffic information* > Settings for your vehicle, e.g. for the central

locking system

> Display of maintenance intervals and dead- lines for legally mandated inspections

> Settings for telephone*

Operating principle From radio readiness, refer to page 65, the fol- lowing message is shown on the Control Dis- play:

To hide the message: Press the controller. This displays the start menu.

The message is automatically hidden after approx. 10 seconds.

Start menu

You can call up all the functions of iDrive using five menu items.

Opening start menu Press the button.

To open the start menu from the menu:

Press the button twice.

iD ri

ve

18

Opening menu items of start menu

With the start menu you can open the menu items Communication, Navigation, Entertain- ment and Climate by moving the controller to the left, right, front or rear.

You can open the menu by pressing the con- troller.

Comfort opening of menu items Comfort opening offers you:

> Opening of a menu item of the start menu in the last display shown

> Direct changing between Communication, Navigation, Entertainment and Climate without pressing the button

For this purpose, move the controller in the cor- responding direction and hold it for longer than approx. 2 seconds.

Displays in menu

1 Each menu is divided into fields. The respective active field is highlighted.

2 A symbol indicates the last selected menu item of the start menu:

1 Menu items are usually grouped in horizon- tal or vertical lists.

2 In these lists, arrows indicate the possibility of accessing other menu items that are not currently visible.

3 Settings are displayed graphically or numerically.

Communication

Navigation or onboard information

Entertainment

Climate

menu

A t

a g

la n

ce

19

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

Operating principle at a glance Basic operation via iDrive is described in this view.

You can view the individual steps under Set- tings on Control Display, Brightness of Control Display, refer to page 89.

1 Selecting menu item:

> Turn the controller; the highlight moves

> Menu items shown in white can be selected by highlighting

2 Activating menu item:

> Press the controller

> New menu items are displayed or the function is carried out

3 Selecting menu item: refer to 1

4 Changing between fields:

> Briefly move the controller left, right, for- ward or back

> Release controller

> Active field appears lighter

5 Adjusting settings:

> Turn controller

> Graphic display, numerical value or text displays can be changed

> Confirmation by changing field

iD ri

ve

20

Status information

1 Display for:

> Entertainment: Radio, CD

> Telephone* in "Communication": Name of linked mobile phone, network search or no network

> "BMW Assist"*: Existing voice connection with a service from BMW Assist

2 Entertainment sound output off

3 Display for traffic information*, TI: Traffic information for the navigation sys- tem can be received and transmission is switched on

4 Display for:

> New entries present in "Missed calls"* > Roaming active

5 Telephoning* possible if the mobile phone is paired in the vehicle

Mobile phone network reception strength, display dependent on mobile phone

6 Time

Other displays: The status information is temporarily hidden when there are Check Control instructions or inputs via the voice activation system*.

Assistance window*

Additional information can be displayed in the assistance window:

> The computer or the trip computer

> The arrow or map view with a navigation system*

> The current position

Selecting display 1. Move the controller to the right to change to

the assistance window and press the con- troller.

2. Select a menu item.

3. Press the controller.

A t

a g

la n

ce

21

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

Switching assistance window off/on 1. Move the controller to the right to change to

the assistance window and press the con- troller.

2. Select "Assist. window off" and press the controller.

To switch on, change to the assistance window and press the controller.

Switching Control Display off/on 1. Press the button.

This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Display off" and press the control- ler.

To switch on, press the controller.

Programmable memory buttons You can save and run certain functions of iDrive on the programmable memory buttons:

> Destinations of navigation

> Telephone, phone numbers* > Entertainment:

> Radio station

> CD

> CD compartment of CD changer* > AUX

The assignment of the programmable buttons is stored for the remote control currently in use.

Saving function

Destinations of navigation 1. Select destination, e.g. in the destination

list or the address book.

2. Press the ... button longer than 2 seconds.

Special features:

> With the destination guidance system and the map view started, the current destina- tion is stored.

> During destination entry via a map, the coordinates at the cursor are stored, not the current destination.

Telephone, phone numbers 1. Enter the phone number or select it in a

list of the stored phone numbers, e.g. of the "A - Z" list.

2. Press the ... button longer than 2 seconds.

If a name is assigned to the phone number, the name will also be stored.

Entertainment In the Entertainment menu, the sound source currently heard, e.g. a radio station, is stored, regardless of the selection on the Control Dis- play.

iD ri

ve

22

1. Select the desired function, e.g. radio sta- tion or CD.

2. Press the ... button longer than 2 seconds.

If the vehicle is equipped with two drives, the current track is stored for CDs with

compressed audio files.<

Running function Press the ... button.

The function is run immediately. This means, for example, that when a phone number is selected, the connection is also established, or when a navigation destination is called up, des- tination guidance is started.

Displaying button assignment You can display the assignment of the buttons by touching them with your finger. Please do not wear gloves when doing so. Touching with an object, e.g. a pen, does not function.

Displaying short info Touch the ... button.

The assignment of the buttons is displayed.

Destination of navigation system

Entertainment source

Telephone, phone number

Not assigned

Displaying detailed information Touch and hold the ... button.

Deleting button assignments 1. Press the button.

This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Select "Programmable Memory Keys" and press the controller.

6. Select "Delete assignment of all memory keys" and press the controller.

7. Select "Yes" and press the controller.

A t

a g

la n

ce

23

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

Voice activation system

The concept The voice activation system allows you to con- trol operation of various vehicle systems with- out ever removing your hands from the steering wheel.

Individual menu items on the Control Display can be spoken as commands. This frees you of having to use the controller.

The voice activation system transforms your oral commands into control signals for the selected systems and provides support in the form of instructions or questions.

The voice activation system uses a special microphone located in the area of the interior rearview mirror, refer to page 14.

Precondition Via iDrive, set the language that applies for the voice activation system in order to enable iden- tification of the spoken commands. To set the language of iDrive, refer to page 90.

Symbols in Owner's Manual

Voice commands

Activating voice command system 1. Press the button on the steering wheel.

This symbol on the Control Display and an acoustic signal tell you that the voice activation system can respond to com- mands.

2. Say the command. The command is displayed on the Control Display.

This symbol is shown on the Control Display when you can say additional commands. If no other commands are possible, then oper- ate the equipment via iDrive.

Terminating or canceling voice command system Press the button on the steering wheel or

*

{...} Say the specified commands word for word. {{...}} Indicates responses of the voice acti- vation system.

{Cancel}

V o

ic e

ac ti

va ti

o n

s ys

te m

24

Commands

Having possible commands read aloud You can have the system read aloud the possi- ble commands related to the selected menu item on the Control Display. To have the system list the possible com- mands:

For example, if you have selected "CD", the system will read aloud the possible commands for operating the CD player and the CD changer*.

Opening help

Using alternative commands There are often a number of commands to run a function, e.g.:

Running functions directly with short commands With short commands you can carry out certain functions directly, regardless of which menu item is selected, refer to page 291.

Opening start menu

Example: selecting a track 1. Switch on Entertainment sound output if

necessary.

2. Press the button on the steering wheel.

5. Press the button on the steering wheel.

{Options}

{Help}

{Radio on} or {Turn radio on}

{Main menu}

3. {Entertainment} The system says: {{Entertainment}}

4. {CD} The system says: {{CD drive switched on}}

6. Select a track, e.g.: {Track 1} The system says: {{Track 1}}

A t

a g

la n

ce

25

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

Notes The mobile phone can also be operated with voice commands, refer to

page 231.<

For voice commands, bear the following in mind:

> Say the commands and numbers smoothly and at normal volume, avoiding excessive emphases and pauses. This also applies to spelling when entering the destination.

> Always issue commands in the language of the voice activation system.

> When selecting a radio station, use the common pronunciation of the station name.

> For entries in the voice-activated phone book, only use names in the language of the voice activation system and no abbrevia- tions.

> Keep doors, windows, and glass sunroof*/ panorama glass sunroof* closed in order to avoid unpleasant outside noise.

> Avoid making other noise in the vehicle while speaking.

Controls This chapter is intended to provide you with

information for complete control of your vehicle. Its extensive array of features and accessories,

both for driving and for your own safety, comfort and convenience, are described here.

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

28

Opening and closing

Keys/remote control

Each remote control contains a battery which is automatically charged in the ignition lock while driving. Drive a longer distance with each remote control at least twice a year to keep the battery charged. For comfort access*, the remote control contains a replaceable battery, refer to page 41.

Depending on which remote control is detected by the vehicle during unlocking, different set- tings are called up and carried out in the vehicle, refer to Personal Profile, page 28.

Information on the required maintenance is also stored in the remote control, refer to Service data in remote control, page 263.

Integrated key

Press button 1 to unlock the key.

The integrated key fits the following locks:

> Driver's door, refer to page 32

> Floor panel flap in cargo bay, refer to page 132

New remote controls To obtain additional or replace lost keys, new remote controls with an integrated key are available at your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center.

Personal Profile

The concept You can set a number of functions of your BMW individually according to your preferences. Per- sonal Profile ensures that most of these set- tings are stored for the remote control currently in use without you having to do anything. When the vehicle is unlocked, the corresponding remote control is detected and the settings stored for it are called up and carried out.

This means that you will always find your BMW set to your own personal settings even if another person with his/her own remote control and settings has used the vehicle since the last time you drove it. The individual settings are stored for a maximum of four remote controls, for two with comfort access*.

Personal Profile settings Details on the settings are provided on the specified pages.

> Behavior of the central locking system when unlocking vehicle, refer to page 30

> Automatic locking of the vehicle, refer to page 32

> Programming buttonson steering wheel, refer to page 59

> Displays on Control Display:

> Brightness of the Control Display, refer to page 89

> Measuring units for consumption, route/ distances, temperature, and pressure, refer to page 89

C o

n tr

o ls

29

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

> Language on Control Display, refer to page 90

> 12h/24h clock format, refer to page 89

> Date format, refer to page 89

> Lighting settings:

> Triple turn signal activation, refer to page 73

> Welcome lamps, refer to page 110

> Pathway lighting, refer to page 111

> Daytime driving lamps*, refer to page 111

> PDC Park Distance Control*: optical warn- ing, refer to page 92

> Rear view camera*:

> Selecting functions, refer to page 93

> Type of display, refer to page 95

> Head-Up Display*: selection, brightness and position of display, refer to page 107

> Automatic climate control: AUTO program and intensity, cooling function, and auto- matic recirculated air control/recirculated air mode, temperature, air distribution, tem- perature in the upper body region, refer to text starting on page 115

> Programmable memory buttons: selecting stored functions, refer to page 21

> Positions of driver's seat, outside mirrors, and steering wheel*, refer to page 50

> Adaptive Drive*: selected chassis and sus- pension tuning, refer to page 99

> Audio sources: volume and tone settings, refer to page 175

> Radio:

> Display of stored stations, refer to page 178

> Switching RDS Radio Data System on/ off*, refer to page 181

> Phone: volume setting, refer to pages 226, 232

Central locking system

The concept The central locking system functions when the driver's door is closed.

The system simultaneously engages and releases the locks on the following:

> Doors

> Liftgate

> Fuel filler door

Operating from outside > via the remote control

> via the door lock

> with comfort access* via the door handles

The interior lamps and the courtesy lamps* are also switched on and off with the remote con- trol. The alarm systemis armed/disarmed at the same time. You can find more detailed information on the alarm systemon page 38.

Operating from inside Via the button for central locking, refer to page 32. The fuel filler door is not locked.

In an accident of sufficient severity, the central locking system automatically unlocks the vehi- cle. In addition, the hazard warning flashers and interior lamps come on.

Opening and closing: Using remote control

Persons or animals left unattended in a parked vehicle can lock the doors from

the inside. Always take along the remote control when leaving the vehicle so that the vehicle can then be opened from the outside.<

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

30

Unlocking Press the button. This unlocks the vehicle.

Setting unlocking behavior You can set whether the first press of the button unlocks only the driver's door or the entire vehi- cle.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Door locks" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Central locking" and press the con- troller.

7. Select "Unlock button" and press the con- troller.

8. Select a menu item:

> "All doors" Press the button once to unlock the entire vehicle.

> "Driver's door only" Press the button once to unlock only the driver's door and the fuel filler door. Press the button twice to unlock the entire vehicle.

9. Press the controller.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Comfort opening Press and hold the button. The windows and the glass sunroof*/panorama glass sunroof* are opened.

Locking Press the button.

Do not lock the vehicle from the outside if persons are inside because unlocking

from the inside is not possible without special knowledge.<

Switching on interior lamps With vehicle locked: Press the button. You can also use this function to locate your vehicle in parking garages etc.

Panic mode* You can also trigger the alarm system in case of danger:

Press the button for at least 3 seconds.

Switch off alarm: press any button.

Unlocking liftgate Press the button for approx. 1 second.

The liftgate will open slightly, regardless of whether it was previously locked or unlocked.

C o

n tr

o ls

31

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

During opening, the liftgate pivots back and up. Ensure that adequate clearance is

available before opening. To prevent accidentally locking yourself out, never lay the remote control in the cargo bay. A previously locked liftgate is also locked again after closing.<

If pointed or sharp-edged objects could strike the rear window while driving, be

sure to provide protection around all edges. Failure to do so could result in damage to the heating conductors of the rear window.<

Setting confirmation signals You can activate or deactivate the confirmation signals.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Door locks" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Confirmation" and press the con- troller.

7. Select the desired signal.

8. Press the controller. The signal is activated.

Malfunctions The remote control may malfunction due to local radio waves. Should the remote control fail to operate due to interference of this kind, unlock and lock the vehicle via the door lock using a key.

If it is no longer possible to lock the vehicle using the remote control, then the battery is discharged. Use this remote control during an extended drive; this will recharge the battery, refer to page 28.

For US owners only The transmitter and receiver units comply with part 15 of the FCC/Federal Communication Commission regulations. Operation is gov- erned by the following:

FCC ID: LX8766S LX8766E LX8CAS LX8CAS2

Compliance statement: This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:

> This device must not cause harmful inter- ference, and

> this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.

Any unauthorized modifications or changes to these devices could void the

user's authority to operate this equipment.<

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

32

Opening and closing: Using door lock

Do not lock the vehicle from the outside if persons are inside because unlocking

from the inside is not possible without special knowledge.<

When unlocking 1. Turning the key once unlocks the driver's

door and the fuel filler door.

2. Turning the key a second time unlocks the remaining doors and the liftgate.

Convenience operation You can use the door lock to operate the win- dows and the glass sunroof*/panorama glass sunroof*.

Turn and hold the key in the positions for unlocking or locking.

Watch during the closing process to be sure that no one is injured. Rotating the

key back into the initial position stops the movement.<

Manual operation In the event of an electrical malfunction, you can turn a key all the way to the right or left in the door lock to lock or unlock the driver's door.

Opening and closing: From inside

This button serves to unlock or lock doors and the liftgate, with the front doors closed. It does not activate the anti-theft system. The fuel filler door remains unlocked.

You can also set the situations in which the vehicle is locked.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Door locks" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Central locking" and press the con- troller.

7. Select a menu item:

> "Relock door if not opened" The central locking system automati- cally locks the vehicle after a short time when no door has been opened.

C o

n tr

o ls

33

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

> "Lock after driving" The central locking system automati- cally locks the vehicle as soon as you start to drive.

8. Press the controller. The setting is selected.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Unlocking and opening > Either unlock the doors together with the

button for the central locking system and then pull the door handle above the armrest or

> pull on the door handle of each door twice: the first time unlocks the door, the second time opens it.

Locking > Use the central locking button to lock all of

the doors simultaneously, or

> press down the lock button of a door. To prevent you from being locked out, the open driver's door cannot be locked using the lock button.

Persons or animals left unattended in a parked vehicle can lock the doors from

the inside. Always take along the remote control when leaving the vehicle so that the vehicle can then be opened from the outside.<

Doors

Automatic soft closing* To close the doors, merely push them gently. The closing process will then be carried out automatically.

Make sure that the closing path of the doors is clear; otherwise injuries may

result.<

BMW X5: liftgate During opening, the liftgate pivots back and up. Ensure that adequate clearance is

available before opening.<

Opening from inside

Press the button: the liftgate opens somewhat unless it has been locked.

Opening from outside

Press the button on the liftgate or the button on the remote control for approx. 1 second: The liftgate opens somewhat. It can be swung upward.

Opening manually In case of an electrical malfunction:

1. From the cargo bay, press out the handle in the liftgate, refer to arrow, with a screw- driver and pull. The liftgate is unlocked.

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

34

2. Open the liftgate and press in the handle.

The liftgate is locked again as soon as it is closed.

Closing Make sure that the closing path of the lift- gate is clear, otherwise injuries may

result.<

The handle recesses on the interior trim of the liftgate make it easier to pull down.

If pointed or sharp-edged objects could strike the rear window while driving, be

sure to provide protection around all edges. Failure to do so could result in damage to the heating conductors of the rear window.<

Automatic liftgate operation*

Adjusting opening height You can adjust how far the liftgate is to open.

When adjusting the opening height, make sure that at least approx. 4 in/10 cm of

clearance is available above the liftgate. Other- wise, the ceiling height could be insufficient for the opened liftgate if, for example, the loading state changes.<

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Door locks" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Tailgate" and press the controller.

7. Turn the controller. The adjustment is applied; the field can be changed.

Opening liftgate The liftgate opens automatically when you:

> Press the button on the outside of the lift- gate when the vehicle is unlocked.

C o

n tr

o ls

35

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

> Press the button in the center console.

> Press the button on the remote control for approx. 1 second.

To stop the opening process:

> Press the button on the outside of the lift- gate.

> Press and hold the button on the remote control.

> Press the button on the inside of the lift- gate.

> Press the button on the center console again.

The opening process is interrupted if you set the vehicle in motion.<

Closing liftgate Make sure that the closing path of the lift- gate is clear, otherwise injuries may

result.<

Function requirement: The tailgate is closed.

The liftgate closes automatically when you press the button on the inside of the liftgate.

To stop the closing process:

> Press the button on the inside of the lift- gate.

> Press the button on the outside of the lift- gate.

Closing is not canceled when you put the vehicle into motion.<

Manually opening or closing In case of an electrical defect of the automatic liftgate operation function:

1. Manually release the liftgate, refer to page 33.

2. Open or close the liftgate slowly and with- out making sudden movements.

BMW X5: tailgate

Opening

Pull the lever and swing the tailgate downward.

The open tailgate can support loads of up to 550 lbs./250 kg.<

Closing Fold the tailgate up and press closed.

BMW X6: liftgate During opening, the liftgate pivots back and up. Ensure that adequate clearance is

available before opening.<

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

36

Opening from inside

Press the button: the liftgate opens somewhat unless it has been locked.

Opening from outside

Press the button on the liftgate or the button on the remote control for approx. 1 second: The liftgate opens somewhat. It can be swung upward.

Opening height* You can open the liftgate to two heights. Unlock the liftgate and swing it upward.

Completely opening liftgate If the liftgate is in the lower position, pull it down approx. 12 in/30 cm and then release it.

Do not push the liftgate up from the lower position; otherwise, it can spring back and

cause personal injury.<

Adjusting opening height You can set the liftgate to open immediately into the upper position or to initially only open to the lower position.

1. To open the liftgate completely, see above.

2. For the lower position, position 1: Turn sleeves of both liftgate supports in the direction of the arrow until the line markings align in position 1.

For the upper position, position 2: Turn sleeves of both liftgate supports in the direction of the arrow until the line markings align in position 2.

With automatic liftgate operation* you can set the opening height using iDrive,

refer to page 37.<

Opening manually In case of an electrical malfunction:

1. From inside the cargo bay, use a screw- driver to push out cover 1 on the liftgate.

2. Push catch 2 in the direction of the arrow.

C o

n tr

o ls

37

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

3. Open the liftgate and press the cover back into place.

The liftgate is locked again as soon as it is closed.

Closing Make sure that the closing path of the lift- gate is clear, otherwise injuries may

result.<

The handle recesses on the interior trim of the liftgate make it easier to pull down.

If pointed or sharp-edged objects could strike the rear window while driving, be

sure to provide protection around all edges. Failure to do so could result in damage to the heating conductors of the rear window.<

Automatic liftgate operation*

Adjusting opening height You can adjust how far the liftgate is to open.

When adjusting the opening height, make sure that at least approx. 4 in/10 cm of

clearance is available above the liftgate. Other- wise, the ceiling height could be insufficient for the opened liftgate if, for example, the loading state changes.<

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Door locks" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Tailgate" and press the controller.

7. Turn the controller. The adjustment is applied; the field can be changed.

Opening liftgate The liftgate opens automatically when you:

> Press the button on the outside of the lift- gate when the vehicle is unlocked.

> Press the button in the center console.

> Press the button on the remote control for approx. 1 second.

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

38

To stop the opening process:

> Press the button on the outside of the lift- gate.

> Press and hold the button on the remote control.

> Press the button on the inside of the lift- gate.

> Press the button on the center console again.

The opening process is interrupted if you set the vehicle in motion.<

Closing liftgate Make sure that the closing path of the lift- gate is clear, otherwise injuries may

result.<

The liftgate closes automatically when you press the button on the inside of the liftgate.

To stop the closing process:

> Press the button on the inside of the lift- gate.

> Press the button on the outside of the lift- gate.

Closing is not canceled when you put the vehicle into motion.<

The liftgate also closes automatically without pressing the button if it is loaded

with an additional weight of approx. 11 lbs./5 kg, e.g. snow or ice.<

Manually opening or closing In case of an electrical defect of the automatic liftgate operation function:

1. Manually release the liftgate, refer to page 36.

2. Open or close the liftgate slowly and with- out making sudden movements.

Alarm system

The concept The vehicle alarm system responds:

> When a door, the hood, or the liftgate is opened

> To movements in the vehicle: interior motion sensor, refer to page 39

> To changes in the vehicle's tilt if someone attempts to steal the wheels or tow the vehicle

> To interruptions in battery voltage

Unauthorized operations are briefly signaled by the alarm system:

> with an acoustic alarm

> by switching onthe hazard warning flashers

> by flashing the high beams

Arming and disarming alarm system When you lock or unlock the vehicle, either with the remote control or at the door lock, the alarm system is armed or disarmed at the same time.

With the system armed, the liftgate can also be opened using the button of the remote con- trol, refer to page 30. When the liftgate is closed, it is once again locked and monitored.

Switching off alarm > Unlock the vehicle using the remote control,

refer to page 30.

> Insert the remote control all the way into the ignition lock.

C o

n tr

o ls

39

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Indicator lamp displays

> The indicator lamp under the interior rear- view mirror flashes continuously: the sys- tem is armed.

> The indicator lamp flashes after locking: The doors, hood, or liftgate are not properly closed. Even if you do not close the alerted area, the system begins to monitor the remaining areas, and the indicator lamp flashes continuously after approx. 10 sec- onds. However, the interior motion sensor is not activated.

> The indicator lamp goes out after unlocking: your vehicle has not been disturbed while you were away.

> The indicator lamp flashes after unlocking until the remote control is inserted into the ignition lock, however for a maximum of approx. 5 minutes: your vehicle has been disturbed while you were away.

Tilt alarm sensor The tilt of the vehicle is monitored. The alarm system reacts, e.g. in case of an attempted wheel theft or towing.

Interior motion sensor In order for the interior motion sensor to func- tion properly, the windows and glass sunroof*/ panorama glass sunroof* must be completely closed.

Avoiding unintentional alarms The tilt alarm sensor and interior motion sensor may be switched off at the same time. This pre- vents unintentional alarms, e.g. in the following situations:

> In stacking garages

> When transporting on car-carrying trains, by sea or on a trailer

> When animals are to remain in the vehicle

Switching off tilt alarm sensor and interior motion sensor Press the button on the remote control again as soon as the vehicle is locked.

The indicator lamp lights up briefly and then flashes continuously. The tilt alarm sensor and the interior motion sensor are switched off until the next time the vehicle is unlocked and subse- quently locked again.

Comfort access* Comfort access enables you to access your vehicle without having to hold the remote con- trol in your hand. It is sufficient to carry the remote control with you, e.g. in your jacket pocket. The vehicle automatically detects the related remote control in the immediate vicinity or in the interior.

Comfort access supports the following func- tions:

> Unlocking/locking vehicle

> Comfort closing

> Opening liftgate

> Starting engine

Functional requirements > The vehicle can only be unlocked if the

vehicle detects that the remote control car- ried is not located in the vehicle interior.

> The next unlocking and locking cycle is not possible until after approx. 2 seconds.

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

40

> The engine can only be started if the vehicle detects that the remote control is located in the vehicle.

Comparison with ordinary remote control You can control the functions mentioned previ- ously with the comfort access or by pressing the buttons on the remote control. Therefore, please familiarize yourself with the information on opening and closing beginning on page 28 beforehand.

The special features when using comfort access are described in the following.

Should a short delay occur when opening or closing the windows or the glass sun-

roof*/panorama glass sunroof*, the system checks whether a remote control is located in the vehicle. Please repeat opening or closing if necessary.<

Releasing

Completely grasp a door handle, arrow 1. This corresponds to pressing the button.

Locking Touch the area highlighted in the picture, arrow 2, with your finger for approx. 1 second.

This corresponds to pressing the but- ton.

Please make sure that all electronic sys- tems/consumers are switched off before

locking to save the battery.<

Comfort closing Hold a finger or the back of a hand on the sur- face, arrow 2.

The windows and the glass sunroof*/panorama glass sunroof* are closed.

Watch during the closing process to be sure that no one is injured. Removing the

hand from the door handle immediately stops the closing process.<

Opening liftgate Press the button on the liftgate. This corresponds to pressing the button.

If a remote control accidentally left in the cargo bay is detected in the locked vehi-

cle after the liftgate is closed, then the liftgate opens again. The hazard warning flashers flash and a signal* sounds.<

Switching on radio readiness By briefly pressing the Start/Stop button, you switch on the radio readiness, refer to page 65.

When doing so, do not depress the brake pedal, otherwise the engine will start.<

Starting engine You can start the engine or switch on the igni- tion if a remote control is located in the interior of the vehicle. It need not be inserted in the igni- tion lock, refer to page 65.

As long as no remote control is detected in the vehicle, it is only possible to restart the engine within approx. 10 seconds after it is switched off if no door has been opened.

Switching off engine > Remote control not in ignition lock:

After switching off the engine, the transmis- sion is automatically switched into trans- mission position P.

> Remote control in ignition lock: If transmission position N is engaged, the transmission remains in this position after the engine is switched off.

C o

n tr

o ls

41

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Before driving into a car wash The vehicle can roll if you proceed according to the following steps:

1. Insert remote control into ignition lock.

2. Depress brake pedal.

3. Engage transmission position N.

4. Release the parking brake.

5. Switch off the engine.

6. Leave the remote control in the ignition lock.

Malfunction The comfort access function may malfunction due to local radio waves. Then open or close the vehicle with the buttons on the remote control or with a key. To start the engine following this, insert the remote control in the ignition lock.

The warning lamp in the instrument panel lights up when an attempt is made to start the engine: starting the

engine is not possible. The remote control is not in the vehicle or has a malfunction. Take along the remote control into the vehicle or have it checked. Insert another remote control into the ignition lock if necessary.

The warning lamp in the instrument panel lights up when the engine is running: the remote control is no

longer in the vehicle. After switching off the engine, the engine can only be started again within approx. 10 seconds if no door has been opened.

The indicator lamp in the instrument panel lights up and a message appears on the Control Display:

Replace the battery of the remote control.

Replacing battery The remote control for comfort access contains a battery which must be replaced if necessary.

1. Remove integrated key from remote con- trol, refer to page 28.

2. Remove cover.

3. Lay in new battery with positive side facing upward.

4. Press cover closed.

Dispose of used batteries at a collection point or at your BMW Sports Activity

Vehicle Center.<

Windows To prevent injuries, exercise care when closing the windows and keep them in

your field of vision until they are shut. Always take along the remote control when you leave the vehicle, otherwise children could, for example, operate the windows and injure them- selves.<

Opening, closing

> Press switch to resistance point: The window continues to open as long as you keep the switch pressed.

> Press switch beyond resistance point: The window opens automatically. Pressing the switch again stops the opening move- ment.

You can close the windows in the same manner by pulling the switch.

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

42

Separate switches for the rear windows are located in the rear.

For information on using convenience opera- tion at the door lock or with the remote control, refer to page 30 or 32.

For information on comfort closing with comfort access, refer to page 40.

After switching off ignition You can still operate the windows with the remote control removed or the ignition switched off for approx. 1 minute, as long as neither of the front doors has been opened.

Pinch protection system If the closing force rises beyond a predefined threshold during closing, the system will stop moving the window prior to lowering it again slightly.

Despite the pinch protection system, inspect the window's travel path prior to

closing it, as the safety system might fail to detect certain kinds of obstructions, such as thin objects, and the window would continue closing. Do not install any accessories in the range of movement of the windows, otherwise the pinch protection system will be impaired.<

Closing without pinch protection system In case of danger from outside or if, for example, ice on the window prevents normal closing, pro- ceed as follows:

1. Pull the switch beyond the resistance point and hold. The pinch protection system is limited and the window opens slightly if the closing force exceeds a certain value.

2. Pull the switch beyond the resistance point and hold again within approx. 4 seconds. The window closes without the pinch pro- tection system.

Safety switch

With the safety switch, you can prevent the rear windows from being opened or closed via the switches in the rear passenger area, by chil- dren, for example. The LED lights up when this safety feature is activated.

Always press the safety switch when chil- dren ride in the rear, otherwise uncon-

trolled closing of the windows could lead to injuries.<

BMW X5: panorama glass sunroof* The panorama glass sunroof is ready for opera- tion with the ignition switched on, refer to page 65.

To prevent injuries, exercise care when closing the panorama glass sunroof and

keep it in your field of vision until it is closed. Always take along the remote control when you leave the vehicle, otherwise children could, for example, operate the roof and injure them- selves.<

C o

n tr

o ls

43

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Raising, opening, closing

Raising Press the switch. The closed sunroof is raised and the sliding visor opens slightly.

Do not use force to close the sliding visor with the glass sunroof in its raised posi-

tion, otherwise the mechanism will be dam- aged.<

Opening, closing

Sliding visor You can move the sliding visor independently with the sunroof closed or raised.

> Slide the switch back to the resistance point. The sliding visor opens as long as you keep the switch in this position.

> Briefly press the switch back beyond the resistance point. The sliding visor will open automatically. Briefly pressing the switch stops the motion.

You can close the sliding visor in a similar man- ner by sliding the switch forwards.

Panorama glass sunroof With the sliding visor open, proceed as described under Sliding visor.

For information on using convenience opera- tion at the door lock or with the remote control, refer to page 30 or 32.

For information on comfort closing with comfort access, refer to page 40.

Opening and closing sunroof and sliding visor together Briefly press the switch beyond the resistance point twice consecutively. Briefly pressing the switch stops the motion.

Comfort mode > Press the switch twice with the sunroof

open: The sunroof is raised.

> When the sunroof is raised, briefly press the switch twice in the opening direction: The sunroof is opened all the way.

Comfort position In the comfort position, the sunroof is not com- pletely open; this reduces wind noise in the passenger compartment.

Each time the panorama glass sunroof is com- pletely opened or closed, it stops in the comfort position. If desired, continue the motion follow- ing this with the switch.

After switching off ignition You can still operate the roof for approx. 1 minute, as long as no door has been opened.

Pinch protection system If the panorama glass sunroof or sliding visor encounter resistance when closing from roughly one third of the sunroof opening or when closing from the raised position, the clos- ing action is interrupted and the panorama glass sunroof and sliding visor reopen a little.

Despite the pinch protection system, inspect the sunroof's travel path prior to

closing it, as the safety system might fail to detect certain kinds of obstructions, such as very thin objects, and the sunroof would con- tinue closing.<

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

44

Closing without pinch protection system In case of danger from outside, slide the switch forward beyond the resistance point and hold. The roof closes without the pinch protection system.

Following interruptions in electrical power supply After a power loss, the sunroof may only respond to the raise command. Then have the system initialized. BMW recommends having this work carried out by your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center.

Moving manually* In the event of an electrical malfunction, you can move the sunroof manually:

1. Remove trim piece. To do so, gently lift the corner of the trim piece with a screwdriver.

2. Using the screwdriver, press in the clamps one after the other, arrows 1, tilt the cover panel down, arrow 2, and remove.

3. Release and disconnect the motor plug. This significantly reduces the effort required for the manual movement.

4. Insert the Allen wrench* from the onboard tool kit, refer to page 269, into the opening provided. Move the panorama glass sunroof in the desired direction.

5. Reconnect the plug.

6. Clip the trim piece into the cover panel, arrow 1. Then fold the cover panel forward until it audibly clicks into place, arrow 2.

C o

n tr

o ls

45

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

BMW X6: glass sunroof*, electric The glass sunroof is ready for operation when the ignition is switched on, refer to page 65.

To prevent injuries, exercise care when closing the glass sunroof and keep it in

your field of vision until it is closed. Always take along the remote control when you leave the vehicle, otherwise children could, for example, operate the roof and injure them- selves.<

Raising Press the switch. The closed glass sunroof is raised and the slid- ing visor opens slightly.

Do not use force to close the sliding visor with the glass sunroof in its raised posi-

tion, otherwise the mechanism will be dam- aged.<

Opening, closing > Slide the switch back to the resistance

point. The glass sunroof and the sliding visor open together as long as you continue to hold the switch in this position.

> Briefly press the switch back beyond the resistance point. The glass sunroof and the sliding visor open automatically. Briefly pressing the switch stops the motion.

You can close the glass sunroof in a similar manner by sliding the switch forward. The slid- ing visor remains open and can be closed by hand.

For information on using convenience opera- tion with the remote control or at the door lock, refer to page 30 or 32.

For information on convenience closing with comfort access, refer to page 40.

Automatic opening and closing Briefly press the switch beyond the resistance point.

The following movements are also automatic:

> With the sunroof open, press the switch: The sunroof is opened all the way.

> With the sunroof raised, briefly press the switch in the opening direction: the sunroof is opened all the way.

Briefly pressing the switch stops the motion.

Comfort position In the comfort position, the sunroof is not com- pletely open; this reduces wind noise in the passenger compartment. Each time the glass sunroof is opened or closed all the way, it stops in the comfort position. If you wish, you can continue the motion by actu- ating the switch.

After switching off ignition You can still operate the roof for approx. 1 minute, as long as no door has been opened.

Pinch protection system If the glass sunroof meets with resistance from about the middle of the roof opening when clos- ing or when lowering from the raised position, the closing process is interrupted and the glass sunroof opens all the way.

Despite the pinch protection system, inspect the sunroof's travel path prior to

closing it, as the safety system might fail to detect certain kinds of obstructions, such as very thin objects, and the sunroof would con- tinue closing.<

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

46

Closing without pinch protection system When there is danger outside the vehicle, pro- ceed as follows:

1. Slide the switch forward past the resistance point and hold it there. The pinch protection system is limited and the sunroof opens slightly if the closing force exceeds a certain value.

2. Within about 4 seconds, slide the switch forward again beyond the resistance point and hold it there. The roof closes without the pinch protection system.

Following interruptions in electrical power supply After a power loss, the sunroof may only respond to the raise command. Then have the system initialized. BMW recommends having this work carried out by your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center.

Moving manually* In the event of an electrical malfunction, you can move the sunroof manually:

1. Remove trim piece. To do so, gently lift the corner of the trim piece with a screwdriver.

2. Using the screwdriver, press in the clamps one after the other, arrows 1, tilt the cover panel down, arrow 2, and remove.

3. Release and disconnect the motor plug. This significantly reduces the effort required for the manual movement.

4. Take the Allen wrench* from its bracket in the onboard tool kit, refer to page 269, and insert it into the opening provided. Move the glass sunroof in the desired direction.

5. Reconnect the plug.

C o

n tr

o ls

47

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

6. Clip the trim piece into the cover panel, arrow 1. Then fold the cover panel forward until it audibly clicks into place, arrow 2.

A d

ju st

in g

48

Adjusting

Sitting safely The ideal sitting position can make a vital con- tribution to relaxed, fatigue-free driving. In the interaction with the safety belts, the head restraints and the airbags, the seat position plays an important role in an accident. To ensure that the safety systems operate with optimal efficiency, we strongly urge you to observe the instructions contained in the fol- lowing section.

For additional information on transporting chil- dren safely, refer to page 61.

Airbags Always maintain an adequate distance between yourself and the airbags. Always

hold the steering wheel by its rim with hands at the 9 o'clock and 3 o'clock positions, to mini- mize the risk of injuries to your hands and arms in the event of airbag deployment. No one and nothing is to come between the air- bags and the seat occupant. Do not use the cover of the front airbag on the front passenger side as a storage area. Make sure that the front passenger is sitting correctly and does not rest feet or legs on the instrument cluster, otherwise leg injuries can occur if the front airbag is triggered. Make sure that occupants do not rest their head on the side or head airbag, otherwise injuries can occur if the airbags are triggered.<

Even if you adhere to all the instructions, inju- ries resulting from contact with airbags cannot be fully excluded, depending on the circum- stances. The ignition and inflation noise may provoke a mild hearing loss in extremely sensi- tive individuals. This effect is usually only tem- porary.

For airbag locations and additional information on airbags, refer to page 105.

Head restraint A correctly adjusted head restraint reduces the risk of spinal injury in the event of an accident.

Adjust the head restraint so that its center is approx. at ear level. Otherwise there is

increased danger of injury in the event of an accident.<

BMW X5: push the head restraints of the 3rd row seats* into the top position.

Head restraints, refer to page 52.

Safety belts Before every drive, make sure that safety belts are being worn at all of the occupied seats. Air- bags complement the safety belt as an addi- tional safety device, but they do not represent a substitute.

BMW X5: depending on its equipment, your vehicle has either five or seven seats, which are all provided with a safety belt.

Never allow more than one person to wear a single safety belt. Never allow

infants or small children to ride in a passenger's lap. Make sure that the belt lies low around the hips in the lap area and does not press on the abdomen. The safety belt may not lie across the neck, rub on sharp edges, be routed over solid or breakable objects or be pinched. Wear the safety belt without twisting, snugly across the lap and shoulders, as close to the body as pos- sible. Otherwise the belt can slip over the hips in the lap area in a frontal impact and injure the abdomen. Avoid wearing clothing that prevents the belt from fitting properly and pull the belt in the upper body area periodically to readjust the tension, in order to avoid a reduction in the restraint of the safety belt. If the center safety belt in the rear is used, the larger backrest half must be locked, refer to page 132, otherwise the center safety belt has no restraining action.<

Safety belts, refer to page 54.

C o

n tr

o ls

49

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Seats

Note before adjusting Never attempt to adjust or calibrate your seat while the vehicle is moving. The seat

could respond with unexpected movement, and the ensuing loss of vehicle control could lead to an accident. Never adjust manually adjustable seats while the vehicle is moving, as otherwise the restrain- ing effect of these seats during accidents could be reduced. Also on the passenger side, do not incline the backrest too far to the rear while the vehicle is being driven, otherwise there is a danger in the event of an accident of sliding under the safety belt, eliminating the protection normally pro- vided by the belt.<

Also observe the information on damage to safety belts on page 55 and on the height of the head restraints on page 52.

Adjusting manually* To ensure that the safety systems con- tinue to provide optimized protection,

observe the adjustment instructions on page 48.<

Pull the lever and slide the seat to the desired position. After you release the lever, move the seat forward or backward slightly so that it engages fully.

Thigh support*

Pull the lever and adjust the thigh support in the longitudinal direction.

Adjusting electrically To ensure that the safety systems con- tinue to provide optimized protection,

observe the adjustment instructions on page 48.<

1 Longitudinal direction

2 Height

3 Seat tilt

4 Backrest

A d

ju st

in g

50

Differs depending on seat:

1 Backrest

2 Height

Additional depending on seat:

1 Backrest width* 2 Shoulder support* 3 Thigh support* 4 Lumbar support*

Backrest width* The width of the backrest can be changed with the side wings to adjust the side support to your own needs.

Shoulder support* This also supports the back in the shoulder area, provides a relaxed sitting position and helps relieve stress on the shoulder muscles.

The shoulder support is also used to adjust the distance of the head restraint from the back of the seat occupant's head.

Lumbar support*

You can also adjust the contour of the backrest to obtain additional support in the lumbar region.

The upper hips and spinal column receive sup- plementary support to help you maintain a relaxed, upright sitting position.

> Increase or decrease curvature: press front or rear section of switch.

> Shift curvature up or down: press upper or lower section of switch.

Seat, mirror and steering wheel memory* You can store and request two different posi- tions for the driver's seat and passenger seat*, exterior rearview mirrors, and steering wheel.

The adjustment of the backrest width and lum- bar support is not stored in the memory.

Storing

1. Switch on radio readiness or ignition, refer to page 65.

2. Set the desired seat, exterior mirror and steering wheel positions.

C o

n tr

o ls

51

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

3. Press the button: The LED in the button lights up.

4. Press the desired memory button 1 or 2: The LED goes out.

The positions of the driver's seat, the exte- rior rearview mirrors, and steering wheel are stored for the remote control currently in use.

Calling up automatically You can choose when the stored positions of the driver's seat, exterior rearview mirrors, and steering wheel are activated.

> Calling up when unlocking vehicle

> Calling up when opening driver's door

When using this feature, always make sure that the footwell behind the driver's

seat is empty and unobstructed. Failure to do so could cause injury to persons or damage to objects behind the seat as a result of a rearward movement of the seat.<

The system cancels the adjustment procedure when you briefly press one of the seat adjust- ment switches or one of the memory buttons.

Selecting calling up automatically iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Door locks" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Central locking" and press the con- troller.

7. Select "Last seat pos." and press the con- troller.

8. Select "After unlocking" or "After door opened".

9. Press the controller.

Deactivating calling up automatically Select "Deactivated" and press the controller.

Calling up manually Do not call up a position from the memory while the vehicle is moving. There is a risk

of accident from unexpected movement of the seat or steering wheel.<

Comfort mode 1. Open the driver's door after unlocking or

switch on radio readiness.

2. Briefly press the desired memory button 1 or 2.

The system cancels the adjustment procedure when you briefly press one of the seat adjust- ment switches or one of the memory buttons.

Safety feature 1. Close the driver's door and switch the igni-

tion on or off.

2. Press the desired memory button 1 or 2 and maintain pressure until the adjustment process has been completed.

If the button was pressed inadvertently: press the button again; the LED goes out.

A d

ju st

in g

52

Head restraints A correctly adjusted head restraint reduces the risk of spinal injury in the event of an accident.

Adjust the head restraint so that its center is approx. at ear level. Otherwise there is

increased danger of injury in the event of an accident. Only remove the head restraints if the respective seat is not occupied. Reinstall the head restraints before transporting passen- gers, as otherwise the head restraint cannot provide its protective function.<

Active front head restraints In the event of a rear-end collision of sufficient severity, the active head restraint reduces the distance to the head.

Do not use seat covers or head restraint covers that could impede the proper

functioning of the active head restraint. Other- wise, there is no assurance that the active head restraint will perform its protective function and it is not possible to take advantage of its injury- reducing potential in the event of a rear-end collision. Have the active head restraints reset after they are triggered in a rear-end collision. Have this work carried out only at a BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center or at a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with cor- respondingly trained personnel. Otherwise, correct operation of this safety equipment is not guaranteed.<

Removal and installation of the front head restraints should be performed by a BMW

Sports Activity Vehicle Center.<

Front seats: height adjustment

You can adjust the height of the head restraints electrically.

Front seats: adjusting distance from back of head

> Forward: pull up.

> Back: press the button and slide the head- rest cushion toward the rear.

Do not place any objects behind the headrest cushion. Otherwise, you can

impair the proper function of the head restraint.<

Comfort seat* You can adjust the distance from the back of the seat occupant's head using the shoulder sup- port, refer to page 50.

C o

n tr

o ls

53

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Adjusting side extensions

You can fold the side extensions on the head restraint forward for increased lateral support in the resting position.

BMW X5: rear seats and 3rd row seats*, adjusting height

> To raise: pull up.

> To lower: press the button, arrow 1,and push the head restraint downward.

In vehicles equipped with 3rd row seats, the height of the middle head restraint is not adjust- able.

Removing 1. Pull the head restraint upward to the stop.

2. Press the button, arrow 1, and pull the head restraint all the way out.

BMW X5: rear seats

2nd row seats With a divided* row of seats you can adjust both sides individually.

Never adjust the 2nd row seats while the vehicle is moving, as otherwise the pas-

sengers on the 3rd row seats could be injured. Make sure that the locking devices of the 2nd row seats engage properly. Otherwise the restraining effect of the safety belts during an accident could be reduced.<

Longitudinal direction*

1. Pull the lever and slide the seat into the desired position.

2. Release the lever and move the seat slightly forward or back so that it engages properly.

Backrest* The backrests can be adjusted in four steps.

Pull the lever and apply weight to or remove weight from the backrest as needed.

A d

ju st

in g

54

Access to 3rd row seats*

Pull the lever and fold the seat forward.

The handle recess on the interior trim of the door pillar makes climbing in easier.<

When folding back the 2nd row seats, make sure that the footwell under the

2nd row seats is clear. Otherwise persons in the 3rd row seats could be injured or objects dam- aged.<

Warning lamp for 2nd row seats: Lights up when the 2nd row seats are not locked. A message also appears

on the Control Display.

3rd row seats* The 3rd row seats are divided and offer space for two persons.

Folding up backrest Before folding the seats up, remove the roll-up cover, refer to page 130, and if need be, slide the 2nd row seats slightly forward.

1. Pull the lever, refer to arrow. The backrest is unlocked.

2. Fold up and engage the backrest.

Make sure that the catch engages securely. If it is not properly engaged,

transported cargo could enter the passen- ger compartment during braking or evasive maneuvers and endanger the vehicle occu- pants.<

3. Push the head restraints into the top posi- tion.

Folding backrest down 1. Push down the head restraint, refer to

page 53.

2. Pull the lever, refer to arrows. The backrests are released.

3. Fold the backrest down.

Safety belts To ensure that the safety systems con- tinue to provide optimized protection,

observe the adjustment instructions on page 48.<

Before every drive, make sure that safety belts are being worn at all of the occupied seats. Air- bags complement the safety belt as an addi- tional safety device, but they do not represent a substitute.

C o

n tr

o ls

55

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Fastening Make sure you hear the latch plate engage in the belt buckle.

Safety belt reminder for driver's seat and passenger seat

The indicator lamp lights up and a signal sounds. A message also appears on the Control Display.

Please check whether the safety belt is cor- rectly fastened.

The safety belt reminder is operative at speeds above approx. 5 mph/8 km/h. It can also be acti- vated if objects are placed on the passenger seat.

Releasing 1. Grasp the belt firmly.

2. Press the red button in the buckle.

3. Guide the belt into its reel.

The shoulder strap's anchorage point will be correct for adult seat occupants of every build if the seat is correctly adjusted, refer to page 49.

BMW X5: the two rear safety belt buckles inte- grated into the rear seat are for passengers sit- ting on the left and right. The belt buckle embossed with the word CENTER is intended exclusively for use by passengers riding in the center position.

Damage to safety belts In the event of loads caused by accidents or other damage: replace the belt system

including the safety belt tensioners and any child restraint devices, and have the belt anchor points checked. Only have this work carried out at a BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center or at a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained per- sonnel. Otherwise correct operation of this safety equipment is not guaranteed.<

Belt-force limiter The effect of the belt-force limiter on the driver's seat is dependent on the position of the driver's seat.

To maintain the long-term accuracy of this function, the driver's seat must be calibrated if a corresponding message is displayed on the Control Display.

Calibrating driver's seat The warning lamp lights up. A mes- sage also appears on the Control Dis- play. Please calibrate the driver's

seat.

1. Move the driver's seat forward until it stops.

2. Move the driver's seat forward again. It briefly moves toward the front in the pro- cess.

3. Set the desired seating position again.

The calibration is completed when the message on the Control Display disappears. Should this message continue to be displayed, repeat the calibration. If the message does not disappear even after repeated calibration, have the sys- tem checked as soon as possible.

Never carry out calibration while the vehi- cle is moving, as this can cause accidents.

Make sure that no persons or objects become wedged during the calibration process, as this can cause injuries or damage.<

Seat heating*

Front

The temperature setting progresses one step through its control sequence each time you press the button. The maximum temperature is supplied when three LEDs are lit.

To switch off: press the button longer.

A d

ju st

in g

56

The temperature is reduced, if need be, down to no heat in order to reduce the load on the bat- tery. The LEDs remain lit.

Rear

Operation similar to front seat heating; without temperature distribution.

Active seat ventilation* and seat heating*

Front

1 Seat heating

2 Active seat ventilation

Press button 1 or 2 once depending on the temperature or ventilation position. The LED in the respective button lights up.

The temperature or ventilation levels are shown on the Control Display.

The air quantity is reduced and if need be, the ventilation is switched off in order to reduce the load on the battery. The LEDs remain lit.

To switch off: press button 1 or 2 longer.

Temperature distribution without active seat ventilation The heat output can be distributed variously in the seat cushion and the backrest.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Move the controller to the left to open "Cli- mate".

3. Select "Seat heater distribution" and press the controller.

4. Move the controller to the left or right to select "Driver" or "Passenger".

5. Turn the controller. The adjustment is applied; the field can be changed.

Temperature distribution with active seat ventilation The heat output can be distributed variously in the seat cushion and the backrest.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Move the controller to the left to open "Cli- mate".

3. Select "Driver's seat climate" or "Passen- ger's seat climate" and press the controller.

C o

n tr

o ls

57

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

4. Turn the controller to adjust the distribu- tion. The setting is applied.

Heated rear seats Operation similar to front seat heating; without temperature distribution, refer to page 55.

Active seat*

The seat cushion is actively varied by alter- nately raising and lowering the right and left half of the seat cushion. This reduces muscular ten- sion and fatigue to help prevent lower back pain.

Press the button to switch on; the LED lights up.

The action of the system is reduced and if need be, switched off in order to reduce the load on the battery. The LED remains lit.

If you switch off the active seat, it can take up to 1 minute before the two halves of the seat cushion have returned to their initial position.

Mirrors

Exterior mirrors The mirror on the passenger's side is more curved than the driver's mirror.

Objects reflected in the mirror are closer than they appear. Do not estimate the distance of following traffic based on what you see in the mirrors; otherwise, there is an increased risk of accident.<

1 Adjusting

2 Switching to the other mirror or to the auto- matic curb monitor

3 Folding mirrors in and out* Storing the mirror positions, refer to Seat, mir- ror and steering wheel memory on page 50.

Adjusting manually The mirrors can also be adjusted manually: press the edge of the glass.

Folding mirrors in and out* Pressing button 3 allows you to fold the mirrors in and out again up to a speed of approx. 12 mph/20 km/h. This is advantageous, for example, in car washes, narrow streets or for bringing mirrors that have been manually folded in back into the correct position. Folded in mirrors fold out again at a speed of approx. 25 mph/40 km/h.

Before going through a car wash, fold the mirrors in manually, or with button 3, oth-

erwise they could be damaged, depending on the width of the car wash system.<

A d

ju st

in g

58

Automatic heating Below a certain outdoor temperature, both exterior mirrors are automatically heated when the motor is running or the ignition is switched on.

Tilting down passenger-side exterior mirror automatic curb monitor*

Activating 1. Slide switch into the driver's side mirror

position, arrow 1.

2. Engage transmission position R. The mirror glass tilts downward somewhat on the passenger side. This allows the driver to see the area immediately adjacent to the vehicle such as a curb when park- ing, etc.

Deactivating Slide switch into the passenger side mirror position, arrow 2.

Interior rearview mirror

To reduce the dazzle effect of following vehi- cles at night, turn the knob.

Interior and exterior mirrors, automatic dimming feature*

This feature is controlled by two photocells in the inside rearview mirror, one on the front and one on the back.

For trouble-free operation, keep the photocells clean and do not cover the area between the interior rearview mirror and the windshield. Do not attach stickers of any kind to the windshield in front of the mirror, either.

Steering wheel

Adjusting Do not adjust the steering wheel while the vehicle is moving. There is a risk of acci-

dent as the result of unexpected movement.<

The steering wheel can be adjusted in four directions.

Storing steering wheel positions, refer to Seat, mirror and steering wheel memory on page 50.

Easy entry/exit* To facilitate entry and exit, the steering wheel temporarily moves into the uppermost position.

C o

n tr

o ls

59

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Steering wheel heating*

Press the button. When the steering wheel heater is switched on, the LED in the button lights up.

Programmable buttons on steering wheel

You can program the buttons individually.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Steering wheel buttons" and press the controller.

A list of different functions appears:

> "Navigation voice instructions" Voice instructions for the navigation system*

> "Air recirculation on / off" Permanently shutting off outside air, refer to AUC Automatic recirculated-air control* on page 117

> "Mute on / off" Mutes the audio sources

> "Monitor on / off" Switches the Control Display on/off

> "Telephone list"* Display/hide phone book or last list of stored phone numbers

> "Next entertainment source" Changes audio source

5. Select the desired function and press the controller.

6. Select the button if necessary and press the controller.

You can operate the selected function using the corresponding button.

A d

ju st

in g

60

Operating function Press the corresponding button on the steering wheel.

If you have programmed "Navigation voice instructions" for one of the buttons:

> To switch voice instructions on/off: Hold the button down.

> To repeat the last voice instruction: Press the button.

C o

n tr

o ls

61

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Transporting children safely

The right place for children Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, otherwise they could endanger

themselves and other persons, e.g. by opening the doors.<

Children always in rear Accident research shows that the safest place for children is on the rear seat.

Children younger than 13 years of age or with a height under 5 ft/150 cm may only

be transported on the 2nd row seats in child restraint devices which correspond to the age, weight and height of the child. Otherwise there is an increased danger of injury in an accident.<

Children 13 years of age or older must wear a safety belt as soon as a suitable child restraint device can no longer be used due to their age, weight and size.

Exception for front passenger seat Should it be necessary to use a child restraint device on the front passenger

seat, the front and side airbags on the passen- ger side must be deactivated. Otherwise, there is an increased risk of injury for the child if the airbags are triggered, even with a child restraint device.<

For more information on automatic deactivation of the front passenger airbags, refer to page 106.

Installing child restraint devices

Follow the child restraint device manufac- turer's instructions for selection, installa-

tion, and use of child restraint devices. Other- wise, the degree of protection may be reduced.<

BMW X5: for equipment with 3rd row seats*, make sure that the seat of the 2nd

row seats on which the child restraint device is mounted is properly locked. Otherwise there is an increased risk of injury for the child in an accident. Do not mount child restraint devices on the 3rd row seats, as otherwise the protection pro- vided by these child restraint devices may be reduced.<

On front passenger seat After mounting a child restraint device on the front passenger seat, make sure that

the front and side airbags on the front passen- ger side are deactivated; otherwise, there is an increased risk of injury if the airbags are trig- gered.<

Backrest width* The backrest width adjustment of the front passenger seat must be completely

open. After installing the child's seat, no mem- ory position may be called up; otherwise, the stability of the child's seat on the front passen- ger seat is reduced.<

1. Open backrest width adjustment com- pletely, refer to page 50.

2. Install child's seat.

Child seat security

The rear safety belts, in the BMW X5 all of the safety belts of the 2nd and 3rd* row seats and the passenger safety belt can be locked to pre- vent them from being pulled out in order to secure child restraint devices.

T ra

n sp

o rt

in g

c h

ild re

n s

af el

y

62

Locking safety belt 1. Secure the child restraint device with the

belt.

2. Pull out the belt webbing completely.

3. Allow the belt webbing to be pulled in and pull taut against the child restraint device. The safety belt is locked.

Unlocking safety belt 1. Open the belt buckle.

2. Remove the child restraint device.

3. Allow the belt webbing to be pulled in com- pletely.

LATCH child restraint fixing system LATCH: Lower Anchor and Tethers for CHil- dren.

Follow the system manufacturer's instructions on installation and use of

LATCH child restraint devices; otherwise, their protective function may be reduced.<

Before attaching the child's seat, pull the belt away from the region of the child restraint fixing system.

BMW X5: before installing the child's seat, remove the covers* from the

mounts for the LATCH anchor fittings, as other- wise the LATCH anchor fittings have no restraining effect.<

Make sure that the LATCH mounts have properly clicked into place and that the

child restraint device is resting snugly against the backrest. Otherwise, the protective action may be reduced.<

The mounts for the LATCH anchors are located at the points indicated by the arrows.

Child restraint device with tether strap Only use the top tether mounting points to secure child restraint devices, other-

wise the mounting points could be damaged. Do not mount child restraint devices on the 3rd row seats in the BMW X5; otherwise the protection provided by these child restraint devices may be reduced.<

BMW X5

There are three additional mounting points for child restraint devices with a tether strap on the 2nd row seats, refer to arrows. Fold out before using the center mounting point.

C o

n tr

o ls

63

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

BMW X6

For child restraint devices with tether strap, there are two additional attachment points on the back of the rear seat backrests, refer to arrows.

Placement of tether strap Make sure that the tether strap is not routed over sharp edges and does not

twist on its way to the attachment point; other- wise, the belt cannot properly secure the child restraint device in the event of an accident.<

BMW X5

1 Direction of travel

2 Head restraint

3 Tether strap hook

4 Mounting point

5 Backrest

6 Tether strap of child restraint device

When using the cargo bay cover, route the tether strap through between the backrest of the 2nd row seats and the cargo bay cover.

BMW X6

1 Direction of travel

2 Head restraint

3 Tether strap hook

4 Mounting point

5 Backrest

6 Tether strap of child restraint device

When using the cargo bay cover, route the tether strap through between the rear seat backrest and the cargo bay cover.

T ra

n sp

o rt

in g

c h

ild re

n s

af el

y

64

Attaching tether strap to the backrest of the 2nd row seats BMW X5:

On outer seats:

1. Slide the head restraint upward.

2. Guide the tether strap between the head restraint brackets.

3. Hook in the tether strap on the mounting point with the hook.

4. Slide the head restraint into the bottom position.

5. Pull tether strap taut.

On center seat with equipment with two rows of seats:

1. Fold the center armrest somewhat toward the front.

2. Guide the tether strap through the opening in the center armrest.

3. Fold back and engage the center armrest.

4. Hook in tether strap on mounting point.

5. Pull tether strap taut.

On center seat with equipment with three rows of seats:

1. Slide the head restraint upward.

2. Guide the tether strap between the head restraint brackets.

3. Hook in the tether strap on the mounting point with the hook.

4. Slide the head restraint into the bottom position.

5. Pull tether strap taut.

BMW X6:

1. Route tether strap over the middle of the head restraint.

2. Hook in the tether strap on the mounting point with the hook.

3. Pull tether strap taut until it compresses the cushion of the head restraint, thus prevent- ing the tether strap from sliding off.

On trips

Child-safety locks for rear doors

Slide down the safety lever on the rear doors: The door can now be opened from the outside only.

Safety switch for power windows Always press the safety switch for the power windows, refer to page 42, when children are riding in the rear of the vehicle.

C o

n tr

o ls

65

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Driving

Ignition lock

Inserting remote control into ignition lock

Insert the remote control as far as possible into the ignition lock. Radio readiness switches on. Some electronic systems/consumers are ready for operation.

Comfort access* With comfort access, only insert the remote control into the ignition lock in exceptional cases, refer to page 39.

Removing remote control from ignition lock

Do not pull the remote control out of the ignition lock using force, as otherwise

damage may result.<

Before removing the remote control, first press it in as far as possible to release the locking device. The ignition is switched off if it was still switched on.

Start/Stop button

Pressing the Start/Stop button switches the radio readiness or the ignition on and off.

Pressing the Start/Stop button with the brake pedal depressed starts the

engine.<

Radio readiness Some electronic systems/consumers are ready for operation. The time and outside tempera- ture are displayed in the instrument panel.

Radio readiness is automatically switched off:

> when the remote control is removed from the ignition lock

> with comfort access* by touching the sen- sitive surface above the door lock, refer to Locking on page 40

Ignition on All electronic systems/consumers are ready for operation. The odometer and the trip odometer are displayed in the instrument panel, refer to page 78.

Please switch off the ignition and the electronic systems/consumers which are

not required when the engine is not running to save the battery.<

Radio readiness and ignition off All indicator lamps, warning lamps, and displays in the instrument panel go out.

D ri

vi n

g

66

The ignition switches off automatically* if the driver's door is opened. Pressing the start/stop button again switches the ignition back on.

For example, the ignition is not switched off in the following situations:

> the brakes are actuated

> the low beams are switched on

Starting engine Do not run the engine in closed rooms, otherwise the inhalation of toxic exhaust

gases can cause unconsciousness and death. The exhaust gases contain carbon monoxide, an odorless and colorless, but highly toxic gas. Never leave an unattended vehicle with the engine running, as such a vehicle represents a potential safety hazard. To prevent the vehicle from rolling, always engage transmission position N or P and set the parking brake before leaving the vehicle with the engine running.<

Do not allow the engine to warm up by leaving it running while the vehicle remains stationary. Instead, begin to drive at a moderate engine speed.

The engine starts when you depress the brake pedal while pressing the Start/Stop

button.<

Avoid frequent starting in quick succes- sion or repeated starting attempts in

which the engine does not start. Otherwise, the fuel is not burned or inadequately burned and there is a danger of overheating and damaging the catalytic converter.<

Remote control in ignition lock or with comfort access in vehicle, refer to page 39.

1. Depress brake pedal.

2. Press the Start/Stop button.

The system responds by automatically engag- ing the starter for a certain period and automat- ically disengaging it as soon as the engine starts.

Diesel engine When the engine is cold and outside tempera- tures are below approx. 327/06, the starting process may be briefly delayed by an automatic preglow phase. The preglow indicator lamp lights up in the instrument panel and a message appears on the Control Display.

Switching off engine When leaving the vehicle, always take along the remote control.

Set the parking brake firmly when parking; oth- erwise, the vehicle could roll.<

Procedure 1. Engage transmission position P with the

vehicle stationary.

2. Press the Start/Stop button.

3. Set the parking brake.

4. Remove the remote control from the igni- tion lock, refer to page 65.

Before driving into a car wash The vehicle can roll if you proceed according to the following steps:

1. With comfort access*: insert the remote control into the ignition lock.

2. Depress brake pedal.

3. Engage transmission position N.

4. Release the parking brake or deactivate Automatic Hold.

5. Switch off the engine.

C o

n tr

o ls

67

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Transmission position P will be engaged:

> automatically after approx. 30 minutes

> if you remove the remote control from the ignition lock

Parking brake

The concept Your BMW is equipped with an electromechan- ical parking brake.

The parking brake is primarily intended to pre- vent the vehicle from rolling while parked.

You can use the parking brake in two ways:

> manually, by pulling and pushing the button

> automatically, by activating Automatic Hold, refer to page 67

With the engine stopped, the parking brake acts on the rear wheels via an electromechanical system. When the engine is running, the park- ing brake acts on the disk brakes of the front and rear wheels via the brake hydraulics.

Setting manually

Pull button. The parking brake is set.

The indicator lamp in the instrument panel lights up red. The parking brake is set.

Indicator lamp on Canadian models.

The remote control does not have to be inserted into the ignition lock for the parking brake to be set.

While driving If exceptional circumstances should make it necessary to set the parking brake while the vehicle is in motion, pull on the button longer. The vehicle continues to brake forcefully for as long as you pull on the button.

The indicator lamp in the instrument panel lights up red, a chime sounds and the brake lamps light up.

Indicator lamp on Canadian models.

As soon as you brake the vehicle almost to a stop, i.e., down to a speed of approx. 2 mph/ 3 km/h or below, the parking brake remains set.

Releasing manually

Press the button with the brake depressed.

The indicator lamp in the instrument panel goes out.

Indicator lamp on Canadian models.

When leaving the vehicle, always take along the remote control; this precaution

prevents children from releasing the parking brake, for example.<

Automatic Hold

The concept This function assists you as you drive by auto- matically setting and releasing the parking brake, e.g. when you are stopped at a traffic sig- nal or in stop-and-go traffic. When Automatic Hold is activated, the vehicle is

D ri

vi n

g

68

automatically held in place when standing. When driving up inclines, the system prevents your vehicle from rolling backward in an undes- ired way.

After the engine is started, the system can be activated and deactivated at any time the driver's seat is occupied until the next time the engine is switched off.

Activating

Press the button. The LED in the button lights up and the indication AUTO H appears in the instrument panel. Automatic Hold is activated.

If the vehicle is being held by Automatic Hold, the indicator light in the instru- ment panel also lights up in green.

Indicator lamp on Canadian models.

Deactivating Press the button again, the LED in the button and the indication AUTO H in the instrument panel go out. Automatic Hold is deactivated.

If the vehicle is being held by Automatic Hold, then press on the brake pedal to deactivate it.

When the parking brake is set manually, refer to page 67, Automatic Hold is automatically deac- tivated.

Driving With Automatic Hold activated, the vehicle is automatically prevented from rolling after it comes to a stop.

The indicator lamp in the instrument panel lights up in green.

Indicator lamp on Canadian models.

If the transmission is in a drive position, simply press on the gas pedal to begin driving. The brake is automatically released and the indica- tor lamp goes out.

Before driving into the car wash, deacti- vate Automatic Hold; otherwise, the park-

ing brake will be automatically set after stop- ping and the vehicle can no longer roll.<

Parking If the vehicle is being held by Automatic Hold and you switch off the motor, the parking brake is automatically set.

The indicator lamp in the instrument panel changes from green to red.

Indicator lamp on Canadian models.

The parking brake is not set if you have already switched off the engine while the

vehicle is rolling to a stop. Automatic Hold is deactivated.<

You can manually release the parking brake even after switching off the motor as long as the remote control remains in the ignition lock, refer to page 67. Use this function in car washes, for example.

When leaving the vehicle, always take along the remote control; this precaution

prevents children from releasing the parking brake, for example.<

For your safety Automatic Hold is automatically deactivated when:

> the engine is switched off

> no one is detected in the driver's seat when the engine is running

C o

n tr

o ls

69

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

> the vehicle is braked to a stop during driv- ing.

In the instrument panel, the indicator lamp changes from green to red and the indication AUTO H goes out.

Indicator lamp on Canadian models.

Before you start to drive, either release the parking brake manually, refer to page 67, or reactivate Automatic Hold, refer to page 68.

Before leaving the vehicle with the engine running, shift the selector lever into posi-

tion P of the automatic transmission and make sure that the parking brake is set. Otherwise, the vehicle may begin to roll.<

Malfunction If the parking brake fails or malfunctions, secure the vehicle against rolling, e.g. with a wheel chock, if you leave the vehicle.

Releasing parking brake manually In the event of an electrical power loss or elec- trical malfunction, you can release the parking brake manually.

Before manually releasing the parking brake and each time you park the vehicle

without setting the parking brake, make sure that the automatic transmission is in position P, refer to page 71. Be sure to pay attention to the information in the instrument panel. In addition, secure the vehicle against rolling, e.g. with a wheel chock. Otherwise there is a danger that the vehicle could roll if parked on a steep slope.<

If it becomes necessary to also release the transmission lock of the automatic transmission manually, follow this sequence:

1. If necessary, start by releasing the parking brake manually.

2. Then release the automatic transmission's transmission lock manually, refer to page 72.

Jump starting and towing, refer to information starting on page 280.

Releasing 1. Open the left-hand side panel in the cargo

bay.

2. Remove the first-aid kit* and the warning triangle* if necessary. Close the bracket of the warning triangle.

3. Insert the releasing tool, contained in the onboard tool kit under the floor panel, refer to page 269, at the releasing point.

4. Firmly pull the releasing tool upward against the mechanical resistance, refer to arrow, until a considerable increase in force is felt and the parking brake is then clearly heard to release.

5. Stow the releasing tool, warning triangle* and first-aid kit* and close the left side panel in the cargo bay.

Only have a malfunction corrected by the nearest BMW Sports Activity Vehicle

Center or a workshop that works in accordance with BMW guidelines and uses appropriately trained personnel. If the parking brake has been released manually in response to a malfunction, only technicians can return it to operation.<

Following manual release, the actual sta- tus of the parking brake may deviate from

that displayed by the indicator lamp.<

Operation after interruptions in power supply

The parking brake can only be used again if it was manually released due to an inter-

ruption in the supply of electrical power. Other- wise the operation of the parking brake is not ensured and there is a danger of the vehicle roll- ing despite the parking brake being set.<

D ri

vi n

g

70

Procedure 1. Switch on the ignition.

2. Press the button with the brake depressed.

The indicator lamp in the instrument panel goes out as soon as the parking brake is ready for operation again.

Indicator lamp on Canadian models.

Any noises which occur are normal. Start-up may take several seconds.

Automatic transmission with Steptronic In addition to fully automatic operation, you can also manually shift with the Steptronic, refer to page 71.

Transmission positions P R N D M/S +

To prevent the vehicle from creeping after you select a driving position, main-

tain pressure on the brake pedal until you are ready to start.<

Displays in instrument panel

P R N D, DS*, S1* through S6*, M1 through M6

The transmission position and the currently engaged gear are displayed.

Engaging transmission position > You can only engage transmission posi-

tions D, R or N when the engine is running.

> With the vehicle stationary, depress the brake pedal before shifting out of P or N; otherwise the shift command will not be executed: shiftlock.

To prevent the vehicle from creeping after you select a driving position,

maintain pressure on the brake pedal until you are ready to start.<

Shifting into D, R, N

Briefly press the selector lever in the desired direction, beyond a resistance point if neces- sary. When shifting out of P or into R, simulta- neously press button 1.

The engaged transmission position is displayed on the selector lever.

The selector lever immediately returns to the center position when released.

Engaging P

Press button P.

Also observe the additional information on the automatic transmission.

C o

n tr

o ls

71

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

The transmission automatically shifts into park if you release the driver's safety belt

and open the driver's door with the engine run- ning while in reverse or drive. The picture from the rear view camera* and PDC Park Distance Control* on the Control Display is hidden.<

R Reverse Select only with the vehicle stationary.

An interlock prevents inadvertent gearshifts into transmission position R. To deactivate the interlock, press the release button 1.

P Park Select only with the vehicle stationary. The rear wheels are locked.

P is engaged automatically as soon as you switch off the engine unless N is

engaged and on vehicles with comfort access the remote control is inserted in the ignition lock, refer to page 65.<

N Neutral Can, for example, be engaged in automatic car washes. The vehicle can roll.

N remains engaged even after the engine is switched off whenever you leave the

remote control in the ignition lock. This function is used, for example, in a car wash, refer to page 66. After approx. 30 minutes P is auto- matically engaged.<

D Drive, automatic position Position for normal vehicle operation. All for- ward gears are available. Under normal operating conditions, the fuel consumption is lowest when driving in posi- tion D.

Kick-down The kick-down mode provides maximum accel- eration. Press the accelerator pedal beyond the increased resistance at full throttle.

Sport program and manual mode M/S

Press selector lever out of transmission position D toward the left: The sport program is activated and DS is displayed in the instrument cluster; in the BMW X6, S1 through S6 are displayed. This position is recommended for a performance- oriented driving style.

When the selector lever is pressed forward or back, the manual mode is activated and the Steptronic shifts the gear. The instrument panel shows M1 through M6.

Upshifts and downshifts are executed only when they will result in a plausible combination of engine and vehicle speed; thus, for example, a downshift that would cause the engine to overrev will not be executed by the system. The selected gear is briefly displayed in the instru- ment panel, followed by the current gear.

To use the automatic function again, press the selector lever to the right into position D.

BMW X6: changing gears using shifting paddles on steering wheel The shifting paddles make it possible to quickly change gears since both hands can remain on the steering wheel.

> In automatic mode D, if you shift using the shifting paddles on the steering wheel, then the system switches into manual mode.

> If, after a certain amount of time, you neither shift with the shifting paddles nor acceler- ate, then the system switches back into automatic mode D.

With the transmission position M/S selected, the manual mode remains

active.<

D ri

vi n

g

72

> Upshifting: pull on one of the shifting pad- dles, arrows +.

> Downshifting: press on one of the shifting paddles, arrows .

Upshifts and downshifts are executed only when they will result in a plausible combination of engine and vehicle speed; thus, for example, a downshift that would cause the engine to overrev will not be executed by the system. The selected gear is briefly displayed in the instru- ment panel, followed by the current gear.

Manually releasing and engaging transmission lock

In case of a power failure, e.g. when the battery is drained or disconnected, or an

electrical malfunction, the transmission lock must be manually released, as otherwise the rear wheels are blocked and the vehicle cannot be towed.<

Step on the brake when manually releas- ing the transmission lock; otherwise,

there is a danger of the vehicle rolling.<

The transmission lock should only be released for towing. Reengage the transmission lock after parking the vehicle at its destination.

If it also becomes necessary to manually release the parking brake, follow this sequence:

1. Secure the vehicle against rolling.

2. Manually release the parking brake, refer to page 69.

3. Manually release the transmission lock of the automatic transmission.

Releasing 1. Slide back the cover of the cup holder and

remove the floor mat on the bar between the cup holders, arrow 1.

2. Open the cover in the bottom of the cup holder with the releasing tool from the onboard tool kit, page 269, refer to arrow 2.

3. If necessary, unlock the lock* with the inte- grated key of the remote control, refer to page 28, and remove it.

4. Insert the releasing tool into the opening, arrow 3.

5. Turn the releasing tool as far as possible, arrow 4, and then press downward and leave it in. The transmission lock is released.

Engage the transmission lock after park- ing the vehicle at its destination. Other-

wise there is a danger of the vehicle rolling.<

C o

n tr

o ls

73

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Locking

1. Pull out the releasing tool. The transmission lock is engaged again.

2. If necessary, insert the lock* and lock it.

3. Close the cover in the bottom of the cup holder and lay in the mat again.

4. Close the cover of the cup holder and stow the releasing tool.

Information on jump starting and towing, from page 280.

Turn signals/headlamp flasher/high beams

1 High beams

2 Headlamp flasher

3 Turn signals

Using turn signals Press the lever beyond the resistance point.

To switch off manually, press the lever up to the resistance point.

Atypically rapid flashing of the indicator lamp indicates that a turn signal bulb

needs to be replaced.<

Signaling briefly Press lever to resistance point and hold for as long as you wish to signal.

Triple turn signal activation Press the lever up to the resistance point. The turn signal flashes three times.

You can activate or deactivate this function.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Lighting" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Triple turn signal" and press the controller.

Triple turn signaling is activated.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

D ri

vi n

g

74

Washer/wiper system

1 Switching on wipers

2 Switching off wipers or brief wipe

3 Activating/deactivating intermittent wipe or rain sensor*

4 Cleaning windshield and headlamps* 5 Setting interval for intermittent wipe or sen-

sitivity of the rain sensor*

Switching on wipers Pull the lever upward, arrow 1.

The lever automatically returns to its initial posi- tion when released.

Normal wiper speed Press once. The system reverts to operation in the intermit- tent mode with the vehicle stationary.

Fast wiper speed Press twice or press beyond the resistance point. The system reverts to normal speed with the vehicle stationary.

Intermittent operation or rain sensor* With the rain sensor, the wiper operation is con- trolled automatically as a function of the rain intensity. The rain sensor is located on the windshield, directly in front of the interior rear- view mirror.

Activating intermittent operation or rain sensor

Press the button, arrow 3. The LED in the but- ton lights up.

Setting interval for intermittent wipe or sensitivity of the rain sensor Turn the serrated dial 5.

Deactivating intermittent operation or rain sensor Press the button again, arrow 3. The LED goes out.

Deactivate the rain sensor when passing through an automatic car wash. Failure to

do so could result in damage caused by undes- ired wiper activation.<

Cleaning windshield and headlamps* Pull the lever, arrow 4.

The system sprays washer fluid against the windshield and activates the wipers for a brief period.

When the vehicle lighting system is switched on, the headlamps are also cleaned at regular and appropriate intervals.

Do not use the washers if there is any danger that the fluid will freeze on the

windshield. If you do so, your vision could be obscured. To avoid freezing, use a washer fluid antifreeze, refer to Washer fluid. Do not use washing mechanisms when the washer fluid reservoir is empty, otherwise you will damage the washer pump.<

C o

n tr

o ls

75

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Windshield washer nozzles Both windshield washer nozzles are automati- cally heated with the engine running or the igni- tion switched on.

BMW X5: rear window wiper

1 Intermittent mode. When reverse gear is engaged, continuous operation is switched on automatically

2 Cleaning the rear window

Do not use washing mechanisms when the washer fluid reservoir is empty, other-

wise you will damage the washer pump.<

Washer fluid Washer fluid antifreeze is flammable. For this reason, keep it away from ignition

sources and store only in the closed original container out of reach of children. Otherwise, there is the danger of bodily injury. Always observe the instructions for use provided on the containers.<

Filler neck for washer fluid Only add washer fluid with the engine cooled down to exclude contact with hot

engine components. Otherwise there is a dan- ger of fire and to personal safety if the fluid is spilled.<

All washer nozzles are supplied from one reser- voir.

Fill with water and if required with a washer antifreeze, according to manufacturer's recom- mendations.

In order to maintain the mixture ratio, mix the washer fluid before filling.<

Capacity Approx. 6.3 US quarts/6 liters.

Cruise control*

The concept The cruise control with a braking function is available for use at speeds of approx. 20 mph/ 30 km/h and higher. The vehicle stores and maintains the speed that you set using the lever mounted on the steering column. To keep the specified speed constant, the system brakes if the engine braking effect is not sufficient on a downhill grade.

Do not use the cruise control under driv- ing conditions that do not permit a con-

stant speed, e.g. when driving on winding roads, in heavy traffic or in poor road conditions such as snow, rain, ice, and loose road surface. Otherwise you could lose control of the vehicle and cause an accident.<

D ri

vi n

g

76

One lever for all functions

1 Storing speed and maintaining or increas- ing

2 Storing speed and maintaining or decreas- ing

3 Deactivating cruise control

4 Resuming stored speed

Maintaining current speed Briefly press, arrow 1, or briefly pull, arrow 2 lever.

The speed currently being driven is stored and maintained. It is indicated on the speedometer and briefly in the instrument panel.

The controlled speed can drop on uphill grades if the engine output is insufficient. If the engine braking effect is not sufficient on a downhill grade, the system lightly brakes the vehicle.

Increasing speed Repeatedly press the lever up to or beyond the resistance point, arrow 1, until the desired speed is set.

> Each time the lever is pressed to the resis- tance point, the speed is increased by approx. 1 mph or 1 km/h.

> Each time the lever is pressed beyond the resistance point, the desired speed increases by a maximum of 5 mph or 10 km/h.

The system stores the setting and maintains the set speed.

Accelerating with lever Accelerate slightly:

Press the lever up to the resistance point, arrow 1, until the desired speed is reached.

Accelerate more rapidly:

Press the lever beyond the resistance point, arrow 1, until the desired speed is reached.

The vehicle accelerates without pressure on the accelerator pedal. The system stores the setting and maintains the set speed.

Reducing speed Repeatedly pull the lever up to the resistance point or beyond, arrow 2, until the desired speed is displayed.

> Each time the lever is pulled up to the resis- tance point, the desired speed decreases by approx. 1 mph or 1 km/h.

> Each time the lever is pulled beyond the resistance point, the desired speed is decreased by a maximum of 5 mph or 10 km/h until the minimum speed of 20 mph or 30 km/h is reached.

The system stores the setting and maintains the set speed.

Deactivating cruise control Briefly press the lever up or down, arrow 3. The displays in the speedometer go out.

In addition, the system is automatically deacti- vated:

> when braking

> when transmission position N is engaged

> when DTC is activated or DSC is deacti- vated

> when HDC is activated

> when the parking brake is set

> when driving stability control systems inter- vene

C o

n tr

o ls

77

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Accelerating does not deactivate the cruise control. After releasing the accelerator pedal, the stored speed is reached and maintained again.

Warning lamp The warning lamp lights up if the cruise control has been deactivated automatically, e.g. by a control inter-

vention of the DSC. A message appears on the Control Display.

Resuming stored speed Briefly press the button, arrow 4. The stored speed is resumed and maintained.

With the ignition switched off, the stored speed value is deleted and cannot be resumed again.

Displays in instrument panel

1 Stored desired speed

2 Selected desired speed appears briefly

If --- mph or --- km/h temporarily appears in the instrument panel display, it is possi-

ble that the system prerequisites for operation are currently not met.<

Malfunction The warning lamp lights up if the sys- tem has failed. A message appears on the Control Display. Detailed informa-

tion is provided from page 85.

E ve

ry th

in g

u n

d er

c o

n tr

o l

78

Everything under control

Odometer, outside temperature display, clock

1 Knob in the instrument panel

2 Time, outside temperature, and date

3 Odometer and trip odometer

Knob in the instrument panel > With ignition switched on

Press knob: Resetting trip odometer

Press the knob for approx. 5 seconds: Displaying service requirements, refer to page 82

> With ignition switched off

Press knob: Briefly displaying time, outside temperature and odometer

Units of measure To select the respective units of measure, miles or km for the odometer as well as 7 or 6 for the outside temperature, refer to page 89.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Time, date, outside temperature From radio readiness the outside temperature and the time are displayed.

Setting the time, refer to page 88.

Retrieving date

Press the button on turn signal lever upward; the date appears.

To set the date, refer to page 89.

Pressing the button upward or downward sev- eral times changes the display between clock, outside temperature, date, and Check Control messages, refer to page 86.

Outside temperature warning If the display drops to +377/+36, a signal sounds and a warning lamp lights up. A mes- sage appears on the Control Display. There is an increased danger of ice.

Even at temperatures above +377/ +36 ice can form. Therefore, drive care-

fully, e.g. on bridges and sections of road in the shade, otherwise there is an increased accident risk.<

Odometer and trip odometer Resetting trip odometer: Press knob 1 in the instrument panel with the ignition switched on.

When vehicle is parked To briefly display the time, outside temperature and mileage after the remote control has been removed from the ignition lock: Press knob 1 in the instrument panel.

C o

n tr

o ls

79

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Tachometer

Do not operate the engine with the needle in the red overspeed zone of the gauge, refer to arrow. At high revs in this range, the flow of fuel is interrupted to protect the engine.

Coolant temperature Should the coolant, and with it the engine become too hot, a warning lamp lights up. In addition, a message appears on the Control Display.

Checking coolant level, refer to page 262.

Engine oil temperature*

When the engine is at operating temperature, the engine oil temperature is between approx. 1707/806 and approx. 2507/1206.

When the engine oil temperature is too high, a warning lamp lights up in the instrument panel.

Energy control*

Displays the current fuel consumption. This allows you to see whether your current driving style is conducive to fuel economy with mini- mum exhaust emissions.

E ve

ry th

in g

u n

d er

c o

n tr

o l

80

Fuel gauge

Fuel tank capacity: approx. 22.5 US gal/ 85 liters. You will find information on refueling on page 244.

If the tilt of the vehicle varies for a longer period, when you are driving in mountainous areas, for example, the indicator may fluctuate slightly.

Reserve After the reserve quantity has been reached, a message briefly appears on the Control Display; the remaining range is shown in the computer. Below a range of approx. 30 miles/50 km, the message remains on the Control Display.

Refuel as soon as possible once your cruising range falls below 30 miles/

50 km, otherwise engine functions are not ensured and damage can occur.<

Computer

Displays in instrument panel

To display the information, press the BC button on the turn signal lever.

The following information is displayed:

> Cruising range

> Average speed

> Average fuel consumption

> BMW X6: Dynamic Performance Control, refer to page 97

Cruising range Displays the estimated cruising range available with the remaining fuel. The range is projected based on the driving style over the last 20 miles/ 30 km.

Refuel as soon as possible once your cruising range falls below 30 miles/

50 km, otherwise engine functions are not ensured and damage can occur.<

Average speed Periods with the vehicle parked and the engine stopped are not included in the calculations of average speed.

To reset average speed: press the BC button on the turn signal lever for approx. 2 seconds.

Average fuel consumption The average fuel consumption is calculated for the time during which the engine is running.

To reset average fuel consumption: Press the BC button on the turn signal lever for approx. 2 seconds.

For different routes You can display the average speed and average consumption for two different routes on the Control Display, refer to the following and to Trip computer*.

Displays on Control Display You can also call up the computer via iDrive. For operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller to the right to open "Navigation".

C o

n tr

o ls

81

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Without navigation system*: Open "Car Data".

3. Select "Car Data" and press the controller.

4. Select "Onboard info" and press the con- troller.

> Estimated time of arrival at destination and remaining distance:

> Entering a distance manually in the com- puter, see below.

> Entering a destination in the navigation system*, refer to page 150.

> Cruising range

> Average speed

> Average fuel consumption

Resetting values You can reset the values for the average speed and average fuel consumption:

1. Select the respective menu item and press the controller.

2. To confirm your selection, press the con- troller again.

Entering a distance manually 1. Select "Distance to dest. " and press the

controller.

2. Turn the controller to select the distance to your destination.

3. Press the controller to apply the setting.

The distance is automatically preset during the destination guidance of the navigation sys- tem*.

Trip computer* The trip computer is suitable, for example, for a vacation trip.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Open "Navigation". Without navigation system*: Open "Car Data".

3. Select "Car Data" and press the controller.

4. Select "Trip computer" and press the con- troller.

> Departure time

> Driving time

> Distance traveled

> Average speed

> Average fuel consumption

E ve

ry th

in g

u n

d er

c o

n tr

o l

82

Starting or stopping the trip computer, or reset- ting all values:

1. Select "Set" and press the controller.

2. Select the desired menu item.

3. Press the controller.

Display options You can display the computer or the trip com- puter in the assistance window.

1. Move the controller to the right to change to the assistance window and press the con- troller.

2. Select "Onboard info" or "Trip computer".

3. Press the controller.

Service requirements

The remaining driving distance and the date for the next maintenance are displayed briefly with the ignition switched on.

To determine the extent of maintenance required, you can also display the remaining distance or the service date individually in the instrument panel.

1. With the ignition switched on, press the knob in the instrument panel, refer to page 78, for approx. 5 seconds until the service requirements are displayed.

2. Press the knob repeatedly to display the individual service requirement items.

C o

n tr

o ls

83

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Displaying service requirements

1 Knob for selecting display

2 Service requirements

3 Engine oil

4 Legally mandated inspections* 5 Front brake pads

6 Rear brake pads

7 Brake fluid

The sequence of the displayed maintenance items can vary. First the data for the next main- tenance are displayed.

Additional information You can select a display of more detailed infor- mation on the maintenance scope on the Con- trol Display. For operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Info sources" and press the control- ler.

4. Select "Service Info" and press the control- ler.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Service requirements" is selected and press the controller.

E ve

ry th

in g

u n

d er

c o

n tr

o l

84

6. Select "Status" and press the controller.

The display shows a list of selected service and maintenance procedures, as well as legally mandated inspections.

You can request more detailed information on every entry.

Select the entry and press the controller.

To exit from the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

Symbols No service is currently required.

The deadline for service or a legally man- dated inspection is approaching. Please

arrange a service appointment.

The service deadline has already passed.

Entering deadlines for legally mandated inspections* Make sure the date on the Control Display is set correctly, refer to page 89; otherwise, the effec- tiveness of CBS Condition Based Service is not ensured.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Info sources" and press the control- ler.

4. Select "Service Info" and press the control- ler.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Service requirements" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Status" and press the controller.

7. Select "State inspection" and press the controller.

8. Select "Set service date" and press the controller. The month is highlighted.

9. Turn the controller to make the adjustment.

10. Press the controller to apply the setting. The year is highlighted.

11. Turn the controller to make the adjustment.

12. Press the controller to apply the setting. The date entry is stored.

To exit from the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

C o

n tr

o ls

85

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Check Control

The concept The Check Control monitors functions in the vehicle and issues a message if there is a mal- function in the monitored systems. This kind of Check Control message consists of indicator and warning lamps in the instrument cluster, and if necessary an acoustic signal and text messages at the bottom of the Control Display.

Indicator and warning lamps

The indicator and warning lamps can light up in different combinations and colors.

means that a Check Control message has been generated. The symbol continues to be visible even when the Check Control message disappears after a short time. The warning lamps and text messages are stored and can be displayed later, also refer to page 86.

Explanatory text messages

Text messages at the bottom edge of the Con- trol Display explain the meaning of the dis- played indicator and warning lamps.

You can display additional information on most Check Control messages later, e.g. on the cause of the malfunction and on corresponding need for action, see below.

In the case of corresponding urgency, this infor- mation is displayed immediately when the related lamp lights up.

Exit the displayed information: Select the arrow and press the controller.

Hiding Check Control messages

Press the button in the turn signal lever up or down.

E ve

ry th

in g

u n

d er

c o

n tr

o l

86

Some Check Control messages are displayed until the malfunctions have been rectified. They cannot be hidden. If a number of malfunctions occur simultaneously, they are displayed in succession.

Other messages are automatically hidden after approx. 20 seconds, but remain stored.

Displaying stored Check Control messages

1. Press the button on the turn signal lever downward. "CHECK OK" or the stored Check Control messages appear in the dis- play. "CHECK OK" is shown if no messages are present. Check Control messages are accompanied by text messages on the Control Display.

2. Press the button to display additional mes- sages, the time and outside temperature, or the date.

Displaying additional information later iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Info sources" and press the control- ler.

4. Select "Service Info" and press the control- ler.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Check Control messages" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select a text message and press the con- troller.

To exit the display: Select the arrow and press the controller.

Indication of malfunction urgency

Depending on your vehicle's equipment, the stored Check Control messages are also dis- played with the following symbols:

No malfunctions are present in the moni- tored systems.

Malfunctions are present in the moni- tored systems. Depending on the mal- function, supplementary information is shown on the Control Display.

The symbols also indicate the status of the ser- vice requirements display, refer to page 84.

C o

n tr

o ls

87

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Speed limit You can enter a speed and a Check Control message indicates when you have reached this speed. This enables you, for example, to receive warnings if you exceed a speed limit in an urban area. You are only warned of reaching this speed a second time if your vehicle speed falls below it again by at least 3 mph/5 km/h.

Displaying, setting or changing limit iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Open "Navigation". Without navigation system*: Open "Car Data".

3. Select "Car Data" and press the controller.

4. Select "Limit" and press the controller.

5. Select the speed value and press the con- troller.

6. Turn the controller to set the limit.

7. Press the controller to apply the setting. The limit is automatically activated.

Applying your current speed as limit Select "Select current speed" and press the controller. The system applies your current speed as the limit.

Activating limit Select "On" and press the controller.

Limit is automatically activated.

Stopwatch iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Open "Navigation". Without navigation system*: Open "Car Data".

3. Select "Car Data" and press the controller.

4. Select "Stopwatch" and press the control- ler.

Starting, stopping or resetting > Select "Start" and press the controller.

The stopwatch starts at the displayed time.

> Select "Reset" and press the controller. The stopwatch is reset and it restarts if it was running beforehand.

> Select "Stop" and press the controller. This stops the timer.

Taking an intermediate time reading Select "Interim time" and press the controller. The interim time appears below the ongoing primary stopwatch count.

All of the remaining functions remain available at all times while the stopwatch

is running. The stopwatch continues operation in the background.<

E ve

ry th

in g

u n

d er

c o

n tr

o l

88

Settings on Control Display iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button once or twice until the start menu appears.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

Setting time 1. Turn the controller until "Time / Date" is

selected and press the controller.

2. Move the controller once to the front if nec- essary to change to the first field from the top.

3. Turn the controller until "Time" is selected and press the controller.

4. Turn the controller until "Set time" is selected and press the controller.

Making settings 1. Turn the controller to set the hours and

press the controller.

2. Turn the controller to set the minutes and press the controller.

The changed time is stored.

Switching on hour signal* You will hear tones just before each full hour.

Select "Hour memo" and press the controller. The hour signal is activated.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

C o

n tr

o ls

89

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Setting time format 1. Select "Time format" and press the control-

ler.

2. Select the desired format and press the controller.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Setting date 1. Select "Date" and press the controller.

2. Select "Set date" and press the control- ler.The first section of the date display is highlighted, in this case the month.

3. Turn the controller to make the adjustment.

4. Press the controller to apply the setting. The next setting is highlighted.

5. Make the remaining adjustments. After the last adjustment, the date is stored.

Changing date format 1. Select "Date format" and press the control-

ler.

2. Select the desired format and press the controller.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Brightness of Control Display The brightness is automatically adapted to the ambient lighting conditions. However, you can change the basic setting.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Display settings" and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Brightness" is selected and press the controller.

6. If necessary, move the controller to the right to select "Display".

7. Turn the controller until the desired setting is selected.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Units of measure You can change the units of measure for con- sumption, distances, temperature and pres- sure.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Language / Units" and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Units" is selected and press the controller.

E ve

ry th

in g

u n

d er

c o

n tr

o l

90

6. Select the menu item to be set and press the controller.

7. Select the desired unit of measure and press the controller.

The settings are stored for the remote control currently in use.

Language on Control Display iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Language / Units" and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Languages" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Text language" and press the con- troller. You can change the language of the text displays.

7. Select and activate the desired language by pressing the controller.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Volume of warning tones* On vehicles equipped with a single drive, you can increase or decrease the volume of the warning tones, e.g. for the safety belt reminder, compared to the entertainment sound output. The warning tones have a specified minimum and maximum volume that cannot be dropped below or exceeded.

1. Select "Tone / Volume" and press the con- troller.

2. Select "Volume settings" and press the controller.

3. Change to the second field from the top if necessary. Select "Warning tones" and press the controller.

4. If necessary, change to the right-hand field and turn the controller. The setting is applied.

C o

n tr

o ls

91

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Technology for comfort, convenience and safety

PDC Park Distance Control*

The concept The PDC assists you when you are parking. Acoustic signals and an optical displaysalert you to the approach of an object in front of* or behind your vehicle. To measure the distance, there are four ultrasonic sensors in each bumper. The range of these sensors is approx. 7 ft/2 m. But an acoustic warning only sounds at approx. 24 in/60 cm for the sensors at the front* and at the two rear corners and at approx. 5 ft/1,50 m for the middle sensors at the rear.

PDC is a parking aid that can indicate objects when they are approached

slowly, as is usually the case when parking. Avoid approaching an object at high speed, oth- erwise the physical circumstances would mean that the system warning was too late.<

Automatic activation Whenever the engine is running or the ignition is on, each time you move the selector lever into position R, the PDC system is activated after approx. 1 second.

Wait this short period before driving off.

Manual activation

Press the button, the LED lights up.

Manual deactivation Press the button again; the LED goes out.

Automatic deactivation After driving approx. 165 ft/50 m or at over approx. 20 mph/30 km/h, the system is switched off and the LED goes out. You can reactivate the system manually as needed.

Signal tones When nearing an object, the position is corre- spondingly indicated by an interval tone. Thus, an object detected to the left rear of the vehicle will be indicated by a signal tone from the left rear speaker, etc. As the distance between vehicle and object decreases, the intervals between the tones become shorter. If the dis- tance to the nearest object falls to below roughly 1 ft/30 cm, then a continuous tone sounds.

An intermittent tone is interrupted after approx. 3 seconds:

> if you remain in front of an object that was only detected by one of the corner sensors

> if you drive parallel to a wall

Adjusting You can adjust the volume of the warning tones if the vehicle is equipped with a single drive, refer to page 90.

Malfunction The LED in the button flashes and a message appears on the Control Display. PDC is mal- functioning. Have the system checked.

To prevent this problem, keep the sensors clean and free of ice or snow in order to ensure that they will continue to operate effectively. Do not spray the sensors with high-pressure clean- ers for long periods and maintain a distance of at least 4 in/10 cm to them.

T ec

h n

o lo

g y

fo r c

o m

fo rt

, c o

n ve

n ie

n ce

a n

d s

af et

y

92

PDC with visual warning You can also have the system show distances to objects on the Control Display. Objects that are farther away are already shown there before a signal tone sounds. The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

If the vehicle is equipped with a rear view cam- era, refer to Displays on page 95.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Maneuvering aids" is selected and press the controller.

6. Turn the controller until "View selection" is selected and press the controller.

7. Select "PDC in main window only" and press the controller.

The PDC screen is activated.

The display appears on the Control Display as soon as PDC is activated.

System limits Even with PDC, final responsibility for estimating the distance between the

vehicle and any obstructions always remains with the driver. Even when sensors are pro- vided, there is a blind spot in which objects can no longer be detected. The system's detection of objects is also subject to the physical limits that apply to all forms of ultrasonic measure- ment, such as those encountered with tow bars and trailer couplings, thin or wedge-shaped objects etc. Low objects already displayed, e.g. the curb, can also disappear from the detection area of the sensors again before or after a con- tinuous tone already sounds. Higher, protrud- ing objects, e.g. ledges, cannot be detected. For this reason, drive with care; otherwise, there is a danger of personal injury or property dam- age. Loud sources of sound, inside and outside the vehicle, could drown out the PDC signal tone.<

C o

n tr

o ls

93

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Rear view camera*

The concept The rear view camera in the liftgate displays the area behind your vehicle on the Control Display.

Also check the traffic situation around the vehicle during parking and maneuvering

with direct vision, as otherwise danger of an accident could result, for example, from road users or objects located outside the picture area of the rear view camera.<

Switching on

Automatically With the engine running, shift into reverse.

If the image of the PDC Park Distance Control appears on the Control Display,

you can switch the image to the rear view cam- era, refer to Displays on page 95.<

Manually

Press the button. PDC is activated at the same time, refer to page 91.

If the image of the PDC Park Distance Control appears on the Control Display,

you can switch the image to the rear view cam- era, refer to Displays on page 95.<

Switching off

Automatically When driving forward at over approx. 12 mph/ 20 km/h or after driving approx. 164 ft/50 m.

Manually Press the button again; the LED goes out.

Driver assistance functions The following functions can improve the effect of the rear view camera depending on the situa- tion.

They can only be activated when the liftgate is completely closed.

Pathway lines The pathway lines are shown in the picture of the rear view camera. They help you to estimate the space required when parking and maneu- vering on level roads.

The pathway lines are dependent on the current steering angle and are continuously adjusted to the steering wheel movements.

Turning lines The static turning lines are displayed in the pic- ture of the rear view camera and show you the course of the smallest possible turning circle on level roads.

T ec

h n

o lo

g y

fo r c

o m

fo rt

, c o

n ve

n ie

n ce

a n

d s

af et

y

94

Parking using pathway and turning circle lines 1. Position the vehicle so that the turning lines

guide within the limits of the parking space.

2. Turn the steering wheel so that the pathway lines cover the corresponding turning lines.

This results in a steering wheel position that makes full use of the smallest possible turning circle of the vehicle when parking.

Virtual camera panning The displayed picture area is dependent on the current speed: At low speeds, the camera view is panned toward the street, and at higher speeds toward the horizon. This enables the currently relevant picture area to be shown enlarged on the Control Display.

To activate the virtual camera panning, select the camera view "Camera view: full screen", refer to Displays on page 95.

Obstacle marking Spatially shaped markings are shown in the pic- ture of the rear view camera. Their stepped col- ors correspond to the markings of the Park Dis- tance Control and support you in estimating the distance to the object shown.

The obstacle marking is deactivated when driv- ing in reverse from approx. 12 mph/20 km/h.

Activating driver assistance functions The driver assistance functions can be active at the same time. The zoom function for trailer towing can only be activated individually with the rear view camera switched on.

With rear view camera switched on iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the controller.

2. Select the desired function and press the controller.

You can also adjust the brightness of the cam- era view.

With rear view camera switched off 1. Press the button.

This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Maneuvering aids" is selected and press the controller.

C o

n tr

o ls

95

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

6. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

7. Select the desired functions and press the controller.

The settings are stored for the remote control currently in use.

Displays on Control Display You can have the picture from the rear view camera displayed in several formats and in combination with the PDC Park Distance Con- trol, refer to page 92. In addition, you also have the option of display- ing only the PDC Park Distance Control.

> "Camera picture and PDC" The rear view camera picture is shown in the main window of the Control Display.

> "Camera view: full screen" The picture of the rear view camera is shown on the entire Control Display.

> "Camera view: main window" The picture of the rear view camera is shown in the main window of the Control Display.

> "PDC in main window only" PDC is shown in the main window of the Control Display.

Selecting displays 1. Select "Maneuvering aids" and press the

controller, refer to Activating driver assis- tance functions.

2. Turn the controller until "View selection" is selected and press the controller.

3. Select the desired display and press the controller.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

The picture of the rear view camera and PDC is hidden when the vehicle is

stopped, the transmission is in R or D, and you disconnect the driver's safety belt and open the driver's door.<

Setting brightness You can set the brightness of the camera view with the rear view camera switched on.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the controller.

2. Turn the controller until "Brightness" is selected and press the controller.

3. Set the desired brightness.

T ec

h n

o lo

g y

fo r c

o m

fo rt

, c o

n ve

n ie

n ce

a n

d s

af et

y

96

Cleaning rear view camera

The lens of the rear view camera is located on the liftgate.

The picture quality of the rear view camera may be impaired by dirt. Clean the lens with a moist, nonabrasive cloth.

The lens is automatically heated in case of frost.

Driving stability control systems Your BMW is equipped with an extended array of systems designed to enhance and maintain vehicle stability under extreme conditions.

ABS Antilock Brake System ABS prevents locking of the wheels during braking. Safe steering response is maintained even during full braking. Active safety is thus increased.

ABS is operational every time you start the engine. Braking safely, refer to page 140.

CBC Cornering Brake Control When braking during curves or when braking during a lane change, driving stability and steer- ing response are improved further.

Electronic brake-force distribution The system controls the brake pressure in the rear wheels to ensure stable braking behavior.

Brake assistant When you apply the brakes rapidly, this system automatically produces the maximum braking force boost and thus helps to achieve the short-

est possible braking distance during full brak- ing. This system exploits all of the benefits pro- vided by ABS.

Do not reduce the pressure on the brake pedal for the duration of the full braking.

DSC Dynamic Stability Control DSC prevents traction loss in the driving wheels when starting off and accelerating. The system also identifies unstable driving conditions, such as a loss of traction at the rear of the vehicle or sliding of the vehicle in its front wheels. In these cases, DSC helps the vehicle maintain a safe course within physical limits by reducing engine output and through braking actions in the indi- vidual wheels.

The laws of physics cannot be repealed, even with DSC. An appropriate driving

style remains the responsibility of the driver. Therefore, do not restrict the additional safety margin with a risky driving style, as otherwise there is a risk of an accident.<

Deactivating DSC

Press the button until the DSC indicator lamp in the instrument panel lights up, but not longer than approx. 10 seconds. DTC Dynamic Trac- tion Control and DSC are deactivated together. Stabilizing interventions are now not carried out.

A message appears on the Control Display. Please note any supplementary information that appears there.

To increase vehicle stability, activate DSC again as soon as possible.

C o

n tr

o ls

97

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Activating DSC Press the button; the indicator lamp in the instrument panel goes out.

For better control The indicator lamp flashes: DSC controls the drive forces and brake forces.

The indicator lamps light up: DSC is deactivated.

DTC Dynamic Traction Control DTC is a version of DSC in which the drive out- put is optimized for particular road conditions, e.g. unplowed snow-covered roads. The sys- tem assures the maximal drive output, but with reduced driving stability. It is therefore neces- sary to drive with appropriate caution.

You may find it useful to briefly activate DTC under the following special circumstances:

> When driving in sand, on snowy inclines, in slush or on unplowed, snow-covered road surfaces

> When rocking a stuck vehicle free or start- ing off in deep snow, sand or on loose ground

> When driving with snow chains*

Activating DTC

Press the button briefly; the DTC indicator lamp in the instrument panel lights up.

For better control The indicator lamp flashes: DTC controls the drive forces and brake forces.

The indicator lamps light up: DTC is activated.

Deactivating DTC Press the button again; the DTC indicator lamp in the instrument panel goes out.

xDrive xDrive is the 4-wheel drive system of your BMW. The combined effects of xDrive and DSC further optimize the traction and dynamic driv- ing characteristics. The 4-wheel drive system xDrive variably distributes the drive forces to the front and rear axle depending on the driving situation and prevailing road conditions.

BMW X6: Dynamic Performance Control

The concept Dynamic Performance Control optimizes the handling characteristics of your BMW when starting off, cornering, and during evasive maneuvers. To achieve this, the system variably distributes the drive torque of the rear axle to the two rear wheels. This further increases the steering precision and tracking stability of your vehicle.

Display The instrument panel display shows how xDrive and Dynamic Performance Control are distrib- uting the drive torque.

T ec

h n

o lo

g y

fo r c

o m

fo rt

, c o

n ve

n ie

n ce

a n

d s

af et

y

98

Press the BC button on the turn signal lever repeatedly until the display appears, refer to arrow.

The drive train and wheels are schematically depicted. Bar graphs show the current distribution of drive torque. The longer an illuminated bar is, the greater the drive torque in the related wheel.

Malfunction If xDrive and Dynamic Performance Control are malfunctioning, the instrument panel display appears in gray.

HDC Hill Descent Control

The concept HDC is a system for driving downhill in steep terrain. This system reduces vehicle speed on steep downhill gradients, thus allowing you to maintain even better control of your BMW under these conditions. The vehicle moves at approximately walking speed without active intervention from the driver.

HDC is available for activation at vehicle speeds below approx. 22 mph/35 km/h. When driving down steep hills with a speed below approx. 22 mph/35 km/h, the vehicle reduces speed automatically down to approximately walking speed, approx. 5 mph/8 km/h, and then main- tains this speed at a constant.

Only use HDC in transmission positions D or R.

Increasing or reducing speed You can use the accelerator or brakes to vary this automatically controlled speed within a range extending from approx. 4 mph/6 km/h to

15 mph/25 km/h. You can specify a target speed within the same range by using the lever of the cruise control.

With downhill grade over 10 you can reduce the speed to approx. 3 mph/4 km/h. Pull the lever of the cruise control beyond the resis- tance point, arrow 3.

1 Increasing speed

2 Pull to the resistance point: Reduce speed to approx. 4 mph/6 km/h

3 Pull beyond the resistance point: With downhill grade over 10, reduce speed to approx. 3 mph/4 km/h.

Activating HDC

Press the button; the LED lights up. The HDC display is shown in the instrument panel.

The LED flashes when the brakes are applied automatically.

Deactivating HDC Press the button again. The LED and the HDC display go out.

HDC is automatically deactivated at speeds over approx. 37 mph/60 km/h.

C o

n tr

o ls

99

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Displays* in instrument panel

1 Display for target speed

2 HDC display

Malfunction HDC is temporarily unavailable in the following situations due to a high brake temperature:

> The LED in the button and the display HDC go out during HDC operation.

> The LED in the button and the HDC display do not light up when the button is pressed.

Malfunction of driving stability control systems

When driving on poor roads, avoid using full throttle or pressing the accelerator

beyond the kick-down point and also avoid heavy braking. Otherwise, the drive train may be damaged or accidents can occur.<

Adaptive Drive*

The concept Adaptive Drive reduces the body roll which occurs when cornering quickly or during fast evasive maneuvers. In addition, Adaptive Drive reduces the steering angle requirement, improves the running comfort and increases the dynamic driving characteristics of your BMW.

Chassis and suspension tuning You can choose between two types of chassis and suspension tuning.

> Normal: The comfortable basic setting offers opti- mum comfort when traveling.

> Sport: The sporty basic setting offers increased driving agility.

Selecting chassis and suspension tuning

Press the button. The system switches between the two chassis and suspension tuning settings.

> Sport: The LED in the button lights up and SPORT is displayed in the instrument panel.

> Normal: The LED in the button goes out.

The selection of the chassis and suspension tuning setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.

Starting assistant The starting assistant enables you to start off conveniently on slopes. The parking brake is not required for this purpose.

1. Hold the vehicle with the footbrake.

2. Release the footbrake and immediately drive off quickly.

The starting assistant holds the vehicle for approx. 2 seconds after releasing the

footbrake. Depending on the load, the vehicle may also roll back slightly during this time. After releasing the footbrake, immediately start quickly, otherwise the starting assistant no

T ec

h n

o lo

g y

fo r c

o m

fo rt

, c o

n ve

n ie

n ce

a n

d s

af et

y

100

longer holds the vehicle after approx. 2 seconds and it begins to roll back.<

Self-leveling suspension*

Malfunction The warning lamp for self-leveling suspension lights up yellow and a message is shown on the Control

Display. A malfunction has occurred in the self- leveling suspension. Stop and check the vehi- cle. If it is considerably lower at the rear than at the front, and possibly also on one side rear left compared to rear right , proceed to the nearest BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained personnel. Drive with appropriate caution in the meantime. The vehicle has reduced ground clearance and driving comfort may be notice- ably reduced. Even if the orientation of the vehi- cle is normal, when a malfunction is indicated on the display, you should proceed to the near- est BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center or a workshop that works according to BMW guide- lines and uses appropriately trained personnel.

FTM Flat Tire Monitor*

The concept The Flat Tire Monitor detects a pressure loss in one tire by comparing the speeds of the individ- ual wheels during driving.

In the event of a pressure loss, there is a change in the rolling circumference and therefore the rotation speed of the corresponding wheel. The system detects this change and reports it as a flat tire.

Function requirements In order to assure the reliable reporting of a flat tire, the system must be initialized for the cor- rect tire inflation pressure.

The initialization must be repeated after each time the tire inflation pressure is cor-

rected and after every tire or wheel change.<

System limits The Flat Tire Monitor cannot indicate sudden severe tire damage caused by

outside factors and does not detect a natural, even pressure drop in all four tires.<

In the following situations, the system could be delayed or malfunction:

> System has not been initialized

> Driving on snowy or slippery road surface

> Sporty driving style: slip in the drive wheels, high lateral acceleration

> Driving with snow chains* When you are driving with the compact wheel* the Flat Tire Monitor is unable to function.

Initializing system The initialization finishes during driving, which can be interrupted at any time.

When driving resumes, the initialization is con- tinued automatically. Do not initialize the sys- tem when driving with snow chains* or with the compact wheel*.<

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

C o

n tr

o ls

101

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "FTM" is selected and press the controller.

6. Start the engine, but do not start driving.

7. Select "Reset" and press the controller.

8. Select "Yes" and press the controller. The message "resetting FTM " is displayed.

9. Start to drive.

The initialization finishes during driving.

Indication of a flat tire The warning lamp lights up red. A message appears on the Control Dis- play. In addition, an acoustic signal

sounds. There is a flat tire or extensive inflation pressure loss.

If you have deactivated DSC, it will be activated automatically.

1. Cautiously reduce speed to below 50 mph/ 80 km/h. Avoid sudden braking and steer- ing maneuvers. Do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h. In case of further air loss of the defective wheel, its position will be indicated to you on the Control Display.

If the vehicle is not equipped with run- flat tires as provided at the factory,

refer to page 256, do not continue driving. Continuing to drive with a flat tire could cause severe accidents.<

2. At the next opportunity, check the air pres- sure in all four tires.

If the tire inflation pressure in all four tires is correct, the Flat Tire Monitor

may not have been initialized. The system must then be initialized.<

3. In the event of complete tire pressure loss, 0 psi/0 kPa, you can estimate the possible distance for continued driving on the basis of the following guide values:

> With a light load: 1 to 2 persons without luggage: approx. 155 miles/250 km

> With a medium load: 2 persons, cargo bay full, or 4 persons without luggage: approx. 95 miles/150 km

> With a full load: 4 or more persons, cargo bay full: approx. 30 miles/50 km

Drive cautiously and do not exceed speeds of 50 mph/80 km/h or else you

run the risk of causing an accident. In the event of pressure loss, vehicle handling changes. This includes reduced tracking stability in braking, extended braking distance and altered natural steering characteristics. If unusual vibrations or loud noises occur while the vehicle is being driven, this can indicate final failure of the damaged tire. Reduce speed and stop at a suitable location as soon as possible, otherwise pieces of the tire could become detached and cause an accident. Do not con- tinue driving, but instead contact the BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center.<

TPM Tire Pressure Monitor*

The concept TPM checks the tire inflation pressure in the four mounted tires. The system reports when

T ec

h n

o lo

g y

fo r c

o m

fo rt

, c o

n ve

n ie

n ce

a n

d s

af et

y

102

the tire inflation pressure has dropped consid- erably in one or several tires.

Function requirements In order to assure the reliable reporting of a flat tire, the system must have been reset with the correct tire inflation pressure.

Always use wheels with TPM electronics, oth- erwise fault-free operation of the system is not ensured.

Reset the system again after each correc- tion of the tire inflation pressure and after

every tire or wheel change.<

System limits TPM cannot announce sudden serious tire damage caused by external influ-

ences.<

The system does not function properly if it has not been reset, e.g. a flat tire is reported despite correct tire inflation pressures.

The system is inactive and cannot display a flat tire if a wheel has been mounted without TPM electronics, e.g. a compact wheel*, or if TPM is temporarily interfered with by other systems or devices which use the same radio frequency.

Status display on Control Display The tire and system status is indicated by the color of the tires.

TPM takes the fact that the tire pressure changes during driving into account. A correc- tion is only required if requested by TPM with the color.

Green The tire pressure matches the learned set state.

"TPM active" is displayed on the Control Dis- play.

One wheel is yellow Flat tire or a major drop in inflation pressure in the indicated tire. A message appears on the Control Display.

All wheels are yellow Flat tire or a major drop in inflation pressure in several tires. A message appears on the Control Display.

Gray The system cannot detect a flat tire.

Reasons for this can be:

> TPM is being reset

> Temporary interference due to systems or devices which use the same radio fre- quency

> Malfunction

Resetting system Reset the system again after each correc- tion of the tire inflation pressure and after

every tire or wheel change.<

Resetting finishes during driving, which can be interrupted at any time. When driving resumes, resetting is continued automatically. Do not reset the system when driving with a compact wheel*.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "TPM" is selected and press the controller.

C o

n tr

o ls

103

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

6. Start the engine, but do not start driving.

7. Select "Reset" and press the controller.

8. Select "Yes" and press the controller.

9. Start to drive. The tires are shown in gray and "Resetting TPM..." is displayed.

After a few minutes of driving, the set tire infla- tion pressures in the tires are applied as the set values to be monitored. Resetting finishes dur- ing driving. The tires are shown in green on the Control Display.

If a flat tire is detected during resetting and applying the tire inflation pressures,

all tires are shown in yellow on the Control Dis- play. The message "Tire low!" is displayed.<

Message with low tire inflation pressure

The warning lamp lights up yellow. A message appears on the Control Dis- play. In addition, an acoustic signal

sounds. There is a flat tire or extensive inflation pressure loss.

1. Cautiously reduce speed to below 50 mph/ 80 km/h. Avoid sudden braking and steer- ing maneuvers. Do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.

If the vehicle is not equipped with run- flat tires as provided at the factory,

refer to page 256, do not continue driving. Continuing to drive with a flat tire could cause severe accidents.<

2. In the event of complete tire pressure loss, 0 psi/0 kPa, you can estimate the possible distance for continued driving on the basis of the following guide values:

> With a light load: 1 to 2 persons without luggage: approx. 155 miles/250 km

> With a medium load: 2 persons, cargo bay full, or 4 persons without luggage: approx. 95 miles/150 km

> With a full load: 4 or more persons, cargo bay full: approx. 30 miles/50 km

Drive cautiously and do not exceed speeds of 50 mph/80 km/h or else you

run the risk of causing an accident. In the event of pressure loss, vehicle handling changes. This includes reduced tracking stability in braking, extended braking distance and altered natural steering characteristics. If unusual vibrations or loud noises occur while the vehicle is being driven, this can indicate final failure of the damaged tire. Reduce speed and stop at a suitable location as soon as possible, otherwise pieces of the tire could become detached and cause an accident. Do not con- tinue driving, but instead contact the BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center.<

Malfunction The yellow warning lamp flashes and then lights up continuously. The tires are shown in gray on the Control Dis-

play and a message is displayed. No flat tire can be detected.

A message like this is displayed in the following situations:

> In case of a malfunction: Have the system checked

T ec

h n

o lo

g y

fo r c

o m

fo rt

, c o

n ve

n ie

n ce

a n

d s

af et

y

104

> If a wheel without TPM electronics is mounted, e.g. a compact wheel*

> If TPM is temporarily interfered with by other systems or devices which use the same radio frequency

Explanation according to the NHTSA/ FMVSS 138 Tire Pressure Monitoring Systems Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle plac- ard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehi- cle has tires of a different size than the size indi- cated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.)

As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pres- sure telltale when one or more of your tires is significantly underinflated. Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pres- sure. Driving on a significantly underinflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Underinflation also reduces fuel effi- ciency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle's handling and stopping ability.

Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver's responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if underinflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale.

Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then remain con- tinuously illuminated. This sequence will con- tinue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists. When the mal-

function indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pres- sure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly.

Active steering*

The concept The active steering actively varies the steering angle of the front wheels in relation to the steer- ing wheel movements. In addition, it also varies the steering force required for steering depend- ing on the vehicle's speed.

When you are driving in the low road speed range, e.g. in a town or when parking, the steer- ing angle increases, i.e. the steering becomes very direct. In the higher speed range, on the other hand, the steering angle is reduced more and more. This improves the handling capability of your BMW over the entire speed range.

In critical situations, the system can make tar- geted corrections to the steering angle pro- vided by the driver and thus stabilize the vehicle before the driver intervenes.

Malfunction The warning lamp lights up yellow and a message is shown on the Con- trol Display. The active steering is defective or has been temporarily

deactivated. At low speeds, greater steering wheel movements are required, whereas at higher speeds, the vehicle reacts more sensi- tively to steering wheel movements. The stabil- ity-promoting intervention can also be deacti- vated. Proceed cautiously and drive defensively. If active steering is defective, have the system checked.

C o

n tr

o ls

105

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Brake force display*

BMW X5

On the left: normal braking.

On the right: heavy braking.

BMW X6

On the left: normal braking.

On the right: heavy braking.

Airbags

The following airbags are located under the marked covers:

1 Front airbags

2 Head-level airbags in front and rear

3 Side airbags in backrests

Protective action To ensure that the safety systems con- tinue to provide optimized protection,

observe the adjustment instructions on page 48.<

The front airbags help protect the driver and front passenger by responding to frontal impacts in which safety belts alone cannot pro- vide adequate restraint. When needed, the head and side airbags help provide protection in the event of side impact. The relevant side air- bag supports the side upper body area. The head air bag supports the head.

The airbags are deliberately not triggered in every impact situation, e.g. less severe acci- dents or rear-end collisions.

Do not apply adhesive materials to the cover panels of the airbags, cover them or

modify them in any other way. Keep the instrument cluster and window in the region of the passenger seat free of foreign materials, i.e. do not cover them with adhesive film or covers and do not attach mounts, e.g. for a navigation device or mobile phone to them. Do not install cosmetic covers, seat cushions, or other items on the front seats that are not especially approved for seats with integrated side airbags. Do not hang articles of clothing such as jackets over the backrests. Do not attempt to remove the airbag restraint system from the vehicle. Do not modify or tamper with either the wiring or the individual components in the airbag system. This includes

T ec

h n

o lo

g y

fo r c

o m

fo rt

, c o

n ve

n ie

n ce

a n

d s

af et

y

106

the upholstery in the center of the steering wheel, on the instrument cluster, the doors, and the roof pillars as well as the sides of the head- liner. Do not attempt to remove or dismantle the steering wheel. Do not touch the individual components immediately after the system has been triggered, because there is a danger of burns. In the event of malfunctions, deactivation, or triggering of the airbag restraint system, have the testing, repair, removal, and disposal of air- bag generators executed only by a BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained personnel and has the required explosives licenses. Otherwise unprofessional attempts to service the system could lead to failure in an emergency or undes- ired airbag triggering, either of which could result in personal injury.<

Warnings and information on the airbags is also provided on the sun visors.

Automatic deactivation of front passenger airbags The occupation of the seat is detected by eval- uating the impression on the occupied seat sur- face of the front passenger seat. The front and side airbags on the front passenger side are activated or deactivated accordingly by the sys- tem.

The current status of the front passenger airbag, i.e. deactivated or activated, is

indicated by the indicator lamp over the interior rearview mirror, refer to Operating state of front passenger airbags in the following.<

Before transporting a child on the front passenger seat, read the safety informa-

tion and follow the instructions under Trans- porting children safely, refer to page 61. When teenagers and adults assume certain sit- ting positions, this can cause the front and side airbags to deactivate. The indicator lamp for the front passenger airbags lights up when this occurs. In these cases, change the sitting posi- tion so that the front passenger airbags are acti- vated and the indicator lamp goes out. If the desired status cannot be produced by changing

the sitting position, transport the correspond- ing person on the rear seat. Do not fit seat cov- ers, seat cushion padding, ball mats or other items onto the front passenger seat unless they are specifically recommended by BMW. Do not lay objects under the seat which could press against the seat from below. Otherwise a cor- rect evaluation of the occupied seat surface cannot be ensured.<

Operating state of front passenger airbags

Depending on the vehicle's equipment, the arrangement of the switches and indicator lamps may differ somewhat.

The indicator lamp for the front passenger air- bags indicates the operating status of the front and side airbags on the front passenger side depending on the seat occupation. The indica- tor lamp shows whether the front passenger airbags are activated or deactivated.

> The indicator lamp lights up when a child in a child restraint device intended for the pur- pose is properly detected on the seat. The front and side airbags on the front pas- senger side are not activated.

Most child's seats are detected by the system. Especially the child's seats

required by the NHTSA at the time the vehi- cle is manufactured. After installing a child's seat, make sure that the indicator lamp for the front passenger airbags lights up. This indicates that the child's seat has been detected and the front passenger airbags are not activated.<

> The indicator lamp does not light up when, for example, a correctly seated person of sufficient height is detected on the seat.

C o

n tr

o ls

107

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

The front and side airbags on the front pas- senger side are activated.

> The indicator lamp does not light up when the seat is empty. However, the front and side airbags on the front passenger side are not activated.

Operational readiness of airbag system

From radio readiness, refer to page 65, the warning lamp lights up briefly, indicating the operational readiness of the entire airbag sys- tem and the safety belt tensioners.

Airbag system malfunction > Warning lamp does not light up from radio

readiness.

> Warning lamp lights up continuously.

Have the airbag system checked immedi- ately in case of a malfunction, otherwise

there is a danger that the airbag system may not respond in the expected manner in an accident despite an impact of corresponding intensity.<

Head-Up Display*

The concept With the Head-Up Display important informa- tion is projected into the driver's field of view, e.g. navigation instructions. This enables you to take in this information without looking away from the road.

Switching on/off Press the button.

1 Navigation information or Check Control messages

2 Cruise control

3 Speed

Selecting displays iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Display settings" and press the controller.

T ec

h n

o lo

g y

fo r c

o m

fo rt

, c o

n ve

n ie

n ce

a n

d s

af et

y

108

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Head-Up Display" is selected and press the controller.

6. Change into the second field from the top. Turn the controller until "Head-Up Display" is selected and press the controller.

7. Select desired information of Head-Up Dis- play.

8. Press the controller. The information is shown on the Head-

Up Display.

The settings are stored for the remote control currently in use.

Adjusting brightness and height of display The brightness of the display is automatically adapted to the ambient lighting conditions. However, you can change the base setting. With the low beams switched on, the brightness can also be adjusted with the serrated dial of the instrument lighting.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Display settings" and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Head-Up Display" is selected and press the controller.

6. Change into the second field from the top. Turn the controller until "Brightness / Posi- tion" is selected and press the controller.

7. If necessary, move the controller to the left or right to select "Brightness" or "Display position".

8. Turn the controller until the desired setting is selected.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Notes The visibility of the displays in the Head-Up Dis- play is influenced by:

> Sunglasses with certain polarization filters

> Certain sitting positions

> Objects on the cover of the Head-Up Dis- play

> Wet road surface and unfavorable lighting conditions

If the image is distorted, have the basic setting checked at a BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Cen- ter.

Special windshield The windshield is part of the system. The shape of the windshield complies with the require- ments of the Head-Up Display to enable a pre- cise display. A film in the windshield prevents the double images from being displayed. Windshield replacement should be carried out by a BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained per- sonnel.

C o

n tr

o ls

109

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Care instructions Important information on this topic is provided on page 268.

Only clean the cover of the Head-Up Dis- play with a soft, lint-free cloth or with a

display cleaning cloth, otherwise damage may result.<

L am

p s

110

Lamps

Parking lamps/low beams

0 Lights off and daytime driving lamps* 1 Parking lamps and daytime driving lamps* 2 Low beams and welcome lamps

3 Automatic headlamp control*, daytime driving lamps*, welcome lamps and Adap- tive Head Light*

If you open the driver's door with the ignition switched off, the exterior lighting is automati- cally switched off when the light switch is in position 0, 2 or 3.

If necessary, switch on the parking lamps, switch position 1.

Parking lamps In switch position 1, the front, rear and side vehicle lighting is switched on. You can use the parking lamps for parking.

The parking lamps drain the battery. Do not leave them switched on for long peri-

ods of time, otherwise it may no longer be pos- sible to start the engine. It is better to switch on the roadside parking lamps on one side, refer to page 112.<

Low beams The low beams light up when the light switch is in position 2 and the ignition is on.

Automatic headlamp control* In switch position 3, the system activates the low beams and switches them on or off in response to changes in ambient light condi- tions, for instance, in a tunnel, at dawn and dusk and in case of precipitation. Adaptive Head Light* is active. The LED next to the symbol lights up when the low beams are on. You can activate the daytime driving lamps, refer to page 111. In the situations named above, the system then automatically switches over to the low beams.

A blue sky with the sun low on the horizon can cause the lights to be switched on.

The low beams remain switched on inde- pendent of the ambient lighting condi-

tions when you switch on the fog lamps*.<

The automatic headlamp control cannot serve as a substitute for your personal

judgment in determining when the lamps should be switched on in response to ambient lighting conditions. For example, the sensors cannot detect fog or hazy weather. To avoid safety risks, you should always switch on the low beams manually under these conditions.<

Welcome lamps When parking the vehicle, if you leave the light switch in position 2 or 3, the parking lamps and the interior lamps light up briefly when the vehi- cle is unlocked.

Activating/deactivating welcome lamps iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

C o

n tr

o ls

111

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Lighting" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Welcome light" and press the con- troller.

The welcome lamps are switched on.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Pathway lighting When you activate the headlamp flasher after parking the vehicle and switching off the lamps, the low beams will come on for a brief period. You can set the duration or deactivate the func- tion via iDrive.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Lighting" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Pathway lighting" and press the controller.

7. Turn the controller to select the desired duration.

8. Press the controller to apply the setting.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Daytime driving lamps* The daytime driving lamps light up in position 0, 1 and 3. If the light switch remains in position 1, the parking lamps light up after the ignition is switched off.

Activating/deactivating daytime driving lamps iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Lighting" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Daytime running lamps" and press the controller.

Daytime driving lamps are switched on.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

L am

p s

112

Adaptive Head Light*

The concept Adaptive Head Light is a variable headlamp control system that enables better illumination of the road surface. Depending on the steering angle and other parameters, the light from the headlamp follows the course of the road.

In tight curves, e.g. serpentines, or when turn- ing, one of the two front fog lamps is also switched on up to a speed of approx. 45 mph/ 70 km/h. This provides improved illumination of the area inside the curve.

Activating Adaptive Head Light With the ignition switched on, turn the light switch to position 3, refer to page 110.

The turning lamps are automatically switched on depending on the steering angle or the use of turn signals.

To avoid blinding oncoming traffic, the Adaptive Head Light directs light towards the front pas- senger side when the vehicle is at a standstill. When driving in reverse, both turning lamps are active.

High beams/ roadside parking lamps

1 High beams

2 Headlamp flasher

3 Roadside parking lamps

Roadside parking lamps, left or right* You also enjoy the option of lighting up just one side of your vehicle when parking.

Switching on After parking the vehicle, press the lever up or down beyond the resistance point for approx. 1 second, arrow 3.

The roadside parking lamps drain the bat- tery. Do not leave them switched on for

long periods of time, otherwise it may no longer be possible to start the engine.<

Switching off Briefly press the lever in the opposite direction up to the resistance point, arrow 3.

Fog lamps*

First, switch on the parking lamps or the low beams. The green indicator lamp in the instru- ment panel lights up whenever the fog lamps are on.

If the automatic headlamp control is acti- vated, the low beams will come on auto-

matically when you switch on the fog lamps.<

C o

n tr

o ls

113

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Instrument lighting

You can control the lighting intensity by using the serrated dial.

Interior lamps The interior lamps, footwell lamps*, door entry lighting*, cargo bay lamps,and the courtesy lamps* are controlled automatically.

With the courtesy lamps, LED lights are located in the door handles to illuminate the exterior area before the doors.

To protect the battery, all lamps in the vehicle are switched off approx. 15 min-

utes after radio readiness is switched off, refer to Start/Stop button on page 65.<

Switching interior lamps on and off manually

Press the button.

If you wish the interior lamps, footwell lamps, door entry lighting and courtesy lamps to remain switched off all the time, press the but- ton for approx. 3 seconds.

Reading lamps

Reading lamps are provided in the front and rear* adjacent to the interior lamps. Press the button to switch the lamps on and off.

C lim

at e

114

Climate

1 Air toward the windshield and side windows

2 Air for the upper body region, refer to Front ventilation on page 118

3 Air to footwell

4 Automatic climate control with 2-zone control, refer to page 115 Automatic climate control with 4-zone control, refer to page 119

C o

n tr

o ls

115

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Automatic climate control with 2-zone control

1 Seat heatingand ventilation, driver's side 56

2 Temperature, left side of passenger compartment

3 AUTO program

4 Temperature, right side of passenger compartment

5 Maximum cooling

6 Seat heatingand ventilation, front passenger side 56

7 Manual air distribution, front passenger side

8 Switching cooling function on and off manually

9 AUC Automatic recirculated-air control/ recirculated-air mode

10 Manual air volume, switching off automatic climate control, residual heat

11 Rear window defroster

12 Defrosting windows and removing condensation

13 Air grill for interior temperature sensor please keep clear and unobstructed

14 Manual air distribution, driver's side

The current setting for manual air distribution is displayed on the Control Display.

A congenial climate The AUTO program offers the optimum air dis- tribution and air volume for virtually all condi- tions, refer to AUTO program below. Now you only need to select an interior temperature pleasant to you.

The following sections contain more detailed information on the available setting options.

Most settings are stored for the remote control currently in use, also refer to Personal Profile settings on page 28.

AUTO program The AUTO program handles the adjustment of air volume and air distribution to the windshield and side windows, in the direction of the upper body and in the footwell.

It also adapts your instructions for the tempera- ture to outside influences throughout the year.

The cooling is switched on automatically with the AUTO program. At the same time, a con- densation sensor controls the program in such a way that window condensation is prevented as much as possible.

Intensity of AUTO program You can adjust the intensity of the AUTO pro- gram by repeatedly pressing the AUTO button. The respective current setting is displayed when the button on the display of the automatic climate control is pressed.

You can also adjust the intensity of the AUTO program via iDrive.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller to the left to open "Cli- mate".

C lim

at e

116

3. Select "Automatic programs" and press the controller.

4. Select the desired intensity and press the controller.

The selected intensity level of the auto- matic program is switched on.

Temperature Set the desired temperature indi- vidually on the driver's and front passenger side.

The automatic climate control adjusts this temperature as quickly as possible at any time of year, if necessary with the maxi- mum cooling or heating capacity, and then keeps it constant.

In the highest setting you activate the maximum heating capacity, regardless of the outside tem- perature. And in the lowest setting, the maxi- mum cooling capacity.

When switching between different tem- perature settings in rapid succession, the

automatic climate control does not have suffi- cient time to adjust the set temperature.<

Adjusting temperature in upper body region 1. Press the button.

This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller to the left to open "Cli- mate".

3. Select "Vent settings" and press the con- troller.

4. Select the driver's or front passenger side if necessary. Move the controller to the right

or left repeatedly until the driver's or front passenger side is selected.

5. Move the controller to select the field.

6. Turn the controller to adjust the tempera- ture.

Defrosting windows and removing condensation

Quickly remove ice and condensa- tion from the windshield and front side windows.

To do this, also switch on the cooling function.

Rear window defroster The rear window defroster switches off automatically after a while. Depending on the vehicle equipment, upper wires are used

as an antenna and are not part of the rear win- dow defroster.

Air volume, manual You can vary the air volume by pressing on the corresponding side. You can reactivate the auto-

matic mode for the air volume with the AUTO button.

Air distribution, manual You can route the air flowing out into the vehicle interior via various programs, separately for the driver and passenger side.

> Upper body region

> Upper body region and footwell

> Footwell

> Driver's side: windows and footwell

C o

n tr

o ls

117

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

> Individual program

Selecting program Press the button repeatedly until the desired program is shown on

the Control Display.

Adjusting air distribution individually individual program The settings are stored in this program.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller to the left to open "Cli- mate".

3. Select "Vent settings" and press the con- troller. The driver's and front passenger side can be adjusted separately with the fields on the right or left side.

4. Select the driver's or front passenger side if necessary. Move the controller to the right or left repeatedly until the driver's or front passen- ger side is selected.

5. Select the desired field by moving the con- troller.

6. Turn the controller to adjust the air distribu- tion.

Driver's side:

1 Air toward the windshield and side windows

2 Air for the upper body

3 Air to footwell

Front passenger side:

4 Air for the upper body

5 Air to footwell

Pressing the AUTO button cancels the manual air distribution settings.<

The automatic mode for the air volume remains effective with manual air distribution.

Switching cooling function on and off The cooling function cools and dehumidifies the incoming air before also reheating it as

required, according to the temperature setting. This function is only available when the engine is running.

The cooling function helps to avoid condensa- tion on the window surfaces or to quickly remove them.

Depending on the weather, the windshield may fog over briefly when the engine is started.

The cooling function is switched on automati- cally with the AUTO program.

Maximum cooling Maximally cooled air is obtained as quickly as possible at an outside temperature above approx. 327/ 06 and with the engine running.

The automatic climate control switches into the recirculated-air mode at the lowest tempera- ture. The maximum air volume flows out of the air vents for the upper body. Therefore, open these vents for maximum cooling.

AUC Automatic recirculated-air control/recirculated-air mode

You can respond to pollutants or unpleasant odors in the immediate environment by suspending the supply of outside air. The system

then recirculates the air currently within the vehicle. During AUC operation, a sensor detects pollutants in the outside air and con- trols the shut-off automatically.

C lim

at e

118

By pressing the button repeatedly, you can request three operating modes:

> LED off: outside air flows in continuously.

> Left LED on, AUC mode: the system detects pollutants in the outside air and shuts off the supply as needed.

> Right LED on, recirculated-air mode: the supply of outside air is permanently shut off.

Should the windows fog up in the recircu- lated-air mode, press the AUTO button or

switch off the recirculated-air mode and increase the air volume if necessary. The recirculated-air mode should not be used without interruption over an extended period of time, as the air quality inside the vehicle deteri- orates continuously.<

Residual heat The heat stored in the engine is used to heat the passenger compartment, e.g. while stopped at a school to pick up a child.

Switching on Pressing the right side switches on the residual heat utilization when the following conditions are met:

> up to 15 minutes after switching off the engine

> with the engine at operating temperature

> with sufficient battery voltage

> at an outside temperature below 777/ 256

REST appears on the display of the automatic climate control when the residual heat utiliza- tion is switched on.

From radio readiness the interior temperature, the air volume and the air distribution can be set.

Switching off You can select the lowest blower speed by pressing and holding the left side. Pressing again switches off the residual heat utilization. REST disappears from the display of the auto- matic climate control.

Switching automatic climate control on and off

You can select the lowest blower speed by pressing and holding the left side. Pressing again switches

off the automatic climate control.

You switch on the system again by pressing any button of the automatic climate control.

Front ventilation

1 Serrated dials to smoothly open and close air vents

2 Levers to change the air vent direction

Do not drop any foreign objects into the air vents, otherwise these could be cata-

pulted outwards and lead to injuries.<

Ventilation for cooling Adjust the air vents to direct the flow of cool air in your direction, for instance, if the interior has become too warm, etc.

Draft-free ventilation Set the air vents so that the air flows past you and is not directed straight at you.

C o

n tr

o ls

119

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Ventilation in rear

1 Serrated dials to smoothly open and close air vents

2 Serrated dial for adjusting the temperature in the upper body region:

> Turn toward blue: colder

> Turn toward red: warmer

3 Levers to change the air vent direction

BMW X5: heating and ventilation, 3rd row seats The air in the area of the 3rd row seats can be heated or recirculated. Air vents are located in the storage compartment area between the seats and in the footwell of the 3rd row seats.

1 Serrated dial:

> Activating heating and distributing air in footwell: Turn toward front

> Distributing air in storage compartment area between seats: Turn toward rear

2 Button for switching on blower: LED lights up

The heating is not ready for operation without switching on the blower. After the

heating is switched off, the blower can be used to recirculate the air within the vehicle, e.g. at high temperatures. To do this, turn the serrated dial 1 toward the rear and switch on the blower, button 2.<

Microfilter/activated-charcoal filter The microfilter removes dust and pollen from the incoming air. The activated-charcoal filter provides additional protection by filtering gas- eous pollutants from the outside air. This com- bined filter is changed during maintenance by your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center. You can select a display of more detailed infor- mation on the Control Display, refer to page 82.

Automatic climate control with 4-zone control*

Front operation Corresponds to the operation of the automatic climate control with 2-zone control, refer to page 115.

Rear operation The control unit is located in the center console in the rear.

1 Temperature, left rear seating area

2 AUTO program

3 Display

4 Temperature, right rear seating area

5 Seat heating, right rear seat

6 Air volume, manual

7 Seat heating, left rear seat

C lim

at e

120

The current setting for the temperature and the air volume is shown on display 3.

Activating iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller to the left to open "Cli- mate".

3. Select "Rear climate control" and press the controller.

4. Select the desired settings and press the controller.

The rear automatic climate control is activated and the settings of the automatic climate control on the driver's side can be applied if necessary.

The rear automatic climate control cannot be operated if the front automatic climate

control is switched off. With the defrost win- dows and eliminate condensation function acti- vated, the rear automatic climate control is also not ready for operation.<

AUTO program The AUTO program assumes the adjustment of the air distribution toward the upper body and in the footwell, as well as the air volume for you. It also adapts your instruc-

tions for the temperature to outside influences throughout the year.

Temperature Set the desired temperature indi- vidually on the left and right side.

The automatic climate control adjusts this temperature as quickly

as possible at any time of year, if necessary with the maximum cooling or heating capacity, and then keeps it constant.

When switching between different tem- perature settings in rapid succession, the

automatic climate control does not have suffi- cient time to adjust the set temperature.<

Air volume, manual You can vary the air volume by pressing on the corresponding side. You can reactivate the auto-

matic mode for the air volume with the AUTO button.

Switching off rear automatic climate control

You can select the lowest blower speed by pressing and holding the left side. Pressing again switches

off the automatic climate control.

The automatic climate control can also be switched off with iDrive. To switch on the

automatic climate control again, the system must first be reactivated, refer to Activating.<

You switch on the system again by pressing any button of the rear automatic climate control.

C o

n tr

o ls

121

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Ventilation in rear

1 Serrated dials to smoothly open and close air vents

2 Serrated dials to adjust temperature in upper body region; can be adjusted sepa- rately for left and right:

> Turn toward blue: colder

> Turn toward red: warmer

3 Levers to change the air vent direction

BMW X5

1 Levers to change the air vent direction

2 Serrated dial to smoothly open and close air vents

For information on the ventilation of the 3rd row seats, refer to page 119.

Parked-car ventilation*

The concept The parked-car ventilation blows air into the passenger compartment to lower interior tem- peratures.

It is ready to use in the parked car mode at any outside temperature.

You can set two different times for the system to start. The parked-car ventilation can also be switched on and off directly. It remains switched on for 30 minutes.

Since the system uses a substantial amount of electrical current, you should refrain from acti- vating it twice in succession without allowing the battery to be recharged in normal operation between use.

The air emerges through the upper body region air vents in the instrument cluster. Therefore, please open the air vents.

The parked-car ventilation is operated via iDrive.

Switching on and off directly iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Move the controller to the left to open "Cli- mate".

3. Select "Parked car operation" and press the controller.

4. Select "Automatic ventilation" and press the controller.

5. Select "Parked car ventilation" and press the controller.

The parked-car ventilation is switched on.

C lim

at e

122

The symbol on the display of the automatic climate control flashes.

Preselecting activation times iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Move the controller to the left to open "Cli- mate".

3. Select "Parked car operation" and press the controller.

4. Select "Activation time" and press the con- troller.

5. Move the controller to the left or right to select "Timer 1" or "Timer 2".

6. Select the time and press the controller.

The first time setting is highlighted.

7. Turn the controller to make the adjustment.

8. Press the controller to apply the setting. The next setting is highlighted.

9. Make the remaining adjustments. After the last adjustment, the time is stored.

Activating activation time Move the controller to the left or right to select "Timer 1" or "Timer 2" and press the controller.

The activation time is activated.

The symbol on the display of the automatic climate control lights up.

The symbol on the display of the automatic climate control flashes when the parked-car ventilation has switched on.

The parked-car ventilation is only avail- able for activation within the next

24 hours. Then it must be activated again.<

C o

n tr

o ls

123

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Practical interior accessories

Integrated universal remote control*

The concept The integrated universal remote control can replace as many as three hand-held transmit- ters for various remote-controlled accessories, such as garage and gate or lighting systems. The integrated universal remote control regis- ters and stores signals from the original hand- held transmitters.

The signal of an original hand-held transmitter can be programmed on one of the three mem- ory buttons 1. Then with the ignition switched on, this programmed memory button 1 can be used to operate the respective feature. The LED 2 flashes to confirm transmission of the signal.

Should you sell your vehicle one day, be sure to delete the stored programs beforehand for your safety, refer to page 124.

To prevent possible damage or injury, before programming or using the inte-

grated universal remote control, always inspect the immediate area to make certain that no peo- ple, animals or objects are within the travel range of the device. Also, comply with the safety precautions of the original hand-held transmitter.<

Checking compatibility If you see this symbol on the packaging or in the manual supplied with the orig- inal hand-held transmitter, it is safe to

assume that it is compatible with the integrated universal remote control.

Should you have additional questions, please contact your BMW Sports Activity

Vehicle Center or call: 1-800-355-3515. Information is also provided on the Internet at: www.bmwusa.com or www.homelink.com.

HomeLink is a registered trademark of Johnson Controls, Inc.<

Programming

1 Memory buttons

2 LED

Fixed-code hand-held transmitters 1. Switch on ignition, refer to page 65.

2. When starting operation for the first time: Press the left and right-hand memory but- ton 1 for approx. 20 seconds until the LED 2 flashes quickly. All stored programs are deleted.

3. Hold the original hand-held transmitter at a distance of approx. 4 in/10 cm to 12 in/ 30 cm from the memory buttons 1.

The required distance between the hand-held transmitter and the mem-

ory buttons 1 depends on the relevant sys- tem of the original hand-held transmitter used.<

4. Simultaneously press the transmit button on the original hand-held transmitter and the desired memory button 1 on the inte- grated universal remote control. The LED 2 flashes slowly at first. As soon as the LED 2 flashes rapidly, release both buttons. If the LED 2 does not flash rapidly after approx. 15 seconds, alter the distance and repeat the step.

5. To program other original hand-held trans- mitters, repeat steps 3 and 4.

P ra

ct ic

al in

te ri

o r a

cc es

so ri

es

124

The corresponding memory button 1 is now programmed with the signal of the original hand-held transmitter.

You can operate the device when the engine is running or when the ignition is switched on.

If the device cannot be used after repeated programming, check whether

the original hand-held transmitter uses an alter- nating-code system. To do so, either read the instructions for the original hand-held transmit- ter or hold down the programmed memory but- ton 1 of the integrated universal remote control. If the LED 2 on the integrated universal remote control flashes rapidly for a short time and then remains lit for approx. 2 seconds, this indicates that the original hand-held transmitter uses an alternating-code system. In the case of an alter- nating-code system, program the memory but- tons 1 as described at Alternating-code hand- held transmitters.<

Alternating-code hand-held transmitters To program the integrated universal remote control, consult the operating instructions for the equipment to be set. You will find informa- tion there on the possibilities for synchroniza- tion. When programming hand-held transmitters that employ an alternating code, observe the following supplementary instructions:

Programming will be easier with the aid of a second person.<

1. Park your vehicle within the range of the remote-controlled device.

2. Program the integrated universal remote control as described above in the section Fixed-code hand-held transmitters.

3. Locate the button on the receiver of the device to be set, e.g. on the drive unit.

4. Press the button on the receiver of the device to be set. After step 4, you have approx. 30 seconds for step 5.

5. Press the programmed memory button 1 of the integrated universal remote control three times.

The corresponding memory button 1 is now programmed with the signal of the original hand-held transmitter.

Should you have questions, please con- tact your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle

Center.<

Deleting all stored programs Press the left and right-hand memory button 1 for approx. 20 seconds until the LED 2 flashes quickly: All stored programs are deleted.

Reassigning individual programs 1. Hold the original hand-held transmitter at

a distance of approx. 4 in/10 cm to 12 in/ 30 cm from the memory buttons 1.

The required distance between the hand-held transmitter and the mem-

ory buttons 1 depends on the relevant sys- tem of the original hand-held transmitter used.<

2. Press the desired memory button 1 of the integrated universal remote control.

3. When the LED 2 flashes slowly after approx. 20 seconds, press the transmit button of the original hand-held transmitter. Release both buttons as soon as the LED 2 flashes rapidly. If the LED 2 does not flash rapidly after approx. 15 seconds, alter the distance and repeat the step.

Digital compass*

1 Adjustment button

2 Display

C o

n tr

o ls

125

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

The display indicates the cardinal or intercardi- nal direction in which you are currently driving.

Operating principle You can run various functions by pressing the adjustment button with a pointed object, e.g. a ball-point pen etc. The following setting options are displayed consecutively, depending on how long the adjustment button is pressed:

> Press briefly: switch display on/off

> 3 to 6 seconds: set compass zone

> 6 to 9 seconds: calibrate compass

> 9 to 12 seconds: set left/right-hand drive vehicle

> 12 to 15 seconds: set language

Setting compass zones

Set the respectively applicable compass zone in your vehicle so that the compass functions properly, refer to the map of the world with compass zones.

To set the compass zones, press the adjust- ment button for approx. 3-4 seconds. The dis- play indicates the number of the currently set compass zone.

To change the zone setting, briefly press the adjusting button repeatedly until the number of the compass zone that applies to your current position is displayed.

The compass will be operational again after approx. 10 seconds.

P ra

ct ic

al in

te ri

o r a

cc es

so ri

es

126

Calibrating digital compass Calibrate the digital compass In the following situations:

> The wrong cardinal direction appears on the display.

> The cardinal direction displayed does not change despite a change in the direction of travel.

> Not all cardinal directions are displayed.

Procedure 1. Make sure that there are no large metal

objects or overhead power lines in the vicin- ity of your vehicle and that you have enough space to drive in a circle.

2. Input the currently applicable compass zone.

3. Press the adjustment button for approx. 6-7 seconds to display C. Then drive in a complete circle at least once at a maximum speed of 4 mph/7 km/h. If the calibration is successful, display C is replaced with the points of the compass.

Setting right/left-hand drive vehicle Your digital compass is already set to right or left-hand drive vehicle to match your vehicle at the factory.

Setting language You can set the language of the display.

Press the adjustment button for approx. 12-13 seconds. Briefly press the adjustment button again to change between English "E" and German "O".

The setting is automatically stored after approx. 10 seconds.

Roller sun blinds for rear side windows* Pull the loop of the roller sun blind and hook onto bracket.

Do not open the window with the roller blind raised, as otherwise there is a dan-

ger of damage, and therefore a danger of inju- ries at higher speeds.<

Glove compartment

Opening

Press the button. The covers open upward and downward and the lighting in the glove com- partment switches on.

To prevent injury in the event of an acci- dent while the vehicle is being driven,

close the glove compartment immediately after use.<

Closing Press one of the two covers closed.

C o

n tr

o ls

127

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Center armrest front A storage compartment is located under the armrest between the front seats and, depend- ing on the vehicle's equipment, also a cover for the mobile phone bracket or the snap-in adapter. Also refer to page 220.

Opening cover

Push cover down slightly and press the button. The cover folds upward.

Connection for external audio device You can connect an external audio device such as a CD or MP3 player and play audio tracks over the vehicle's speaker system:

> AUX-In connection, refer to page 200

> USB audio interface, refer to page 201

Storage compartments Compartments are located in the doors, in the center console in the front and rear* as well as in the rear console in the X6. Storage nets* are located on the backrests of the front seats.

Do not stow hard or sharp-edged objects in the storage nets; otherwise there is an

increased risk of injury in the event of an acci- dent.<

Clothes hooks When hanging clothing on the hooks, ensure that it will not obstruct the driver's

vision. Do not hang heavy objects on the hooks.

If you do so, they could cause personal injury to occupants during braking or evasive maneu- vers.<

BMW X5 Clothes hooks are located near the grab han- dles in the rear.

BMW X6

To fold out, press against upper edge.

Cup holders Use lightweight, unbreakable containers and do not transport hot beverages; oth-

erwise, there is an increased risk of injury in the event of an accident. Do not force unsuitable containers into the cup holders, as otherwise damage can result.<

Front

Slide the cover back.

P ra

ct ic

al in

te ri

o r a

cc es

so ri

es

128

Rear

BMW X5

Unlock the center armrest with the button in the lower section of the opening and fold down.

Press the button; the cover folds forward.

With the 3rd row seats*:

Fold down the center armrest. Press the button; the cup holders are opened.

The cup holders of the 3rd row seats are located in the center console between the seats.

BMW X6

Slide the cover forward.

Remove the beverage container before folding the rear seat backrest forward or

using the ski bag; otherwise it may cause dam- age.<

Ashtray

Front

To open the cover, slide it forward.

Press the button. The ashtray insert raises slightly and can be removed.

C o

n tr

o ls

129

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Rear

BMW X6

Slide the cover back.

Remove the insert to empty.

Lighter

Front

Press in the lighter with the engine running or the ignition switched on.

The lighter can be removed as soon as it pops back out.

Hold or touch the hot cigarette lighter by the knob only. Holding or touching it in

other areas could result in burns. Always take along the remote control when you leave the vehicle, otherwise children could, for example, use the lighter and burn themselves.<

Rear

Refer to Cigarette lighter, front.

Connecting electrical devices

Sockets With the engine running or the ignition switched on, the cigarette lighter socket can be used as a power outlet for hand flashlights, car vacuum cleaners, etc., with power ratings of up to approx. 200 W at 12 V. Avoid damaging the socket due to inserting plugs of different shapes or sizes. The same is true for all power outlets in the vehicle.

In cargo bay

Access to socket: Fold open the cover.

P ra

ct ic

al in

te ri

o r a

cc es

so ri

es

130

In rear center console

Depending on your vehicle's equipment pack- age, the socket in the rear is covered with a cap or equipped with a lighter. Refer to Cigarette lighter, front, page 129.

Access to socket: Remove cap or lighter.

In storage compartment under center armrest

Access to socket*: Pull off the cover.

BMW X6: in rear console

Slide the cover back.

Access to socket: Pull off the cover.

Rear center armrest

BMW X6 and BMW X5 with 3rd row seats*

Pull on the loop and fold down the center arm- rest.

BMW X5 without 3rd row seats*

Unlock the center armrest with the button in the lower section of the opening and fold down.

Cargo bay

BMW X5: roll-up cover

Pull out the roll-up cover and hook it into the brackets.

C o

n tr

o ls

131

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Do not place heavy or hard objects on the roll-up cover. If you do so, they may

already pose a danger to vehicle occupants dur- ing braking or evasive maneuvers. Do not allow the roll-up cover to snap back, oth- erwise it can be damaged.<

Removing 1. Unlock the case with the button, arrow 1.

2. Swing the case somewhat to the left, arrow 2, and remove.

Installing When installing, proceed in the opposite order of removal.

1. Lay on the case on the left-hand side and push it forward, arrow 1.

2. Swing the case toward the inside, refer to arrow 2.

3. Push the case forward at the ends until it engages in the two side brackets.

4. Check whether the case is properly locked in place by pulling it with a sudden move- ment.

BMW X6: cargo bay cover

Deploy cargo bay cover by pulling back.

Do not place heavy or hard objects on the cargo bay cover. If you do so, they may

pose a danger to vehicle occupants during braking or evasive maneuvers.<

Removing

1. Grasp retracted cargo bay cover under- neath the upper fold on both sides.

2. Pull the cover back out of the side brackets.

3. Depending on your vehicle's equipment package, you can store the cover under the floor panel in the cargo bay.

P ra

ct ic

al in

te ri

o r a

cc es

so ri

es

132

Installing When installing, proceed in the opposite order of removal.

1. Set the cargo bay cover into place on the left and right sides.

2. Lift the back of the cover slightly and slide forward until it snaps into the two side brackets.

Expanding cargo bay The rear seat backrest is divided. You can fold down both sides separately in order to expand the cargo bay.

BMW X6: before folding the rear seat backrest forward or using the ski bag,

remove beverage containers from the cup holder and close the cup holder.<

Reach into the recess and pull toward the front.

When you fold back the backrest, be sure that the catch engages securely. The red

warning indicator disappears in the recess when the catch is engaged. If it is not properly engaged, transported cargo could enter the passenger compartment during braking or eva- sive maneuvers and endanger the vehicle occu- pants.<

To ensure that the safety systems con- tinue to provide optimized protection,

observe the safety belt information on page 48.<

Storage compartments in cargo bay Depending on the vehicle's equipment, the fol- lowing storage compartments are provided in the cargo bay.

> Storage compartments behind the remov- able side panels on the right and left side of the cargo bay* and under the floor panel flap, storage compartment* right side of cargo bay.

> Storage tray* under the floor panel flap, capacity approx. 21 US gal/80 liter.

> Retaining straps* on the left and right side panel for securing small objects.

> Hooks*, e.g. for hanging up shopping bags or carrier bags on the left and right in the cargo bay.

> Net* on the left side panel of the cargo bay for smaller objects.

> Lashing rail with lashing eyes*. You can secure heavy-duty cargo straps on the lash- ing eyes. They can be removed at the notches in the rails. To move the lashing eyes, press the button.

Read and comply with the information enclosed with the heavy-duty cargo

straps.<

Floor panel flap

To access the onboard toolkit etc.

To open, swing up the flap by the handle, refer to arrow.

The floor panel flap can be locked*.

C o

n tr

o ls

133

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Adaptive fixing system* The adaptive fixing system is used to divide up the cargo bay. It consists of two brackets with a telescopic rail and retaining straps. These are guided into the two rails on the cargo bay floor.

Before using the adaptive fixing system, fold up and lock the rear seat backrest;

otherwise, the cargo could be thrown into the vehicle interior in an accident.<

1 Brackets

2 Telescopic rail

3 Notch in the cargo bay rail

Mounting brackets The two brackets are connected with a tele- scopic rail.

1. Insert the brackets at the respective notch in the rail on the cargo bay floor.

2. Press down the brackets to push them into the desired position.

3. Check the firm seating of the brackets. They must be clearly heard to engage.

Do not lay cargo on the brackets, as oth- erwise they could be unlocked.<

Dividing up cargo bay

You can position the cargo as follows:

> between the rear seat backrest and the telescopic rail

> between the telescopic rail and the retain- ing strap

Positioning cargo between telescopic rail and retaining strap:

1. Lay the cargo on the telescopic rail. Press the button, arrow 1, and route the retaining strap around the cargo, arrow 2.

2. Hook the retaining strap into the mount 3 on the telescopic rail.

3. Press the button of the bracket, arrow 1. The retaining strap is tensioned.

You can also hook both retaining straps into each other.<

When you are finished using the adaptive fixing system, unhook the retaining strap and guide it back into the bracket in order to prevent dam- age and injury. Then slide the fastening system toward the front in order to permit the best possible use of the cargo bay.

Removing brackets Press down the brackets, slide them up to the notches of the rails and remove them.

Depending on your vehicle's equipment pack- age, you can store the adaptive fixing system under the floor panel in the cargo bay.

P ra

ct ic

al in

te ri

o r a

cc es

so ri

es

134

Ski bag* The ski bag is designed for safe, clean transport of up to 4 pairs of standard skis or up to 2 snow- boards.

With the ski bag you can stow skis with a length of up to 6.9 ft/2.10 m. When skis of 6.9 ft/ 2.10 m in length are loaded, the ski bag will tend to contract, reducing its overall capacity.

Before loading the ski bag, fold in the dis- play screen of the DVD system in the

rear*, as otherwise the display screen could be damaged.<

Loading 1. Fold down the center armrest, press the

button and open the cover.

2. Press the button again; the cover in the cargo bay opens. If you press the button firmly the first time, this cover also opens.

3. Extend the ski bag between the front seats and fill it. The zipper facilitates access to the stowed items and drying of the ski bag.

4. BMW X5: insert the latch plate of the ski bag retaining strap into the center safety belt buckle that is marked CENTER.

BMW X6: attach the hook of the ski bag retaining strap to the eyelet on the rear seat backrest.

Only stow clean skis in the ski bag. Wrap sharp edges to prevent damage.

Securing cargo

After loading, secure the ski bag and its con- tents. Tighten the retaining strap on the ten- sioning buckle for this purpose.

Secure the ski bag in this way. If you fail to do so, it could endanger occupants dur-

ing braking or evasive maneuvers.<

To store the ski bag, perform the above steps in reverse order.

C o

n tr

o ls

135

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Removing ski bag The ski bag can be completely removed, e.g. for faster drying or to allow you to put it to other uses.

1. Pull the handle toward the front, arrow 1.

2. Take out the ski bag upward, arrow 2.

3. Close the cover in the cargo bay.

Details on various inserts are available from your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle

Center.<

Driving tips This section is designed to provide you

with extra support by supplying information useful in dealing with specific driving

and operating conditions.

T h

in g

s to

re m

em b

er w

h en

d ri

vi n

g

138

Things to remember when driving

Break-in period Moving parts need breaking-in time to adjust to each other. To ensure that your vehicle contin- ues to provide optimized economy of operation throughout an extended service life, we request that you devote careful attention to the follow- ing section.

Engine and differential Always obey all official speed limits.

Up to 1,200 miles/2,000 km Drive at changing engine and vehicle speeds, however do not exceed:

> Gasoline engine 4,500 rpm or 100 mph/160 km/h

> Diesel engine 3,500 rpm or 90 mph/150 km/h

Avoid full-throttle operation and use of the transmission's kick-down mode during these initial miles.

From 1,200 miles/2,000 km The engine and vehicle speed can gradually be increased.

Tires Due to technical factors associated with their manufacture, tires do not achieve their full trac- tion potential until after an initial break-in period. Therefore, drive reservedly during the first 200 miles/300 km.

Brake system Brakes require an initial break-in period of approx. 300 miles/500 km to achieve optimized contact and wear patterns between brake pads and rotors. Drive in a reserved manner during this break-in period.

Following part replacement Observe the break-in instructions again if com- ponents mentioned above must be replaced after subsequent driving operation.

Saving fuel The fuel consumption of your vehicle depends on various factors. Through a few simple steps, your driving style, and regular maintenance, you can have a positive influence on your fuel con- sumption and environmental impact.

Removing unnecessary cargo Additional weight increases fuel consumption.

Removing add-on parts after use Remove unneeded auxiliary mirrors, roof or rear luggage racks after use. Add-on parts attached to the vehicle impede the aerodynamics and increase the fuel consumption.

Closing windows and glass sunroof*/ panorama glass sunroof* An open glass sunroof/panorama glass sunroof or open windows likewise increase the drag coefficient and therefore the fuel consumption.

Checking tire inflation pressures regularly Check and correct the tire inflation pressure as needed at least twice a month and before long trips.

An insufficient tire inflation pressure increases the rolling resistance and thus increases the fuel consumption and tire wear.

Driving off immediately Do not allow the engine to warm up by leaving it running while the vehicle remains stationary. Instead, begin to drive at a moderate engine

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

139

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

speed. This is the fastest way for the cold engine to reach its operating temperature.

Thinking ahead when driving Avoid unnecessary acceleration and braking. To do so, maintain the appropriate distance from the vehicle in front of you. An anticipatory and smooth driving style reduces fuel con- sumption.

Avoiding high engine speeds Driving at a low engine speed reduces fuel con- sumption and minimizes wear.

Taking advantage of coasting The flow of fuel is interrupted when coasting.

Switching off engine during longer stops Switch off the engine at longer stops such as traffic signals, railroad crossings, or in traffic jams. Even having the engine switched off for approx. 4 seconds results in fuel savings.

Switching off functions currently not required Functions such as air conditioning, seat heat- ing, or rear window defrosting consume a lot of energy and require additional fuel. Their influ- ence is particularly pronounced in city traffic and stop & go operation. For this reason, it is a good idea to switch these functions off when they are not really needed.

Having maintenance carried out Have the vehicle serviced regularly in order to achieve the optimum economy and service life of your vehicle. BMW recommends having the maintenance performed by a BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center. Also pay attention to the BMW maintenance system, refer to page 263.

General driving notes

Closing liftgate Operate the vehicle only when the liftgate is completely closed. Otherwise, exhaust

fumes could enter into the passenger compart- ment.<

If it is absolutely necessary to drive with the lift- gate open:

1. Close all windows as well as the glass sun- roof*/panorama glass sunroof*.

2. Increase the air volume of the automatic cli- mate control to a high level, refer to page 116.

Hot exhaust system As in all vehicles, extremely high temper- atures are generated on the exhaust sys-

tem. Do not remove the heat shields installed adjacent to it, and never apply undercoating to them. When driving, standing at idle and while parking take care to avoid possible contact between the hot exhaust system and any highly flammable materials such as hay, leaves, grass, etc. Such contact could lead to a fire, and with it the risk of serious property damage as well as personal injury. Do not touch hot tailpipes, as otherwise there is a danger of burns.<

Diesel particulate filter* Soot particles are collected in the diesel partic- ulate filter and are periodically cleared out through high-temperature combustion. This cleaning process lasts for several minutes. You may sometimes notice it by the fact that the engine temporarily runs a little less smoothly and requires a somewhat higher engine speed to achieve the usual power. You may also notice additional sounds and small amounts of smoke coming from the exhaust, even for a brief time after switching off the engine.

Hydroplaning When driving on wet or slushy roads, reduce road speed. If you do not, a wedge

of water can form between tires and road sur- face. This phenomenon is referred to as hydro-

T h

in g

s to

re m

em b

er w

h en

d ri

vi n

g

140

planing, and is characterized by a partial or complete loss of contact between the tires and the road surface, ultimately undermining your ability to steer and brake the vehicle.<

The risk of hydroplaning increases as the tread depth of the tires decreases, also refer to Mini- mum tread depth on page 255.

Driving through water Maximum water depth:

> BMW X5 20 in/50 cm

> BMW X6 17 in/45 cm

Only drive through water up to the above- mentioned depth at no greater than walk-

ing speed; otherwise, the engine, electrical sys- tem, and transmission can be damaged.<

Braking safely Your BMW is equipped with ABS as a standard feature. In situations that require it, it is best to brake with full force. Since the vehicle maintains steering responsiveness, you can still avoid possible obstacles with a minimum of steering effort.

Pulsation of the brake pedal, combined with sounds from the hydraulic circuits, indicate that ABS is in its active mode.

Do not drive with your foot resting on the brake pedal. Even light but consistent

pedal pressure can lead to high temperatures, brake wear and possibly even brake failure.<

Driving in wet conditions When roads are wet or there is heavy rain, briefly exert gentle pressure on the brake pedal every few miles. Monitor traffic conditions to ensure that this maneuver does not endanger other road users. The heat generated in this process helps dry the pads and rotors to ensure that full braking efficiency will then be available when you need it.

Hills To prevent overheating and the resulting reduced efficiency of the brake system,

drive long or steep downhill gradients in the

gear in which the least braking is required. Even light but consistent pressure on the brake pedal can lead to high temperatures, brake wear and possibly even brake failure.<

The braking effect of the engine can be further increased by downshifting in the manual mode of the automatic transmission, if necessary into first gear, refer to page 71. This prevents an excessive strain on the brakes.

Do not drive in idle or with the engine stopped, otherwise there will be no

engine braking action or support of the braking force and steering. Never allow floor mats, carpets or any other objects to protrude into the area of movement of the pedals and impair their operation.<

Corrosion on brake rotors When the vehicle is driven only occasionally, during extended periods when the vehicle is not used at all, and in operating conditions where brake applications are less frequent, there is an increased tendency for corrosion to form on rotors, while contaminants accumulate on the brake pads. This occurs because the minimum pressure which must be exerted by the pads during brake applications to clean the rotors is not reached.

Should corrosion form on the brake rotors, the brakes will tend to respond with a pulsating effect that even extended application will fail to cure.

When vehicle is parked Condensation forms in the automatic climate control system during operation, and then exits under the vehicle. Traces of condensed water under the vehicle are therefore normal.

Before driving into a car wash Fold in the exterior mirrors, refer to page 57, otherwise they could be damaged due to the width of the vehicle.

Release the parking brake, particularly when you have activated Automatic Hold, refer to page 67.

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

141

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

General information on the care of your BMW is provided beginning on page 265.

Mixed tires* Before driving into a car wash, make sure that the vehicle width is not too large for

the car wash, as otherwise the vehicle and the car wash could be damaged.<

BMW X5: rear window wiper The rear window wiper can be damaged in car washes. Take appropriate protective measures; ask the car wash operator if necessary.

With comfort access* Insert the remote control into the ignition lock. The engine can be switched off in transmission position N, also refer to page 41.

Loading To avoid loading the tires beyond their approved carrying capacity, never over-

load the vehicle. Overloading can lead to over- heating and increases the rate at which damage develops inside the tires. The ultimate result can assume the form of a sudden blow-out.<

Make sure that no fluids leak in the cargo bay; otherwise the vehicle could be dam-

aged.<

Determining loading limit

1. Locate the following statement on your vehicle's placard*:

The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed

YYY lbs. or XXX kg. Otherwise, this could

damage the vehicle and produce unstable vehicle operating conditions.<

2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be riding in your vehicle.

3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from YYY lbs. or XXX kg.

4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if the YYY amount equals 1,400 lbs. and there will be five 150 lbs. passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs.: 1,400 lbs. minus 750 lbs. = 650 lbs.

5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in step 4.

6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, part of the load from your trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. Consult the manual for transporting a trailer to determine how this may reduce the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.

Load BMW X5:

T h

in g

s to

re m

em b

er w

h en

d ri

vi n

g

142

BMW X6:

The permissible load is the total of the weight of occupants and cargo/luggage. The greater the weight of occupants, the less cargo/luggage can be transported.

Stowing cargo

BMW X5

BMW X6

> Load heavy cargo as far forward and as low as possible, placing it directly behind the backrest.

> Cover sharp edges and corners.

> When transporting very heavy cargo with unoccupied rear seats, insert the safety belts, the outer safety belts in the BMW X5, into the buckles on the opposite sides.

> Do not pile objects higher than the top edge of the backrest.

> Wrap sharp-edged or pointed objects which could strike the rear window while driving.

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

143

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Securing cargo

BMW X5

BMW X6

> Use the luggage net*, retaining straps*, or securing straps to hold down small and lightweight luggage and cargo.

> For larger and heavier pieces, heavy-duty cargo straps* are available from your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center. Four lashing eyes* mounted in the cargo bay are used to secure these heavy-duty cargo straps, refer to illustrations.

> Observe the special instructions supplied with the heavy-duty cargo straps.

Position and secure the cargo as described above, so that it cannot endan-

ger the car's occupants, for example if sudden braking or evasive maneuvers are necessary. Never exceed either the approved gross vehicle weight or either of the approved axle weights, refer to page 289, as excessive loads can pose a safety hazard, and may also place you in viola- tion of traffic safety laws. You should never transport unsecured heavy or hard objects in the passenger compartment, as they could fly around and pose a safety hazard

to the vehicle's occupants during abrupt brak- ing or evasive maneuvers. Use only the lashing eyes pictured to fasten the heavy-duty cargo straps. Do not secure cargo with the attachment points for the top tether, refer to page 62; otherwise they could be dam- aged.<

Roof-mounted luggage rack* A special rack system is available as an option for your BMW. Please comply with the precau- tions included with the installation instructions.

Loading roof-mounted luggage rack Because roof racks raise the vehicle's center of gravity when loaded, they have a major effect on its handling and steering response. You should therefore always remember not to exceed the approved roof load capacity, the approved gross vehicle weight or the axle weights when loading the rack.

You can find the specified weights under Weights on page 289.

The load on the roof must be evenly distributed and must not extend outward beyond the limits of the loading surface. Always stow the heaviest pieces on the bottom. Be sure that adequate clearance is maintained for raising the glass sunroof*/panorama glass sunroof* and that objects do not project into the opening path of the liftgate.

Secure roof-mounted cargo correctly and securely to prevent it from shifting or falling off during the trip.

Drive smoothly. Avoid sudden acceleration and braking maneuvers. Take corners gently.

T h

in g

s to

re m

em b

er w

h en

d ri

vi n

g

144

Driving on poor roads Your BMW is at home on all roads and surfaces. It combines a 4-wheel drive system with the advantages of a normal passenger car.

Do not drive on unpaved terrain, as other- wise the vehicle may be damaged.<

When you are driving on poor roads, there are a few points which you should strictly observe for your own safety, for that of your passengers, and for the safety of the vehicle:

> Familiarize yourself with the vehicle before driving off and avoid taking risks at all costs.

> Adapt your driving speed to the road condi- tions. The steeper and rougher the road surface is, the lower the speed should be.

> If you want to drive on very steep uphill or downhill gradients, make sure beforehand that the engine oil and coolant levels are near the MAX mark, refer to page 259. BMW X5: you can operate your vehicle on uphill and downhill gradients with a maxi- mum slope of 50%.

> On very steep downhill slopes, use Hill Descent Control HDC, refer to page 98. BMW X5: it is possible to start off on inclines of up to 33%. The permissible body roll is 50%.

> While driving, watch carefully for obstacles such as rocks or holes. Try to avoid these obstacles whenever possible.

> Make sure that the undercarriage does not touch the ground, for example on crests and bumpy roads. The ground clearance of the vehicle is a maximum of approx. 8 in/20 cm. Please note that the ground clearance can vary depending on loading and the driving conditions of the vehicle.

> Only drive through road surface water up to a maximum water depth of

> BMW X5 20 in/50 cm

> BMW X6 17 in/45 cm

and only drive at walking speed; do not remain stationary.

> After driving through water at low speed, lightly press the brake pedal several times to dry the brakes and to prevent the braking effect from being reduced by wetness.

> Depending on the condition of the surface, it may be practical to briefly activate DTC, refer to DTC Dynamic Traction Control on page 97.

> If the drive wheels spin on one side, depress the accelerator pedal sufficiently so that the driving stability control systems can distrib- ute the drive forces to the individual wheels.

Please note the following points after driving on poor roads to maintain the driving safety of your BMW:

> Clean the coarsest dirt from the body.

> Clean mud, snow, ice etc. from the wheels and tires and check the tires for damage.

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

145

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Navigation This chapter describes how you can

enter destinations and specify your route so that your navigation system guides you

reliably to your destination.

S ta

rt in

g n

av ig

at io

n s

ys te

m

148

Starting navigation system

Your navigation system can use satellites to ascertain the precise position of your vehicle and guide you reliably to any destination you enter.

Navigation DVD The navigation system requires a special navi- gation DVD. The latest version is available at your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center.

Inserting navigation DVD

Use the lower drive for navigation DVD.

1. Insert the navigation DVD with the labeled side up. The navigation DVD is automatically pulled in.

2. Allow several seconds for the system to scan the data from the DVD.

Removing navigation DVD 1. Press the button 1.

The DVD emerges slightly from the drive.

2. Remove the DVD.

If the DVD is not ejected from the drive, it is pos- sible that it is blocked. In this case a message is also shown on the Control Display.

Display in assistance window You can display the route or the current position in the assistance window. This display remains visible even if you change to another applica- tion.

1. Move the controller to the right to change to the assistance window.

2. Press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

3. Select the desired route view or "Current position".

4. Press the controller.

Displaying arrow view in map view If the navigation system suggests a change of direction, the arrow view is briefly displayed.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

*

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

149

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

4. Turn the controller until "Language / Units" is selected and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Languages" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Arrow display pop-up instructions" and press the controller.

The arrow view appears in the assistance window.

D es

ti n

at io

n e

n tr

y

150

Destination entry

In entering your destination you can select from among the following options:

> Entering a destination manually, see below

> Entering destination via voice*, refer to page 153

> Selecting destination using information, refer to page 156

> Selecting destination from a list, refer to Destination list, page 157

> Selecting destination from address book, refer to page 158

> Selecting home address, refer to page 160

After selecting your destination you can pro- ceed to start the destination guidance, refer to page 162.

You can also store a navigation destination on the programmable memory buttons, refer to page 21.

Enter data only with the vehicle station- ary, and always give priority to the appli-

cable traffic regulations in the event of any con- tradiction between traffic and road conditions and the instructions issued by the navigation system. If you do not observe this precaution, you can endanger the vehicle occupants and other road users.<

Opening navigation system iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller to the right to open "Navigation".

3. Select "Navigation" and press the control- ler.

The Control Display shows:

> the arrow view or map view during destina- tion guidance

> the destination list when destination guid- ance is switched off

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

151

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Entering a destination manually The system's word matching principle makes it easier for you to enter the names of streets or towns/cities, refer to page 161. This allows you to enter different spellings and completes your entry automatically so that stored names can be called up quickly.

1. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Navigation" is selected and press the controller. "New destination" is selected.

2. Press the controller.

3. Select "Enter address" and press the con- troller.

The system also supports you with the follow- ing features:

> If you do not enter a street, the system will guide you to the downtown area of a town or city.

> You can skip the entry of country and town/ city if the current entries should be retained for your new destination.

Selecting country 1. Select "State / Province" or the displayed

country and press the controller.

The list of available countries appears on the display.

2. Select the country of destination and press the controller.

In order to be able to start the destination guid- ance, at least the town/city of the destination or its zip code must be entered.

Entering destination via town/city name 1. Select "Town / City" or the displayed town/

city and press the controller.

2. Select the starting letter and press the con- troller. A list of all towns/cities starting with this let- ter appears on the Control Display.

3. To delete the letter entered if necessary:

> Delete individual numbers or letters: Move the controller toward the right to select and press the controller.

> Delete all numbers or letters: Move the controller toward the right to select and press the controller longer.

D es

ti n

at io

n e

n tr

y

152

4. If necessary, enter more letters. The list gradually grows smaller each time you enter a new letter.

> Enter blank space if necessary: Select the symbol and press the con- troller.

5. Change to the third field from the top if nec- essary. Turn the controller until the town/ city name is selected from the list and press the controller.

Entering destination via zip code 1. Select "Town / City" and press the control-

ler.

2. Enter the zip code: Select the desired digits and press the con- troller.

> Enter a blank space: Select the symbol and press the con- troller.

> Delete individual numbers or letters: Move the controller toward the right to select and press the controller.

> Delete all numbers or letters: Move the controller toward the right to select and press the controller longer.

3. Select the zip code and press the controller. The corresponding destination is displayed.

4. Change into the third field from the top. Turn the controller until the destination is selected and press the controller.

Entering street, house number and intersection After the street you can also enter the intersec- tion or the house number.

Entering street and intersection 1. Select "Street" or the displayed street and

press the controller.

2. Enter the street. The street is entered exactly like the desti- nation.

The intersection is entered in the same way as the street.

Entering a street without entering a town/city of destination You can also enter a street without entering a town/city of destination. In this case all streets of the entered country are offered for selection.

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

153

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

The related town/city is displayed after the street name.

If a town/city has already been entered, you can undo this entry. This may be practical if the desired street does not exist in the entered des- tination, because, for example, it belongs to another part of the town/city.

1. Change to upper field. The arrow is selected.

2. Turn the controller to the right until the request for the entry of a street in the coun- try appears and press the controller.

3. Change to the second field from the top and enter the street.

Entering house number All house numbers stored for the street on the navigation DVD can be entered.

1. Select "House number" and press the con- troller.

2. Enter the house number: Select the desired digits and press the con- troller.

3. Change into the third field from the top. Turn the controller until the house number is selected and press the controller.

Starting destination guidance with manual destination entry

> Select "Start guidance" and press the con- troller. Destination guidance starts immediately.

> If the destination guidance does not need to be started immediately: Select "Add to destination list" and press the controller. The destination is stored in the destination list, refer to page 157.

Entering destination via voice* You can enter a desired destination with the voice activation system. When entering the destination, it is possible to change between voice command and iDrive at any time. Reacti- vate the voice command system for this pur- pose if necessary.

With {Options} you can have the possible commands read aloud.<

1. Press the button on the steering wheel.

2. {Enter address}

D es

ti n

at io

n e

n tr

y

154

Selecting country 1. Wait for the system to ask for the country of

destination.

Say the name of the country of destination in the language of the voice activation system.

Entering destination The destination can be spelled or entered as an entire word.

Spelling destination To enter the destination, spell it using the orthography of the country of destination. Pronounce the letters smoothly and at normal volume, avoiding excessive emphasis and pauses.

The system can suggest up to 20 destina- tions that match your entries. Up to 6 entries are displayed at once on the Con- trol Display.

The town/city can also be selected from the list via iDrive: Turn the controller until the destination is selected and press the controller.

Entering destination as an entire word* Towns/cities and streets located in the region where the language of the voice activation sys- tem is spoken can be entered as an entire word.

Example: to enter a destination located in the US as an entire word, the language of the sys- tem must be English.

Speak smoothly and at normal volume, avoiding excessive emphases and pauses.

1. Wait for the system to request the destina- tion.

The system can suggest up to 6 destina- tions that match your entries.

The town/city can also be selected from the list via iDrive: Turn the controller until the destination is selected and press the controller.

Destinations that sound the same which cannot be differentiated by the system

are summarized in a separate list and shown as a destination followed by three dots.

2. Say the name of the country of destina- tion.

1. Spell town/city name: Say at least the first three letters of the destination. The more letters you say, the more exactly the system recognizes the town/city.

A destination is suggested by the system.

2. Select city/town:

> Choose selected city/town: {Yes}

> Select other city/town: {No}

> Select entry, e.g. {Entry 3}

> Display additional entries of the list: {Next page}

> Spell the city/town again: {Repeat}

2. Say the name of the destination.

A destination is suggested by the system.

3. Select city/town:

> Choose selected city/town: {Yes}

> Select other city/town: {No}

> Select entry, e.g. {Entry 3}

> Enter city/town again: {Repeat}

> To enter the town/city by spelling: {Spell}

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

155

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Select this entry with {Yes} if necessary. Then select the desired city/town in this list.<

Entering street and house number The street is entered in the same way as the destination.

To enter the house number:

Up to 4-digit house numbers can be entered. Say the house number as individual numbers.

Starting destination guidance

Destination guidance starts immediately.

Saving destination The destination is added to the destination list or can be stored in the address book.

Selecting destination via map If you only know the location of the town/city or street of the destination, then you can enter the destination by using a map. You can use the cursor to select the destination on the map and then apply it in the destination guidance.

1. Select "Navigation" and press the control- ler. "New destination" is selected.

2. Press the controller.

3. Select "Input map" and press the controller.

A section of a map is displayed on the Con- trol Display:

> During destination guidance, around the current destination

> With the destination guidance deacti- vated, around the last destination entered

4. Select destination with cursor.

> Changing scale: turn the controller.

> Moving map: move the controller in the corresponding direction. The controller can be moved to the left, right, forward and back.

5. To apply or store the destination in the des- tination guidance, press the controller. The selected destination and other menu items are displayed.

6. Select the desired menu item:

> "Start route guidance" starts destination guidance.

> "Show current position" places the cur- rent position in the center of the map.

> "Show destination position" places the current destination in the center of the map.

1. {House number}

2. Say the house number.

{Start guidance}

{Add to destination list} or {Add to address book}

D es

ti n

at io

n e

n tr

y

156

> "Return to map" changes back to the "Input map".

> Exit the menu.

7. Press the controller.

The map for the destination entry can also be displayed in the map display: Select the symbol and press the controller.

Selecting destination using information You can obtain a display of selected destina- tions, e.g. hotels, sights or hospitals, and apply them in the destination guidance.

1. Select "Navigation" and press the control- ler.

2. Select "Information" and press the control- ler.

3. Select location:

> "On destination"

> "On location"

> "On a new destination"

4. Press the controller.

5. Make your selection, e.g. "Hotels and res- taurants", and press the controller.

6. Enter search criteria if necessary, e.g. the maximum distance from the current loca- tion.

7. Select " " and press the con- troller. These destinations are displayed on the Control Display.

8. Select a destination and press the control- ler.

The scope of the information and symbols is dependent on the respec-

tive navigation DVD.<

9. Select the desired menu item:

> To apply the address in the destination list and start the destination guidance: Select the symbol and press the controller.

> To establish a telephone connection: Select the symbol and press the con- troller.

> To display additional destinations: Select the symbol and press the controller.

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

157

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

> To start a new search: Select the symbol and press the con- troller.

To exit from the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

Symbols in map view If, for example, you have selected the category Hotels and have started the search, the hotels are shown on the map as symbols.

To hide the symbols in the map view:

1. Select the symbol and press the control- ler.

2. Select "Hide map icons" and press the con- troller.

The symbols are hidden.

To display the symbols: Select "Show map icons" and press the con- troller.

To exit from the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

Destination list The last 20 entered destinations are shown in the destination list. You can display these desti- nations and apply them in the destination guid- ance. For example, to plan a longer route, you can store all destinations you want to drive to in advance in the destination list, refer to Entering a destination manually on page 151.

Select "Navigation" and press the controller.

The last destination entered is the first item in the destination list.

This symbol indicates the current destina- tion during destination guidance.

To display additional destinations from the des- tination list: Turn the controller.

Applying destination in destination guidance 1. Select the desired destination and press

the controller.

2. Select "Start guidance" and press the con- troller.

Editing destination list 1. Select the desired destination in the desti-

nation list and press the controller.

2. The selected destination can be edited:

> Store entry: Select "Add to address book".

> Display information on destination: Select "Information on destination".

> Delete entry: Select "Delete entry".

D es

ti n

at io

n e

n tr

y

158

> Delete all entries: Select "Delete list". The destination guidance is switched off.

> Change entry: Select "Edit". For operation, refer to Entering destination via town/city name, page 151.

3. Press the controller.

Address book

Opening address book iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

Select "Address book" and press the controller.

Storing destinations in address book You can store approx. 100 destinations in the address book.

1. Select "Address book" and press the con- troller.

2. Select "New address" and press the con- troller.

3. Select "Enter address" and press the con- troller.

4. Enter name and address, also refer to Entering a destination manually, page 151.

5. Select "Store in address book" and press the controller. The entry is stored in the address book.

You can also store a destination from the desti- nation list into the address book, refer to page 157.

Storing current position* The current position can be applied in the address book.

1. Select "Address book" and press the con- troller.

2. Change into the third field from the top. Turn the controller until "New address" is selected and press the controller.

3. Select "Use current location as address" and press the controller. The name given can be changed. For oper- ation, refer to Entering a destination manu- ally, page 151.

4. Select "Store in address book" and press the controller.

You can also apply your current position in the address book if you have left the sector covered by the navigation DVD. In this case, you must enter a name.

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

159

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Selecting destinations from address book 1. Select "Address book" and press the con-

troller. The stored entries appear on the Control Display.

2. Select the entry and press the controller.

To start the destination guidance: Select "Start guidance" and press the control- ler.

Changing destinations from address book 1. Select "Address book" and press the con-

troller.

2. Select the entry and press the controller.

3. Select "Edit address" and press the con- troller.

4. Change entry. For operation, refer to Entering a destina- tion manually, page 151.

5. Select "Store in address book" and press the controller.

Deleting individual destinations from address book 1. Select "Address book" and press the con-

troller.

2. Select the entry and press the controller.

3. Select "Delete address" and press the con- troller.

Deleting all destinations from address book 1. Open the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Delete data" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Delete address book" and press the controller.

7. Select "Yes" and press the controller.

D es

ti n

at io

n e

n tr

y

160

Home address You can store your current position or the cur- rent destination as the home address in the address book. This entry occupies the second position in the address book.

Storing home address 1. Select "Address book" and press the con-

troller.

2. Change into the third field from the top. Turn the controller until "Home address" is selected and press the controller.

3. Select "Use current location as address", or "Save current destination" during the desti- nation guidance, and press the controller.

4. Select "Store in address book" and press the controller.

Applying home address as destination 1. Select "Home address" and press the con-

troller.

2. Select "Start guidance" and press the con- troller.

Changing home address 1. Select "Home address" and press the con-

troller.

2. Select "Edit address" and press the con- troller. For operation, refer to Entering a destination manually, page 151.

Selecting route You can influence the calculated route by choosing certain route criteria. You can change the route criteria as often as you like while entering the destination and whenever the des- tination guidance is active.

The route is planned according to fixed rules. The road type is taken into account, e.g. whether it is a highway or a winding road. The road types are stored on the navigation DVD. As a result, the routes recommended by the navigation system may not always be the same ones that you would choose based on personal experience.

Changing route criteria 1. Select "Navigation" and press the control-

ler.

2. Change into the third field from the top. Turn the controller until "Route preference" is selected and press the controller.

The various criteria are listed on the Control Display.

3. Select a route criterion for the route:

> "With highways" Freeways and major traffic arteries are given priority

> "Avoid highways" Freeways are avoided where possible

> "Fast route" The short traveling time, being a combi- nation of the shortest possible route and the fastest roads

> "Short route" Short route, irrespective of how fast or slow progress will be

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

161

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

4. Press the controller.

The route criterion is highlighted.

5. If necessary, select an additional route cri- terion and then press the controller:

> "Dynamic route" Automatic changing of the route in case of traffic obstructions. Depending on road type and the kind and extent of the traffic obstruction, the route can also be calculated so that you travel through the traffic obstruction.

> "Avoid tollroads" Tollroads are avoided where possible.

> "Avoid ferries" Ferries are avoided where possible.

To exit from the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

The route criteria can also be changed in the arrow or map display.

1. Select the symbol for the route criterion and press the controller.

2. Select a route criterion and press the con- troller.

If the route criteria "Avoid highways", "Avoid tollroads" or "Avoid ferries" are

selected, the calculation time for the route can increase considerably.<

Word matching principle The system supports the word matching princi- ple to make it easier for you to enter the names of streets or towns/cities. The system runs ongoing checks, comparing your destination entries with the data stored on the navigation DVD as the basis for instant response. The user benefits include:

> Names of specific locations can also vary from the official versions if you are using a spelling that is customary in another coun- try.

Example:

Instead of "Mnchen", you can also enter the English spelling "Munich" or the Italian spelling "Monaco".

> When you are entering the names of towns/ cities and streets the system will complete them automatically as soon as enough let- ters are available to ensure unambiguous identification.

> The system only accepts name entries beginning with letters that are stored on the navigation DVD. The system will not accept non existent names and addresses.

D es

ti n

at io

n g

u id

an ce

162

Destination guidance

Starting destination guidance

Via iDrive iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Navigation" is selected and press the controller.

2. Select a destination from the destination list and press the controller or enter a new des- tination, refer to page 150.

3. Select "Start guidance" and press the con- troller.

After the route has been calculated, destination guidance is indicated by arrows or a map dis- play on the Control Display.

The destination guidance can also be started in the arrow or map view: Select the symbol and press the controller.

During destination guidance, you can operate other equipment via iDrive at any time. You will be punctually notified of a change of direction

by spoken instructions and the display of the direction arrow.

Via programmable memory buttons Press the ... button on which the desired destination is stored, also refer to page 22.

Ending/continuing destination guidance

In arrow or map display

Select the symbol and press the controller.

In destination list This symbol indicates the current destina-

tion.

1. Select the current destination and press the controller.

2. Select "Stop guidance" and press the con- troller.

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

163

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

When you park the vehicle before reaching the entered destination, the following question is displayed before beginning the next trip: "Continue guidance to destination?".

The destination guidance starts automatically after a short time.

To start the destination guidance: Select "Yes" and press the controller.

Displaying route You have the option of displaying various views of the route during destination guidance.

From another menu, you can change directly to the screen last displayed,

refer to Comfort opening of menu items, page 18.<

Displaying arrow display 1. Select "Navigation" and press the control-

ler.

2. Change into the fourth field from the top. Turn the controller until "Arrow display" is selected and press the controller.

The arrow display is shown.

1 Switching voice instructions on/off

2 Selecting route criteria

3 Starting/ending destination guidance

4 Arrow to destination from a bird's eye view

5 Distance to the next change of direction

6 Current position

7 Direction of travel

> Outline arrow: Destination guidance on the calculated route

> Solid arrow: Arrow shows the route to be calculated from a bird's eye view when the vehicle is not located in an area contained on the navigation DVD, e.g. in a multilevel park- ing lot.

Depending on the equipment, the estimated time of arrival and the distance to the destina- tion are displayed in the top or bottom line of the Control Display.

Before a change in direction, the representation of the arrow changes.

1 Street name for change of direction

2 Distance up to change of direction

3 Change of direction

D es

ti n

at io

n g

u id

an ce

164

To exit from the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

Displaying map view You can have your current position displayed on a map. After starting the destination guidance, the planned route is shown on the map.

1. Select "Navigation" and press the control- ler.

2. Change into the fourth field from the top. Turn the controller until the desired map view is selected:

> "Map facing north"

> "Map direction of travel"

> "Perspective"

3. Press the controller.

1 Switching voice instructions on/off

2 Starting/ending destination guidance

3 Selecting destination via map

4 Displaying the menu in which the informa- tion last selected can be displayed/hidden, refer to Selecting destination using infor- mation, page 156

5 Changing map display

> "Map facing north"

> "Map direction of travel"

> "Perspective"

6 Changing route criteria

7 Manually displaying traffic information* 8 Arrow to destination from a bird's eye view

The estimated time of arrival and the distance to the destination are shown in the bottom line of the Control Display.

To exit from the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

At scales of less than 250 miles/500 km, you have the option of deciding whether to orient the map to north, toward your current direction of travel, or show the map in perspective. At scales of 250 miles/500 km or greater, the map always points toward north.

Changing map display

Select the corresponding symbol and press the controller. The next map display is displayed.

Changing scale Turn the controller to change the scale.

Displaying roads and towns/cities of route You can have the roads and towns/cities along the route displayed during destination guid- ance.

The distances remaining to be traveled on each individual route are also displayed.

1. Select "Navigation" and press the control- ler.

2. Change into the third field from the top. Turn the controller until "Route list" is selected and press the controller.

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

165

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

To exit from the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

Destination guidance via voice instructions

Switching voice instructions on/off

Voice instructions can be switched on or off during the destination guidance in the arrow or map view: Select the symbol and press the controller.

To switch the voice instructions on and off at any time:

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

4. Turn the controller until "Language / Units" is selected and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Languages" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Navigation voice instructions" and press the controller.

The voice instructions are switched on.

Repeating and canceling voice instructions With the programmable buttons on the steering wheel you can also make the following settings, refer to page 59:

> Repeat the voice instruction: Press the button.

> Switch voice instructions on/off: Hold the button down.

D es

ti n

at io

n g

u id

an ce

166

Setting volume of voice instructions The volume can only be adjusted while a voice instruction is being output.

1. Repeat the last voice instruction, if neces- sary.

2. Turn the knob during the voice instruction to select the desired volume.

This volume is independent of the volume of the audio sources.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Changing route During destination guidance, you can revise the navigation system's route recommendations to avoid particular stretches of road. Enter the number of miles/kilometers that you want to travel before returning to the original route.

1. Select "Navigation" and press the control- ler.

2. Change into the third field from the top. Turn the controller until "New route" is selected and press the controller.

3. Turn the controller to enter the desired number and press the controller.

The route is recalculated.

To exit from the menu without changing the route:

Select the arrow and press the controller.

Traffic information* In many congested areas, you can receive traf- fic information transmitted by radio stations. The traffic conditions are monitored by traffic management centers and the traffic information is periodically updated. During destination guidance, the traffic infor- mation relevant to your planned route is auto- matically displayed and, if you wish, taken into account in the route planning. Whether destina- tion guidance is active or not, you can have the traffic information displayed in the map view or in the traffic info list.

Switching reception of traffic information on/off iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

4. Turn the controller until "Traffic Info set- tings" is selected and press the controller.

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

167

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

5. Select "Traffic Info" and press the control- ler.

The traffic information can be received and displayed.

"AUTO": automatic selection of the Traffic Info station with the strongest reception.

Depending on the station, either the sta- tion name, frequency, local number or

other information is displayed.<

Manually displaying traffic information

During destination guidance During destination guidance, traffic information can be displayed in the arrow or map view.

If the symbol is shown with a red border, traf- fic information is available for the planned route.

Select the symbol and press the controller.

During destination guidance, the traffic infor- mation on the planned route is marked with a yellow diamond.

First the traffic information along the planned route is shown sorted according to the distance to the current vehicle position.

With destination guidance switched off 1. Open the start menu.

2. Move the controller to the right to open "Navigation".

3. Select "Traffic Info" and press the control- ler.

First the traffic information along the planned route is shown sorted according to the distance to the current vehicle position.

Depiction of traffic information in map view The traffic information symbols are shown in the map view up to a scale of 100 miles/200 km.

The section of the route affected by a traffic report as well as the indication for the type of incident, which will be described below, are dis- played and hidden. This occurs as a function of the scale selected.

D es

ti n

at io

n g

u id

an ce

168

Displaying detailed traffic information Select traffic information from the displayed list and press the controller.

To exit from the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

Symbols for traffic information

Traffic event with map scales greater than 5 miles/10 km, arrow points in the direction of travel concerned.

Several traffic events have been received. Select a smaller scale to display these individually.

Traffic light failure

Roadwork

General traffic obstruction Transport of hazardous load Vehicle on wrong carriage way

Danger

Low clearance

No parking

Fog

Heavy rain

Slippery road

Cross winds

Smog

Road closed

Slow traffic

Traffic back up

Stopped traffic

Icy roads

Uneven surface

Accident

Lane closure

Delay

Police checkpoint

Slow traffic or other traffic event

Stop-and-go traffic

Stopped traffic

Traffic event in both directions of travel

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

169

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Traffic information during destination guidance If there are traffic obstructions on the planned route, the traffic information symbols are dis- played with a red border.

System response will vary depending on whether or not "Dynamic route" is selected, refer to page 160.

Displaying traffic obstructions If a traffic obstruction is reported to the naviga- tion system and "Dynamic route" is not selected, then you will be provided with certain information from a distance of approx. 25 miles/ 40 km, e.g. the length of the traffic jam. The last possible junction will be displayed shortly before this.

Select "Detour" and press the controller. The navigation system determines a new route to bypass the traffic congestion.

This information is displayed even if you have activated a different function on the Control Display.

Dynamic route planning When "Dynamic route" is selected, the route will be changed automatically in the event of a traffic obstruction. The system does not point out traffic obstructions along the original route. Depending on road type and the kind and extent of the traffic obstruction, the calculated route may nevertheless lead through the traffic obstruction.

Displaying current position You can have your current position displayed even when the destination guidance is switched off.

1. Select "Navigation" and press the control- ler.

2. Change into the fourth field from the top. Turn the controller until "Current position" is selected and press the controller.

The current position of your BMW is displayed.

If the navigation system is unable to identify a town or city, your current map coordinates will appear.

To exit from the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

You can also have the current position dis- played on a map, refer to page 164.

W h

at to

d o

if

170

What to do if

What to do if

> a navigation DVD is inserted, but an instruc- tion to insert the DVD appears on the Con- trol Display? The navigation DVD may not be the correct DVD for the navigation system. This infor- mation is indicated on the DVD label.

> you request the current position of your vehicle, but do not receive a precise dis- play? The system is unable to receive enough GPS signals at your current position due to obstructions, your position is not yet avail- able on your navigation DVD, or the system is in the process of calculating your posi- tion. Reception is best when you have an unobstructed view to the sky.

> the destination guidance does not accept a destination? The data of the destination is not stored on the navigation DVD that is loaded. Select a destination that is as close as possible to the original.

> the destination guidance does not accept an address without the street name? On the navigation DVD, no downtown area can be determined for the city or town entered. Enter any street, or a destination such as the railway station in the selected town, and then start the destination guid- ance.

> you want to enter a destination for the des- tination guidance, but it is not possible to select the letters for your desired entry? The data of the destination is not stored on the navigation DVD that is loaded. In this case, the system will not offer you any let- ters to choose from. Select a destination that is as close as possible to the original.

> the system stops furnishing directions on which way to turn as you approach intersec- tions? You are driving in an area that has not yet been completely recorded on the naviga- tion DVD. Instead of an arrow indicating a turn, you will see an arrow which indicates the general direction of your planned route. Or you have left the recommended route and the system requires a few seconds to calculate a new recommended route.

> the navigation system does not react to entries? If the battery was disconnected, it takes about 10 minutes before the system is once again operational.

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

171

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Entertainment Operation of the radio and CD as well as their

tone settings are described in this chapter.

O n

/O ff

a n

d s

et ti

n g

s

174

On/Off and settings

The following audio sources have shared con- trols and setting options:

> Radio

> CD player

> CD changer*

Controls The audio sources can be controlled using:

> Buttons in the area of the CD player

> iDrive

> Buttonson steering wheel, refer to page 11

> Programmable memory buttons, refer to page 21

Buttons on CD player

Equipment with a single drive

1 Entertainment sound output on/off, volume

> Press: switch on/off. When the system is switched on, the most recently selected radio station or CD track is played.

> Turn: adjust volume.

2 Eject CD

3 Drive for audio CDs

4 Station scan/track search

> Change radio station.

> Select track for CD player and CD changer.

Equipment with two drives

1 Entertainment sound output on/off, volume

> Press: switch on/off. When the system is switched on, the most recently selected radio station or CD track is played.

> Turn: adjust volume.

2 Drive for audio CDs

3 Eject CD

4 Station scan/track search

> Change radio station.

> Select track for CD player and CD changer.

5 Drive for navigation DVDs

Operation via iDrive iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller backwards to open "Entertainment".

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

175

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

You have the following choices:

> "FM" and "AM": radio reception

> "WB": Weather Band station

> "SAT": satellite radio* > "CD": CD player or changer* > "AUX": AUX-In connection, USB audio

interface* > "Set": depending on the audio source,

other adjustments can be made, e.g. with the radio: update station with strongest reception, store station, tone control, sam- ple stations.

From another menu, you can change directly to the screen last displayed,

refer to Comfort opening of menu items, page 18.<

From radio readiness, the selected audio source is stored for the remote control currently in use.

Switching on/off To switch the Entertainment sound output on and off: Press knob 1 on the CD player.

This symbol on the Control Display indi- cates that sound output is switched off.

For equipment with a single drive, the sound output is available for approx. 20 minutes with the ignition switched off. Switch on the sound output again for this pur- pose.

Adjusting volume Turn knob 1 on the CD player until the desired volume is set.

You can also adjust the volume with buttons on the steering wheel, refer to page 11.

From radio readiness, the setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.

Tone control You can alter various tone settings, e.g. treble and bass, or the speed-dependent volume increase. The tone settings are set for all audio sources at once.

From radio readiness, the settings are stored for the remote control currently in use.

Changing tone settings 1. Press the button.

This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

4. Select "Audio" or "Tone / Volume" and press the controller.

The tone settings can also be selected when you have opened "Entertainment" in the start menu: Select "Set" and then "Tone", and press the controller.

Treble and bass 1. Select "Treble / Bass" and press the con-

troller.

O n

/O ff

a n

d s

et ti

n g

s

176

2. Move the controller to the left or right to select "Treble" or "Bass".

3. Turn the controller until the desired setting is selected.

Balance and fader You can adjust the volume distribution in the same manner as "Treble / Bass".

> "Balance": left/right volume distribution

> "Fader": front/rear volume distribution

Speed-dependent volume control The speed-dependent volume control auto- matically increases the volume with increasing speed. You can set various stages for the increase in volume.

When equipped with two drives:

1. Select "Speed volume" and press the con- troller.

2. Turn the controller: The adjustment is applied; the field can be changed.

When equipped with a single drive:

1. Select "Volume settings" and press the controller.

2. Change to the second field from the top if necessary. Select "Speed volume" and press the controller.

3. Turn the controller: The adjustment is applied; the field can be changed.

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

177

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

Professional HiFi System* You can choose between stereo and multichan- nel playback, surround.

1. Select "Surround Settings" and press the controller.

2. Select "Stereo" or "Surround".

3. Press the controller. The spatial sound effect is activated.

Equalizer* You can set individual sound frequency ranges.

1. Select "Equalizer" and press the controller.

2. Move the controller to the left or right to select the desired frequency range.

3. Turn the controller until the desired setting is selected.

Resetting tone settings You can reset all tone settings to the default settings.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

4. Select "Audio" and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Reset" is selected and press the controller.

6. When equipped with two drives: Select "Yes" and press the controller.

R ad

io

178

Radio

Your radio provides reception of the FM and AM wavebands.

Listening to radio

Press the knob if the sound output is switched off.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller backwards to open "Entertainment".

3. Change to upper field if necessary. Select "FM" or "AM".

4. Press the controller.

Stations are shown on the Control Display on the basis of various selection criteria, e.g. "Presets".

If "Autostore" does not display any stations or if the stations displayed can no longer be received in the AM reception range, update the stations with the best reception, refer to page 179.

Changing stations

Turn the controller.

Buttons on CD player Press the button for the corresponding direction. The system changes to the next displayed sta- tion. You can also change stations with the buttons on the steering wheel, refer to page 11.

Changing selection criteria In addition to the stations currently displayed, you can have stations with another selection criterion displayed.

You can choose from the following selection criteria:

> "All stations"*: Stations that can currently be received in the "FM" waveband.

> "Autostore": The stations with the strongest received signals in the "AM" waveband. With High Definition Radio: the stations with the strongest received signals in the "FM" waveband.

> "Presets": Stations you have previously stored, refer to page 180.

> "Manual": To set stations that can be received in addi- tion to those displayed, refer to Selecting frequency manually on page 179.

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

179

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

To change the selection criterion:

1. Change into the second field from the top.

2. Select the selection criterion and press the controller.

Sampling stations, scan The system automatically plays a brief sample from each of the stations on the current wave- band.

1. Select "FM" or "AM" and press the control- ler. "Set" is selected.

2. Press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

3. Select "Scan" and press the controller.

The stations are sampled.

To end sampling:

1. Press the controller.

2. Select "Scan" and press the controller.

This cancels sampling of the stations, and the radio remains on the current station.

Buttons on CD player To sample the stations, press and hold the

button for the corresponding direction.

To end scanning, press the button again.

Selecting frequency manually With "Manual" you can select stations that can be received in addition to those displayed.

1. Select "FM" or "AM" and press the control- ler.

2. Change into the second field from the top.

3. Select "Manual" and press the controller.

4. Turn the controller to set a certain fre- quency.

Updating stations with best reception If you are on a longer journey and leave the transmission range of the stations originally set, you can update the list of stations in the AM range with the best reception.

1. Select "AM" and press the controller.

2. Change into the second field from the top.

3. Select "Autostore" and press the controller. "Set" is selected.

4. Press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

R ad

io

180

5. Select "Autostore" and press the controller.

The display of the stations with the strongest reception is updated. The frequencies of the stations are displayed.

Storing stations

Via iDrive 1. Select "FM" or "AM" and press the control-

ler.

2. Change into the second field from the top. Turn the controller until the desired selec- tion criterion is selected and press the con- troller.

3. Select the desired frequency or station. "Set" is selected.

4. Press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

5. Select "Store" and press the controller.

"Presets" is displayed.

6. Turn the controller until the desired mem- ory position is selected.

7. Press the controller. The station is stored.

The stations of the last selection criterion are displayed once again after a short time.

From radio readiness, the stations are stored for the remote control currently in use.

Via programmable memory buttons You can also store a station on the programma- ble memory buttons, also refer to page 21.

1. Select a station.

2. Press and hold the desired button ... .

Changing a memory position 1. Select "Presets" and press the controller.

2. Select the desired station. "Set" is selected.

3. Press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

4. Select "Store" and press the controller.

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

181

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

5. Turn the controller until the desired mem- ory position is selected. The number of the memory position appears beside the name or frequency of the station.

6. Press the controller. The station is stored.

RDS Radio Data System In the FM frequency range, additional informa- tion is transmitted via RDS. If the reception con- ditions are good, the station names are shown on the Control Display. If the reception is weak or disrupted, it can take some time before the station names are displayed.

Switching RDS on/off 1. Select "FM" and press the controller.

"Set" is selected.

2. Press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

3. Select "RDS" and press the controller.

RDS is activated.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

High Definition Radio* Many stations transmit both analog and digital signals. You can receive these stations digitally and with improved sound quality.

A digital radio network must be available in order to receive digital stations.

Activating/deactivating digital radio reception iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

4. Select "Audio" and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field. Turn the controller until "HD radio" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Off" and press the controller.

The reception of digital stations is acti- vated.

This symbol is displayed when a station is being received digitally.

R ad

io

182

With some stations the digital signals are not transmitted simultaneously with the analog sig- nals. If you are in an area in which the selected station is not continuously received digitally, playback changes between analog and digital reception. This can result in repetitions or inter- ruptions. In this case it may be advisable to deactivate digital radio reception.

Selecting programs of a digital station* Some stations transmit several programs on one frequency. To select one of these pro- grams:

1. Select "FM" or "AM" and press the control- ler.

2. Select "Manual" and press the controller.

3. Select a station that is received digitally. This symbol is displayed when a station

is being received digitally.

4. Switch to the next program of the digital station with the buttons on the radio or the steering wheel.

You can store a station, refer to page 180.

Updating stations offering digital reception If you are on a longer journey and leave the transmission range of the stations originally set, you can update the list of stations with the best reception.

1. Select "FM" or "AM" and press the control- ler.

2. Change into the second field from the top.

3. Select "Autostore" and press the controller.

4. Press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

5. Select "Autostore " and press the con- troller.

The display of the stations offering digital reception is updated. This can take up to 2 min- utes.

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

183

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

Displaying additional information With the digital stations, additional information on the current track is displayed, e.g. the name of the artist.

1. Select a station and press the controller.

2. Select "Details" and press the controller.

The information is displayed.

If a digital station is received again when the station is changed, the additional information will be displayed again following a brief interrup- tion.

Weather news flashes* Weather Radio is a service of the National Oce- anic and Atmospheric Administration (NOAA) of the US Department of Trade. Weather news flashes are repeated every four to six minutes and are routinely updated at intervals of one to three hours, and more often when necessary. Most stations operate 24 hours a day. In case of a storm, the National Weather Service inter- rupts the routine weather news and transmits special warning messages instead. If you have a question about NOAA Weather Radio, please contact the nearest office of the National

Weather Service. Details are also provided on the Internet at www.nws.noaa.gov.

Calling up weather news flashes 1. Select "WB" and press the controller.

2. Select a station.

The station for weather news flashes may be unavailable in some regions.

S at

el lit

e ra

d io

184

Satellite radio

You can receive over 100 different channels with high sound quality.

The channels are offered to you in predefined packages. To receive the channels of your choice, you must have this package enabled.

With this new technology the signal may fail, causing interruptions in reception.<

Enabling or disabling channels iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller backwards to open "Entertainment".

3. Select "SAT".

4. Press the controller.

The channels are displayed. These channels are enabled.

Enabling 1. Select a channel that has not yet been

enabled and press the controller. A telephone number and the electronic serial number, ESN, are displayed.

The electronic serial number is required for enabling or disabling.<

2. To enable the channel: Dial the phone number.

Disabling 1. Select an enabled channel and press the

controller.

2. Select "ESN" and press the controller. The electronic serial number, ESN, is dis- played.

The electronic serial number is required for disabling.<

3. To disable the channel: Dial the phone number.

*

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

185

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

Selecting and storing channel 1. Select "SAT" and press the controller.

Channels or categories appear on the Con- trol Display.

2. Select a menu item:

> "Presets": Up to twelve channels you have stored previously.

> "All channels": All channels are displayed.

> "Categories": All channels, sorted by categories, e.g. news, jazz.

3. Press the controller.

4. If "Categories" has been selected: Select the desired category and press the controller.

The channels of this category are displayed.

5. Select a channel marked with this sym- bol.

6. Press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

7. Select "Details" and press the controller.

Additional information The name of the channel and additional infor- mation on the current track are displayed, e.g. the name of the artist.

1 Artist

2 Track

S at

el lit

e ra

d io

186

Storing channel 1. Select desired channel.

2. Press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

3. Select "Store" and press the controller.

"Presets" is displayed.

4. Turn the controller to select a memory loca- tion and press the controller.

The channel is stored. The channels of the last selection criterion are displayed once again after a short time.

Changing channel with buttons on CD player Press the button for the corresponding direction. The system switches to the next enabled chan- nel.

Notes If no signal can be received for more than four seconds, a message is displayed on the Control Display.

Reception may not be possible for certain reasons, e.g. environmental influences or

topographical conditions. The satellite radio has no influence on this. The signal may not be available in tunnels or underground garages, next to tall buildings, near trees, mountains or other sources of radio interference. Reception is usually possible again as soon as the signal is available again.<

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

187

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

CD player and CD changer

Listening to CDs

When equipped with two drives: The upper drive is for audio CDs.

Compressed audio files CDs with compressed audio files, i.e. MP3, can be played by the CD player and CD changer.

Starting CD player

Inserting CD Insert the CD into the drive with the labeled side up. The CD is automatically pulled in. Playback starts automatically if the sound output is on. For CDs with compressed audio files, it can take up to approx. 1 minute to read in the data depending on the directory structure.

Via iDrive Starting playback when there is already a CD in the drive:

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller backwards to open "Entertainment".

3. Change to upper field if necessary. Select "CD" and press the controller.

4. Change to the second field from the top if necessary. On vehicles with a CD changer, select "CD" and press the controller to start the CD player.

Playback starts automatically if the sound out- put is switched on.

Via programmable memory buttons You can store the CD player function on the programmable memory buttons. To start the CD player, refer to page 21.

Starting CD changer Filling CD changer, refer to page 191.

Via iDrive 1. Press the button.

This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller backwards to open "Entertainment".

3. Change to upper field if necessary. Select "CD" and press the controller.

*

C D

p la

ye r a

n d

C D

c h

an g

er

188

4. Change to the second field from the top if necessary. Select the desired CD and press the controller.

At the end of the last track, the next CD will be selected.

Via programmable memory buttons You can store a CD compartment of the CD changer on the programmable memory but- tons. To start the CD changer, refer to page 21.

Selecting a track

Buttons on CD player Press the button for the corresponding direction repeatedly until you reach the desired track. The track is displayed on the Control Display. You can also change tracks using the buttons on the steering wheel, refer to page 11.

Via iDrive

Select a track by turning the controller.

Compressed audio files 1. Select the directory if necessary and press

the controller.

2. Select the track and press the controller.

To change the directory: Select the directory and press the controller.

To exit from the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

For equipment with two drives, you can save a certain track on the programmable memory buttons, refer to page 21.

Displaying information on track With compressed audio files, you can display any information stored on the current track, e.g. the name of the artist.

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

189

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

1. Press the controller.

2. Select "Details" and press the controller.

The information for the current track are dis- played.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Sampling tracks, scan The system automatically plays a brief sample from each of the tracks on the current CD.

1. Select "Set" and press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

2. Select "Scan" and press the controller.

To end sampling:

1. Press the controller.

2. Select "Scan" and press the controller.

This cancels sampling of the tracks, and the player remains on the current track.

Compressed audio files 1. Select the current track and press the con-

troller.

2. Select the desired menu item:

> To sample all tracks of the current direc- tory, select "Scan directory" and press the controller.

> To sample all tracks of the CD, select "Scan all" and press the controller.

To end sampling:

1. Press the controller.

2. Select "Scan directory" or "Scan all" and press the controller.

This cancels sampling, and the player remains on the current track.

Repeating a track 1. Select "Set" and press the controller.

Other menu items are displayed.

C D

p la

ye r a

n d

C D

c h

an g

er

190

2. Select "Repeat" and press the controller.

The current track on the CD is repeated.

To stop repeating:

1. Press the controller again.

2. Select "Repeat" and press the controller.

Compressed audio files 1. Select the current track and press the con-

troller.

2. Select the desired menu item:

> To repeat the selected track, select "Repeat track" and press the controller.

> To repeat all tracks of the current direc- tory, select "Repeat directory" and press the controller.

To stop repeating:

1. Press the controller.

2. Select "Repeat track" or "Repeat directory" and press the controller.

Random play sequence In this mode, the tracks on the current CD are played once in a random sequence.

1. Select "Set" and press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

2. Select "Random" and press the controller.

To stop random function:

1. Press the controller.

2. Select "Random" and press the controller.

Compressed audio files 1. Select the current track and press the con-

troller.

2. Select the desired menu item:

> To play all tracks of the current directory in random order, select "Random direc- tory" and press the controller.

> To play all tracks of the CD in random order, select "Random all" and press the controller.

To stop random function:

1. Press the controller.

2. Select "Random directory" or "Random all" and press the controller.

Fast forward/reverse Buttons on CD player:

Press and hold the button for the corre- sponding direction. The tracks can be listened to with some distor- tion.

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

191

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

CD changer

The BMW CD changer for six CDs is installed in the glove compartment.

Controls and displays

1 LEDs on CD bay Flash when the CD can be inserted.

2 Buttons for CD compartments LED lights up when CD compartment is filled.

Filling CD changer 1. Press the button.

The LED on the first empty compartment flashes.

2. Select another CD compartment if neces- sary: Press the ... button.

3. When the LEDs 1 on the CD bay flash, insert an individual CD. The CD is automatically pulled in and inserted into the selected CD compartment.

Do not push in the CD until the LEDs 1 on the CD bay are flashing;

otherwise, the CD or the CD changer may be damaged.

Do not continue to push on the CD; this may cause it to jam and prevent it from being able to eject again.<

4. To fill additional CD compartments: Repeat steps 1 to 3.

Filling empty CD compartments 1. Hold down the button.

The LEDs on the empty CD compartments flash.

2. When the LEDs 1 on the CD bay flash, insert an individual CD. The CD is automatically pulled in and inserted into the first available CD compart- ment.

Do not push in the CD until the LEDs 1 on the CD bay are flashing;

otherwise, the CD or the CD changer may be damaged. Do not continue to push on the CD; this may cause it to jam and prevent it from being able to eject again.<

3. Wait until the CD has been pulled in.

4. To fill additional CD compartments: Repeat steps 2 and 3.

Removing CDs from CD changer 1. Press the button.

2. Press the ... button to select the CD compartment. The CD is pushed partially out of the CD changer.

3. Remove the CD.

Removing all CDs from CD changer 1. Hold down the button.

The CDs are pushed partially out of the CD changer in sequence.

2. Remove the CDs.

C D

p la

ye r a

n d

C D

c h

an g

er

192

Notes BMW CD/DVD players and changers are officially designated Class 1 laser prod-

ucts. Do not operate if the cover is damaged, otherwise severe eye damage can result. Do not use self-recorded CDs/DVDs with labels applied as these can become detached during playback due to heat buildup and can cause irreparable damage to the device. Only use round CDs/DVDs with a standard diameter of 4.7 in/12 cm and do not play CDs/ DVDs with an adapter, e.g. CD singles, as other- wise the CD/DVD or the adapter can jam and may no longer eject properly. Do not use a combined CD/DVD, e.g. DVDPlus, otherwise the CD/DVD can jam and will no longer eject.<

General malfunctions BMW CD/DVD changers and players have been optimized for performance in vehicles. In some instances they may be more sensitive to faulty CDs/DVDs than stationary devices would be.

If a CD/DVD cannot be played, first check if it has been inserted correctly.

Humidity High levels of humidity can lead to condensa- tion on the CD/DVD or the laser's scan lens and temporarily prevent playback.

Malfunctions with individual CDs/DVDs If malfunctions occur only with particular CDs/ DVDs, this can be due to one of the following causes.

Filling CD/DVD changer or removing CDs/DVDs If all of the LEDs on the CD/DVD changer flash rapidly, then a malfunction is occurring.

To rectify the malfunction:

1. Press the button. The CD/DVD last inserted is ejected.

2. Remove the CD/DVD.

When the LEDs stop flashing rapidly, the CD/ DVD changer is once more operational.

Self-recorded CDs/DVDs Possible reasons for malfunctions with self- recorded CDs/DVDs are, e.g., inconsistent data-creation or recording processes, or poor quality or high age of the CD/DVD blank.

Only label CDs/DVDs on the upper side with a pen intended for this purpose.

Avoiding damage Avoid fingerprints, dust, scratches and mois- ture. Store CDs/DVDs in a sleeve. Do not subject CDs/DVDs to temperatures over 1226/506, high levels of humidity, or direct sunlight.

CDs/DVDs with copy protection CDs/DVDs are often provided with a copy pro- tection feature by the manufacturer. This can mean that some CDs/DVDs cannot be played or can only be played to a limited extent.

Care If necessary, clean the reflective scanning side of the CDs/DVDs with a commercially available cleaning cloth by wiping in straight lines from the center outward.

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

193

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

DVD changer

Installation position

The BMW DVD changer for six DVDs is installed in the glove compartment.

Controls and displays

1 LEDs on DVD bay Flash when the DVD can be inserted.

2 Buttons for DVD compartments The LED lights up when DVD compartment is filled.

Filling the DVD changer 1. Press the button.

The LED on the first empty compartment flashes.

2. Select another DVD compartment if neces- sary: Press the ... button.

3. When the LEDs 1 on the DVD bay flash, insert an individual DVD. The DVD is automatically pulled in and inserted into the selected DVD compart- ment.

Do not push in the DVD until the LEDs 1 on the DVD bay are flashing;

otherwise, the DVD or the DVD changer may be damaged. Do not continue to push on the DVD; this may cause it to jam and prevent it from being able to eject again.<

4. To fill additional DVD compartments: Repeat steps 1 to 3.

Filling empty DVD compartments 1. Hold down the button.

The LEDs on the empty DVD compart- ments flash.

2. When the LEDs 1 on the DVD bay flash, insert an individual DVD. The DVD is automatically pulled in and inserted into the first available DVD com- partment.

Do not continue to push on the DVDs; this may cause them to jam and pre-

vent them from being able to eject again.<

3. Wait until the DVD has been pulled in and the LEDs 1 on the DVD bay are flashing again.

Do not push in the DVD until the LEDs 1 on the DVD bay are flashing;

otherwise, the DVD or the DVD changer may be damaged.<

4. To fill additional DVD compartments: Repeat steps 2 and 3.

Removing DVDs from the DVD changer 1. Press the button.

2. Press the ... button in order to select the DVD compartment. The DVD is pushed partially out of the DVD changer.

3. Remove the DVD.

If the DVD is not removed, it is pulled back in again after about 10 seconds.<

*

D V

D c

h an

g er

194

Removing all DVDs from DVD changer 1. Hold down the button.

The DVDs are pushed partially out of the DVD changer in sequence.

2. Remove the DVDs individually.

Malfunctions If all of the LEDs on the DVD changer flash rap- idly, then a malfunction is occurring. In this case, proceed as follows.

1. Press the button or button. The DVD last inserted is ejected.

2. Remove the DVD.

The DVD changer tests the DVD compartments and the rapid flashing of the LEDs stops. The DVD changer is once more operational.

DVD country codes Your DVD player only plays DVDs with the cod- ing of your home region, e.g. Europe = 2. The country codes supported by your DVD are con- tained in the information on your DVD. It is not possible to change this coding. An overview of the six coding zones:

DVDs with the code 0 can be played back on all units.<

Playing DVDs Depending on the equipment in your vehicle, you have the option of playing back both the audio track and video track of DVDs or only their audio track.

> Vehicles with two drives: audio and video playback

> Vehicles with a single drive: audio playback, refer to page 197

Audio and video playback For your own safety, the picture only appears on the Control Display at speeds of up to about 2 mph/3 km/h. For certain national-market ver- sions, the picture does not appear on the Con- trol Display unless the vehicle is stationary and the transmission is in Park.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller backwards to open "Entertainment".

3. Change to upper field if necessary. Select "DVD" and press the controller.

4. Change into the second field if necessary, select the desired DVD and press the con- troller.

It can take a little time for the DVD contents to be scanned in. Then the DVD is played and the DVD-specific menu is displayed.

DVD control Using the DVD control, you can select the title and chapter, open the DVD-specific menu and operate functions such as language, fast for-

Code Region

1 USA, Canada

2 Japan, Europe, Middle East, South Africa

3 Southeast Asia

4 Australia, Central and South America, New Zealand

5 Northwest Asia, North Africa

6 China

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

195

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

ward and reverse, or freeze frame. A DVD can briefly deactivate functions of the DVD control, under certain circumstances even while the entire DVD is being played. It is not possible to operate the DVD control under these circumstances. In this case, try to make the selection using the DVD-specific menu.

During playback:

1. Press the controller.

2. Select "DVD control bar" if needed and press the controller.

The DVD control is displayed.

The DVD control disappears again after a short time if you have not selected a function.

Fast forward/reverse

Forward/reverse with DVD control 1. Press the controller during playback to hide

the DVD control.

2. Select the symbol and press the controller.

3. Press the controller repeatedly to increase the speed of the fast forward/reverse. The DVD playback will be distorted.

To cancel fast forward/reverse:

Select the symbol and press the controller. The DVD will start play at the point selected.

Forward/reverse using controller 1. Turn the controller during playback.

Fast forward/reverse is interrupted.

2. Turn the controller further. The speed is increased.

3. Release the controller. Fast forward/reverse is interrupted. The current DVD will start play at the point selected.

Skipping chapter You can change to the next or previous chapter during playback.

1. Press the controller during playback to hide the DVD control.

2. Select the symbol and press repeatedly until you reach the desired chap- ter.

Or:

Press the button on the left or right repeatedly until you reach the desired chapter.

Making settings for DVD With some DVDs, it is only possible to select language, subtitles, camera angle,

or title by using the DVD-specific menu. Refer to the information on your DVD for possi- ble selections.<

Tone control In DVDs with multichannel or surround sound, for optimum playback, select an audio track with multichannel sound and set the tone set- tings to Surround, refer to Selecting language on page 196 and Professional HiFi System* on page 177.

Function

Exit DVD control

"SET" Settings for playing DVD

Starting playback

Stop playback

Activating freeze frame

Skipping chapter

Fast forward/reverse

"Menu" Open DVD-specific menu

D V

D c

h an

g er

196

Adjusting brightness and contrast 1. Press the controller during playback.

2. Select "SET" and press the controller.

3. Select "Video settings" and press the con- troller.

4. Select "Brightness" or "Contrast" and press the controller.

5. Turn the controller until the desired setting is selected.

Resetting to defaults:

Select "Reset" and press the controller.

DVD format 1. Press the controller during playback.

2. Select "SET" and press the controller.

3. Select "DVD format" and press the control- ler.

> "Standard"

> "Zoom": full-screen playback

Selecting language 1. Press the controller during playback.

2. Select "SET" and press the controller.

3. Select "Language" and press the controller.

4. Select language or audio track and press the controller.

The languages and audio tracks are generally accompanied by an indication of how may channels are included. 5.1 means multichannel.

Selecting subtitling 1. Press the controller during playback.

2. Select "SET" and press the controller.

3. Select "Subtitles" and press the controller.

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

197

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

4. Select the language of the subtitles and confirm by pressing the controller.

Selecting title 1. Press the controller during playback.

2. Select "SET" and press the controller.

3. Select "Title" and press the controller.

4. Select the desired title.

Selecting viewing angle Notes or symbols that appear during the play- back of a film generally indicate the availability of different camera angles. These are usually only briefly available.

1. Press the controller during playback.

2. Select "SET" and press the controller.

3. Select "Angle of view" and press the con- troller.

Opening DVD-specific menu Additional functions may be available on DVDs. For example, the viewer can select from several possible plots or display information on the film.

1. Press the controller during playback.

2. Select "Menu" and press the controller.

3. Make your selection in the DVD-specific menu. To do so, move the controller in the corresponding direction in order to select the menu items and then press the control- ler.

4. Select "Confirm selection" and press the controller.

You can also select language, subtitles, camera angle, or title in the DVD-specific

menu. Refer to the information on your DVD for possi- ble selections.<

Closing settings menu > Select "Return" and press the controller.

Audio playback In vehicles equipped with a single drive, you have the option of playing back the audio track of a DVD, even when no video playback is pos- sible in the vehicle.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller backwards to open "Entertainment".

3. Change to upper field if necessary. Select "DVD" and press the controller.

D V

D c

h an

g er

198

4. Change into the second field if necessary, select the desired DVD and press the con- troller.

Displaying DVD audio contents DVDs are usually divided into titles that are divided into chapters. The playback begins with the title that contains the most chapters. For example, this has the advantage that the intro- duction of a DVD is not played first.

All of the chapters, numbered all the way through, are show, i.e. the numbering is differ- ent than on the DVD. The numbering of the DVD is displayed in the status line.

Example:

Chapter 06 of the selection corresponds to chapter 6 in title 1 of the DVD.

The behavior during playback of the DVD can differ, depending on the DVD. It may

not be possible to play some DVDs or the play- back may stop before the end. In this case, the system usually skips to the next DVD in the DVD changer.<

Selecting chapter Select the chapter by turning the controller.

If playback does not automatically continue after the end of a title, then use the controller to select the next chapter.

A maximum of 99 chapters of a DVD can be played back.

Tone control In DVDs with multichannel or surround sound, for optimum playback, select an audio track with multichannel sound, refer to Selecting audio language, and set the tone settings to Surround, refer to Professional HiFi System* on page 177.

Selecting audio language If there are different languages on a DVD, you can select the language.

1. Select "Set" and press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

2. Select "Language / Audio format" and press the controller.

Display in the status line Display in the chapter selection

Title 1 Chapter 1 01

Chapter 2 02

Chapter 3 03

Chapter 4 04

Chapter 5 05

Chapter 6 06

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

199

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

The different languages of the DVD are dis- played.

3. Select the desired language and press the controller.

The languages and audio tracks are generally accompanied by an indication of how may channels are included. 5.1 means multichannel.

Notes The DVD changer can play back the following formats:

> DVD video

> Video CD

> CD-DA

> CD-DTS

> Compressed audio files

MACROVISION This product includes copyright-protected technology that is based on a series of regis- tered US patents and the intellectual property of the Macrovision Corporation and other man- ufacturers. Use of this copyrighted material must be approved by Macrovision. Unless oth- erwise agreed upon with Macrovision, it is only

permissible for correspondingly protected media to be produced for private use. The copying of this technology is strictly forbidden.

Dolby Manufactured under license from Dolby Labo- ratories. "Dolby", "Pro Logic", "MLP Lossless" and the double-D symbol are registered trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.

DTS "DTS" and "DTS Digital Surround" are regis- tered trademarks of DTS, Inc.

A U

X -I

n c

o n

n ec

ti o

n

200

AUX-In connection

You can connect an external audio device, e.g. an MP3 player, and play the sound via the vehi- cle speakers. The sound can be adjusted via iDrive.

Connecting Open the lid of the center armrest.

1 Connection for audio playback: TRS connector 1/8 in/3.5 mm

To play audio tracks through the vehicle's speaker system, connect the headphone or line-out port of the device with the AUX-In con- nection.

Starting audio playback The audio device must be switched on.

Via iDrive iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller backwards to open "Entertainment".

3. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "AUX" is selected and press the controller.

4. Select "AUX IN" and press the controller.

5. Adjust volume and sound if necessary.

With external devices, the sound output via the vehicle speakers can differ from

other audio sources. For a comparison of the volume, adapt the sound output of the external device.<

Via programmable memory buttons You can save the "AUX" function on the pro- grammable memory buttons. To start audio playback, refer to page 21.

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

201

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

USB audio interface

You can connect an external audio device or USB device to the USB audio interface.

> MP3 player

> USB memory stick

> iPod/iPhone

> Suitable mobile phone:

You can operate these devices via iDrive, if they are supported by the USB audio interface.

If equipped with an additional connection of the music player in the mobile phone, connect the phone by means of the snap-in adapter*, refer to page 233. The phone can then be used for the hands-free system and audio playback. The audio playback is only possible if no device is connected to the USB audio interface.

The common audio files, e.g. MP3, WMA, WAV (PCM) and AAC, as well as playback lists in the M3U format can be played back.

Due to the large number of audio devices avail- able on the market, operation via the vehicle cannot be ensured for every audio device. Ask your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center, which audio devices, mobile phones, or USB devices are suitable.

Connecting Open the lid of the center armrest.

1 Connection for audio playback: TRS connector 1/8 in/3.5 mm

2 USB interface

iPod/iPhone In order to connect the iPod/iPhone, use the BMW cable adaptor for Apple iPod/iPhone. For more information, contact a BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center or consult our website: www.bmw.com

For audio playback via the vehicle speakers, connect the iPod/iPhone to the connections 1 and 2. The menu structure of the iPod/iPhone is sup- ported by the USB audio interface.

USB device Use a flexible adapter cable for connec- tion to protect the USB interface and your

USB device against mechanical damage.<

For audio playback via the vehicle speakers, connect the USB device to the connection 2.

After connecting for the first time, the informa- tion of all tracks, e.g. artist, music genres, and the playback lists of the USB device are trans- ferred to the vehicle. This process can take some time. The time required is dependent on the USB device and on the number of tracks.

During the transfer you can select the tracks via the directories and file names.

Following the transfer you can call up the tracks via the information and playback lists.

The information of up to four USB devices or for a total of approx. 16,000 tracks can be stored in the vehicle.

If a fifth USB device is connected or if more than 16,000 tracks are to be stored, then the infor- mation about existing tracks is deleted if neces- sary.

Music tracks with integrated Digital Rights Management (DRM) cannot be

played.<

*

U S

B a

u d

io in

te rf

ac e

202

Starting audio playback

Via iDrive If the audio device has a device name, this will be displayed if possible.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller backwards to open "Entertainment".

3. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "AUX" is selected and press the controller.

4. Select "USB" or the name of the audio device and press the controller.

The playback starts with the first track.

With the connection of an iPhone by means of the snap-in adaptor and a simultaneous con- nection of an audio device at the Aux-In con- nection, the audio signal is played back.

With external devices, the sound output via the vehicle speakers can differ from

other audio sources. For a comparison of the volume, adapt the sound output of the external device.<

Via programmable memory buttons You can save the "USB" function on the pro- grammable memory buttons. To start audio playback, refer to page 21.

Selecting a track You can call up the tracks via the playback lists and information. With USB devices you can also call up the tracks via the file directory. The titles can be displayed if they are stored in the Latin alphabet.

1. Make your selection, e.g. "Playlists" or "Artists", and press the controller.

2. Select the track and press the controller.

Displaying information on track You can display any information stored on the current track, e.g. the name of the artist.

1. Press the controller during playback.

2. Select "Details" and press the controller.

The information for the current track are dis- played.

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

203

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

Repeating a track 1. Select the current track and press the con-

troller.

2. Select "Repeat track" and press the con- troller.

To stop repeating:

1. Press the controller.

2. Select "Repeat track" and press the con- troller.

Random play sequence You can play back the tracks of the selected list in random order, e.g. all tracks of an artist.

1. Select the current track and press the con- troller.

2. Select "Random" and press the controller.

To end random playback:

1. Press the controller.

2. Select "Random" and press the controller.

Fast forward/reverse Buttons on the steering wheel or on the CD player:

Press and hold the button for the corre- sponding direction.

Notes Do not subject the audio device to extreme environmental conditions, e.g.

extremely high temperatures, refer to the oper- ating manual of the audio device. Otherwise the audio device may be damaged, impairing driv- ing safety while driving.<

Depending on the configuration of the audio files, e.g. bit rates greater than 256 Kbit/s, proper playback cannot always be ensured.

Information on connection > The USB audio interface supplies the con-

nected audio device with power, provided the audio device supports this function. Therefore, do not connect the USB audio device to a socket in the vehicle during operation.

> Do not use force when plugging the con- nector into the USB interface.

> Do not connect any devices, e.g. fans or lamps, to the USB audio interface.

> Do not connect USB hard disks.

> Do not use the USB audio interface to recharge external devices.

D V

D s

ys te

m in

re ar

204

DVD system in rear

With the DVD system in the rear you can play CDs and DVDs with audio, video and image data. External audio and video devices can also be connected and played via the DVD system in the rear. Tone output is possible both via headphones and via the vehicle speakers.

You can operate the DVD system in the rear with the buttons on the CD/DVD player or with the remote control.

Some functions can only be operated with the remote control.<

Enabling DVD system Enable the DVD system with iDrive. For operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Unlock rear menu" and press the controller.

5. Select "Rear enabled" and press the con- troller.

The DVD system is enabled.

Controls

1 Display screen

2 Infrared interface for headphones

3 CD/DVD player

4 Headphone connection: Jack 1/8 in/3.5 mm

5 12 V sockets, refer to page 130

Folding in display screen When using the ski bag or when transporting bulky pieces of luggage, the display screen should be folded in, as otherwise it may be dam- aged.

Do not open the covers of the center arm- rest or rest your arm on the display screen

with the display screen folded in, as otherwise the display screen may be damaged.<

*

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

205

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

1. Turn display screen, arrow 1. The display screen switches off.

2. Fold in display screen, arrow 2.

The display screen is folded out in the reverse order.

CD/DVD player

Controls

1 Press: switching DVD system on/off Turn: volume for headphones on left

2 Eject CD, DVD

3 Start of track, reverse Stop Playback, pause, hold screen Next track, fast forward

4 CD/DVD bay

5 Connection for external device: Cinch sockets with protective cap

6 Press: switching DVD system on/off Turn: volume for headphones on right

Connecting headphones You can connect headphones with a jack plug 1/8 in/3.5 mm or operate them using the infra- red interface.

Ask your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center which infrared headphones are supported by the infrared interface.

When using infrared headphones, the infrared connection between the head-

phones and the infrared interface may not be interrupted. This means that no obstacle may be located between them and the cover of the infrared interface may not be covered or scratched. Unfavorable lighting conditions, such as glaring ambient light, can result in poor reception.<

Remote control

1 Menu navigation

2 Volume for headphones with jack plug

3 Change track or chapter with CD or DVD playback, fast forward/reverse

4 Switch over headphones right/left

5 Open start menu for DVD system

Menu navigation You can navigate through the menus with the serrated dial 1 and the buttons 1. For operating principle also refer to iDrive, page 16.

> Turn the serrated dial 1: Selecting a menu item.

> Press buttons 1: Changing between fields.

D V

D s

ys te

m in

re ar

206

> Press the button: Activating menu item.

Changing batteries

1. Press the detent and remove the cover.

2. Change the batteries. The type and installa- tion position are marked on the bottom of the battery compartment.

3. Close the cover.

Return used batteries to a recycling col- lection point or to your BMW Sports

Activity Vehicle Center.<

Sound output via speakers In addition to the headphones, you can also play the sound via the vehicle speakers.

As soon as a plug is inserted in the AUX-In con- nection in the center console, the sound output of the DVD system via the vehicle speakers is interrupted.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller backwards to open "Entertainment".

3. Select "AUX / Rear" and press the control- ler.

Switching DVD system on/off Press the button on the CD/DVD player.

The DVD system switches on automatically when a CD or DVD is inserted.

Playing CD/DVD The menu item with which the contents of the CD/DVD can be called up is dependent on the data on a CD or DVD:

> Video data via "DVD"

> Audio data via "CD"

> Images via "Photo"

Playing videos from CD/DVD

Country codes of DVDs Your DVD player only plays DVDs with the coding of your home region, e.g. Europe = 2. The country codes supported by your DVD are contained in the information on your DVD.

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

207

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

An overview of the coding zones:

Starting playback 1. Push the CD/DVD into the drive with the

labeled side facing upward. The CD/DVD is automatically pulled in.

> Playback usually begins automatically after a few seconds.

> If playback does not begin automatically: Select "DVD". Press the button.

2. If the DVD controller or the DVD-specific menu is displayed for a DVD, select the desired option for menu guidance with the remote control buttons.

Or:

Press the button on the CD/DVD player.

You can control the playback with the buttons on the CD/DVD player or the DVD control.

Video CDs, VCD, and Super Video CDs, SVCD, can be played like DVDs if they do

not have a DVD menu of their own.<

Ejecting CD/DVD Press the button on the CD/DVD player. The DVD emerges slightly from the drive.

DVD control With the DVD control, you can select the title and chapter, open the DVD-specific menu and operate functions such as Language, Fast for- ward and Reverse or Freeze frame. A DVD can briefly deactivate functions of the DVD control, under certain circumstances while

the entire DVD is being played. It is not possible to operate the DVD control under these circum- stances. In this case, try to make the selection using the DVD-specific menu.

1. Press the button on the remote con- trol during playback.

2. Press the buttons on the remote control or turn the serrated dial to select the desired function.

3. Press the button.

The DVD control disappears again after a short time if you have not selected a function.

Or:

Press the button on the remote control to exit the DVD control.

Fast forward/reverse

Forward/reverse with DVD control 1. Press the button on the remote con-

trol during playback.

2. Select the symbol.

Code Region

1 USA, Canada

2 Japan, Europe, Middle East, South Africa

3 Southeast Asia

4 Australia, Central and South America, New Zealand

5 Northwest Asia, North Africa

6 China

Function

Exit DVD control

"SET" Settings for playing DVD

Starting playback

Stop playback

Activate and deactivate freeze frame

Skipping chapter

Fast forward/reverse

"Menu" Open DVD-specific menu

D V

D s

ys te

m in

re ar

208

3. Press the button.

4. Press the button several times to increase the fast forward/reverse speed.

The DVD playback will be distorted.

To cancel fast forward/reverse:

1. Select the symbol.

2. Press the button.

Or:

Press the button on the CD/DVD player.

The DVD will start play at the point selected.

Forward/reverse with remote control Press and hold the button until you reach the desired point.

Or:

1. During playback, turn the serrated dial. Fast forward/reverse is interrupted.

2. Continue to turn the serrated dial. The speed is increased.

3. Press the button on the CD/DVD player. Fast forward/reverse is interrupted.

The DVD will start play at the point selected.

Skipping chapter You can change to the next or previous chapter during playback.

1. Press the button on the remote con- trol during playback.

2. Select the symbol.

3. Press the button repeatedly, continuing until you reach the desired chapter.

Or:

Press the button on the left or right on the remote control repeatedly until you reach the desired chapter.

Freeze frame 1. Press the button on the remote con-

trol during playback.

2. Select the symbol.

3. Press the button.

To continue playback:

1. Select the or symbol.

2. Press the button.

As an alternative you can also stop and con- tinue playback with the button on the CD/ DVD player.

Making settings for DVD 1. Press the button during playback.

2. Make the settings with the remote control:

> "Video settings":

> "Brightness", "Color" and "Contrast" of screen display

> Additional settings can be made after changing to the top field. "Language": system language of DVD system in rear. "Display": background brightness of screen.

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

209

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

> "Tone":

> "Treble / Bass" and "Balance": Separately adjustable for the left and right-hand headphones and the infrared headphones.

> "Reset": The settings are reset to the default value.

> "DVD format":

> "Standard"

> "Zoom": full-screen playback

> "Language": Language or sound track of DVD playback. The language advances one setting each time the menu item is selected.

> "Subtitles": Language of subtitles "00 n/a": no subtitles.

> "Title": Selection of a single track of the DVD.

> "Angle of view": Camera angle Notes or symbols that appear during the playback of a film generally point out differ- ent camera angles. These are usually only briefly available.

> "Menu": Call up the DVD-specific menu.

> "Return": Exit menu or: Press the buttons on the remote con- trol.

Many DVDs offer dialogs and subtitles in vari- ous languages or scene descriptions for the hearing impaired. These functions are stored on the DVD.

With some DVDs, it is only possible to select language, subtitles, camera angle,

or title by using the DVD-specific menu. Refer to the information on your DVD for possi- ble selections. Entries marked in gray in the menus cannot be selected.<

Opening DVD-specific menu Additional functions may be available on DVDs. For example, it is possible to select from several possible plots or display information on the film.

1. Press the button on the remote con- trol during playback.

2. Select "Menu".

3. Press the button.

On some DVDs, selecting "Menu" and "Title" gives you the option of

choosing from additional menus.<

To make a selection:

1. Use the buttons on the remote control to select the desired function in the DVD-spe- cific menu.

2. Press the button.

You can also select language, subtitles, camera angle, or title in the DVD-specific

menu. Observe the information on your DVD.<

Compressed video files

Playback 1. Select the directory if necessary.

2. Press the button.

D V

D s

ys te

m in

re ar

210

3. Select a track.

4. Press the button.

5. Select "Play".

6. Press the button.

To change the directory:

1. Select the directory.

2. Press the button.

Playback functions 1. Select a track.

2. Press the button.

3. Select a menu item:

> "Play": Start playback.

> "Pause": Stop and continue playback.

> "Repeat track": Repeat the selected track.

> "Repeat directory": Repeat the tracks in the current direc- tory.

4. Press the button.

Playing audio tracks from CD/DVD

Starting playback Push the CD/DVD into the drive with the labeled side facing upward. The CD/DVD is automatically pulled in.

> Playback begins automatically after a few seconds.

> If playback does not begin automatically: Select "CD". Press the button.

For CDs/DVDs with compressed audio files, refer to page 211, it may take several minutes to read the data depending on the directory struc- ture.

To start playback when there is already a CD/DVD in the drive:

1. Open the start menu with the remote con- trol.

2. Select "CD".

As an alternative you can also control the play- back with the buttons on the CD/DVD player.

To eject CD/DVD:

Press the button on the CD/DVD player.

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

211

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

Selecting a track

Buttons on CD/DVD player Press the button for the corresponding direction repeatedly until you reach the desired track. Playback begins at the start of the track.

Via the remote control Press the button for the corresponding direction repeatedly or turn the serrated dial until you reach the desired track. Playback begins at the start of the track.

Settings and playback functions for audio CDs/DVDs 1. Select "SET".

2. Press the button.

3. Make the settings with the remote control:

> "Tone":

> "Treble / Bass" and "Balance": Separately adjustable for the left and right-hand headphones and the infrared headphones.

> "Reset": The settings are reset to the default value.

> "Pause": Stop and continue playback.

> "Random": In this mode, the tracks on the CD/DVD are played once in a random sequence.

> "Scan": Automatically briefly sample all tracks of the CD/DVD consecutively.

> "Repeat": Repeat the current track. Select again to end.

Fast forward/reverse Buttons on the CD/DVD player:

Press and hold the button for the corre- sponding direction.

Remote control:

Press and hold the button until you reach the desired point.

Compressed audio files With some CDs/DVDs playback may automati- cally start with the first track.

Playback 1. Select the directory if necessary.

2. Press the button.

D V

D s

ys te

m in

re ar

212

3. Select a track.

4. Press the button.

To change the directory:

1. Select the directory.

2. Press the button.

Settings and playback functions for compressed audio files 1. Select a track.

2. Press the button.

3. Make the settings with the remote control:

> "Tone":

> "Treble / Bass" and "Balance": Separately adjustable for the left and right-hand headphones and the infrared headphones.

> "Reset": The settings are reset to the default value.

> "Pause": Stop or continue playback.

> "Scan directory": Briefly sample the tracks in the current directory.

> "Scan all": Briefly sample all tracks.

> "Random directory": Play the tracks in the current directory in a random sequence.

> "Random all": Play all tracks in a random sequence.

> "Repeat track": Repeat the selected track.

> "Repeat directory": Repeat the tracks in the current directory.

> "Details": Display any stored information on the cur- rent track.

Displaying images from CD/DVD 1. Push the CD/DVD into the drive with the

labeled side facing upward. The CD/DVD is automatically pulled in.

2. Open the start menu with the remote con- trol.

3. Select "Photo".

4. Press the button.

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

213

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

Displaying overview 1. Select the subdirectory if necessary.

2. Select "Overview".

3. Press the button. It may take some time until the overview is completely displayed.

4. Scroll through the overview with the menu guidance of the remote control.

If a symbol is shown instead of an image, the image cannot be shown in the over-

view.<

Displaying images 1. Select an image with the buttons of the

remote control.

2. Press the button.

3. Select type of display:

> Scroll with the menu guidance buttons of the remote control.

> Show slide show: Turn the serrated dial to set the display duration and the sequence of the dis- play. Stop slide show: Select "Stop".

Adjusting 1. Press the button.

2. Select a menu item:

3. Press the button.

Ending display 1. Press the button.

2. Select the symbol.

3. Press the button.

Ejecting CD/DVD Press the button on the CD/DVD player.

Function

Return to the photo menu

"SET" "Display": adjusting the bright- ness of the screen. "Language": the language of the system can be set after changing to the top field

Start slide show.

Show first/last image

Rotate image by 90

"Overview" Change to image overview

D V

D s

ys te

m in

re ar

214

Information on CD/DVD player

Safety notes The BMW CD/DVD player is a Class 1 laser product. Do not operate if the cover

is damaged or open, otherwise severe eye dam- age can result.<

Suitable media Do not use self-recorded CDs/DVDs with labels applied as these can become

detached during playback due to heat buildup and can cause irreparable damage to the device. Only use round CDs/DVDs with a standard diameter of 4.7 in/12 cm. Never play CDs/DVDs with adapters, e.g. sin- gle-CDs, as otherwise the CDs or the adapter can jam and may not be ejected. Never use combined CD/DVD, e.g. DVDPlus or hybrid disks, as otherwise the CD/DVD can jam and may not be ejected.<

The CD/DVD player can play the following media:

> Video DVD

> CD-DA (Audio CD)

> CDs/DVDs with compressed image files

> CDs/DVDs with compressed audio files

> CDs/DVDs with compressed video files

DVD Audio and SACD are not supported by the DVD player. However, many audio DVDs avail- able in stores also contain a video track in the DVD Video format in addition to the audio track. These DVDs can be played back by the DVD player. Refer to the information on your DVD to determine whether your audio DVD contains an additional video track.

Depending on the authoring used, it is possible that not all functions are available during play- back.

Dual-sided DVDs available from retail suppliers are coated on both sides and bear no markings. This means both sides are information carriers.

To play the information on the other side, turn over the DVD.

Supported formats Depending on the compression method used, not all files of the specified formats can be opened.

Images JPEG/JPG

With very large image files, it may take a longer time until the images are shown.

Compressed audio files > MP3

> WMA

> OGG

> AAC

Compressed video files > VCD

> SVCD

> MPEG1

> MPEG2

> MPEG4

Digital Rights Management DRM It may not be possible to play CDs/DVDs with integrated Digital Rights Management.

General malfunctions The BMW CD/DVD player is optimized for oper- ation in the vehicle. It may react more sensi- tively to defective CDs/DVDs than devices intended for stationary use.

If a CD/DVD cannot be played, first check whether it has been inserted correctly.

Make sure that no foreign bodies or liq- uids enter the CD-/DVD bay, as otherwise

the CD/DVD player will be damaged.<

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

215

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

Humidity High levels of humidity can lead to condensa- tion on the CD/DVD or the laser's scan lens and temporarily prevent playback.

Malfunctions with individual CDs/DVDs If malfunctions occur only with particular CDs/ DVDs, this can be due to one of the following causes.

Copied or self-recorded CDs/DVDs Possible reasons for malfunctions with copied or self-recorded CDs/DVDs are, e.g., inconsis- tent data-creation or recording processes, or poor quality or high age of the CD/DVD blank.

Only label CDs/DVDs on the side with the label using a pen intended for this purpose.

Damaged CDs/DVDs Avoid fingerprints, dust, scratches and mois- ture. Store CDs/DVDs in a sleeve. Do not subject CDs/DVDs to temperatures over 1227/506, high levels of humidity, or direct sunlight.

CDs/DVDs with copy protection CDs/DVDs are often provided with a copy pro- tection feature by the manufacturer. As a result, some CDs/DVDs cannot be played, can only be played to a limited degree, or cause the system to switch off. In this case, wait a short while and then switch the system back on again. Then remove the CD/DVD from the drive.

CDs/DVDs with compressed audio files If the language set for the CD/DVD player does not match the language of the music track, the music tracks may be displayed incorrectly.

Care instructions Do not use cleaning CDs with a brush.

External device

Connecting

1 Connections for audio/video cables: Watch the colors of the sockets when con- necting. Yellow socket: video White socket: audio left Red socket: audio right

2 Power supply for external device: sockets with removable cap, also refer to page 129

Playback 1. Switch on the external device and start the

playback.

2. Open the start menu with the remote con- trol.

3. Select "AUX".

4. Press the button.

For devices without a video signal, e.g. MP3 players, "No video signal" is shown. The sound is nevertheless played.

D V

D s

ys te

m in

re ar

216

Settings for external devices 1. Press the button during playback.

2. Make the settings with the remote control:

> "Video settings":

> "Brightness", "Color" and "Contrast" of video playback.

> "NTSC color": The color can be adjusted on an external device with the NTSC standard.

> "Standard": The DVD system in the rear can be adapted to external devices with various TV standards. When doing so, also refer to the operating manual of the external device.

> "Reset": The settings are reset to the default value.

> "Tone":

> "Treble / Bass" and "Balance" can be adjusted for the left and right-hand headphones and the infrared head- phones.

> "Reset": Your settings are reset.

> Additional settings can be made after changing to the top field. "Audio": adjust the volume of the exter- nal device to the volume of the CD/DVD player. "Language": system language of the DVD system in the rear. "Display": background brightness of screen.

> "Video Format":

> "Standard"

> "Zoom": full-screen playback

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

217

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

Communications This chapter summarizes how to operate your mobile phone using iDrive or voice control and

how to use BMW Assist or BMW TeleServices.

T el

ep h

o n

in g

220

Telephoning

The concept Your BMW is equipped with a full mobile phone preparation package. After pairing a suitable mobile phone in the vehicle once, you can oper- ate the mobile phone via iDrive, with the buttons on the steering wheel and by voice.

Once a mobile phone has been paired in your vehicle, it is automatically recognized as soon as it is inside the vehicle while the engine is run- ning or the ignition is switched on. The pairing data of up to four mobile phones can be stored simultaneously. If several mobile phones are detected simultaneously, the respective last mobile phone paired can be operated via the vehicle.

Using a phone in your vehicle

Using snap-in adapter* The so-called snap-in adapter, a mobile phone cradle, enables the battery to be charged and the mobile phone to be connected to the exter- nal antenna of your vehicle. This ensures improved network reception and a consistent voice reproduction quality. Ask your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center which mobile phones snap-in adapters are offered for.

For your safety A car phone makes life more convenient in many ways, and can even save lives in an emer- gency. While you should consult your mobile phone's separate operating instructions for a detailed description of safety precautions and information, we request that you direct your particular attention to the following:

Only make entries when the traffic situa- tion allows you to do so. Do not hold the

mobile phone in your hand while you are driving; use the hands-free system instead. If you do not observe this precaution, your being dis-

tracted can endanger vehicle occupants and other road users.<

Suitable mobile phones Ask your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center which mobile phones with Bluetooth interface are supported by the mobile phone preparation package and which mobile phones are compat- ible with the snap-in adapter. By virtue of their particular software versions, these mobile phones support the functions described in this Owner's Manual. Malfunctions can occur with other mobile phones.

Care instructions You can find everything you need to know on this topic by consulting the separate operating instructions for the mobile phone.

Operating options You can operate the mobile phone* using:

> Buttons on steering wheel, refer to page 11

> iDrive, refer to page 226

> Voice commands, refer to page 231

> Programmable memory buttons, refer to page 21

Avoid operating a mobile phone detected by the vehicle with the keypad of the mobile phone, otherwise malfunctions can occur.

Placing phone calls with BMW Assist system*: BMW Assist calls You can use the BMW Assist system via the hands-free unit for BMW Assist calls.

When the status information "Communication" or "BMW Assist" is displayed in "BMW Ser- vice", only BMW Assist calls are possible.

*

221

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

It may not be possible to establish a telephone connection using the mobile phone while a con- nection is being established to BMW Assist or while a call to BMW Assist is already in progress. If this happens, you must log off the mobile phone from the vehicle if you wish to place a call with the mobile phone.

Commissioning

Pairing mobile phone in vehicle The following prerequisites must be met:

> Suitable mobile phone: the mobile phone is supported by the full mobile phone prepara- tion package. Information on this subject is also provided on the Internet at: www.bmw.com

> The mobile phone is ready to operate.

> The Bluetooth link on the vehicle, refer to page 225, and on the mobile phone is active.

> Depending on the mobile phone, it may be necessary to adjust the presets of the mobile phone, e.g. via the following menu items:

> Bluetooth activated

> Connection not with confirmation

> Reconnect

> Depending on the mobile phone model, the setting energy saving mode can, for exam- ple, result in vehicle failing to detect the paired mobile phone.

> For pairing, specify any desired number as the Bluetooth passkey, e.g. 1. This Blue- tooth passkey is no longer required follow- ing successful pairing.

> The ignition is switched on.

Only pair the mobile phone with the vehi- cle stationary, otherwise the passengers

and other road users can be endangered due to a lack of attentiveness on the part of the driver.<

Switching on ignition 1. Insert the remote control as far as possible

into the ignition lock.

2. Switch on the ignition by pressing the Start/ Stop button without depressing the brake pedal.

Preparation via iDrive iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

3. Press the button to open the start menu.

4. Press the controller to open the menu.

5. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

6. Select "Bluetooth" and press the controller.

T el

ep h

o n

in g

222

7. Change into the second field from the top, select "Phone" and press the controller.

8. Select "Pair new phone" and press the con- troller.

9. Select "Start pairing" and press the control- ler.

The Bluetooth name of the vehicle is dis- played.

Preparation with mobile phone 10. Additional operations must be carried out

on the mobile phone and differ depending on the model, refer to the operating instruc- tions of your mobile phone, e.g. find, con- nect or pair under Bluetooth device. The Bluetooth name of the vehicle is also shown on the mobile phone display.

11. Select the Bluetooth name of the vehicle on the mobile phone display.

Pairing Depending on your mobile phone, you will first be requested consecutively via the display of your mobile phone or iDrive to enter the Blue- tooth passkey you specified.

12. Enter the Bluetooth passkey. Depending on the mobile phone, approx. 30 seconds are available for entering the Bluetooth passkey on the mobile phone and on the Control Display.

13. Change into the third field from the top, select "Confirm passkey" and press the controller.

14. Wait a few seconds until the "Communica- tion" menu appears.

The next time you use the mobile phone in the vehicle interior, it will be detected within a max- imum of 2 minutes with the engine running or the ignition switched on.

With some mobile phone models it may be necessary to make certain settings for

a permanent Bluetooth link, e.g. via the menu item Authorization or Secure connection, refer to the operating instructions of your mobile phone.<

223

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

As soon as a mobile phone is detected by the vehicle, the phone book entries stored on the SIM card or on your mobile phone are transmit- ted to your vehicle. This transmission is depen- dent on your mobile phone, refer to the operat- ing instructions of your mobile phone if necessary, and can take several minutes.

If not all phone book entries are displayed:

> Transfer all phone book entries from the SIM card to the mobile phone if necessary.

> It may not be possible to display phone book entries with special characters.

Up to four mobile phones can be paired consec- utively. When you pair a fifth mobile phone, the pairing data of the mobile phone for which the pairing data were stored first in the vehicle will be deleted.

Checking if pairing is unsuccessful > Is the mobile phone supported by the

mobile phone preparation package? Infor- mation on this subject is also provided on the Internet at: www.bmw.com.

> Do the Bluetooth passkeys on the mobile phone and the vehicle match? The same Bluetooth passkey must be entered both on the mobile phone display and via iDrive.

> Have you required longer than 30 seconds to enter the Bluetooth passkey?

> Only a limited number of devices can be connected to the mobile phone. Delete the connection to other devices if necessary.

> The mobile phone no longer reacts? Switch the mobile phone off and then on again or disconnect the power supply.

To repeat pairing:

1. Select "Restart pairing" and press the con- troller.

2. Repeat steps 9 to 14.

If pairing was repeatedly unsuccessful, contact BMW Customer Relations.

To call BMW Customer Relations: Select "Help" and press the controller.

The phone number of BMW Customer Rela- tions and information required for pairing is shown on the display. With mobile phones already paired, you can select the phone num- ber of BMW Customer Relations to establish the connection.

T el

ep h

o n

in g

224

List of paired mobile phones The mobile phones for which the vehicle has stored the pairing data can be displayed. If sev- eral paired mobile phones are detected by the vehicle simultaneously, you can operate the mobile phone highest up in the list via the vehi- cle.

You can change the order of the mobile phones in the list. As long as a mobile phone is selected in this list, the mobile phones cannot be oper- ated via the vehicle.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button to open the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Bluetooth" and press the controller.

5. Change into the second field from the top, select "Phone" and press the controller.

6. Select the desired mobile phone.

With two drives:

> Move the controller to the rear to change to the bottom field.

> Select the desired mobile phone and press the controller.

With a single drive:

> Select the desired mobile phone and press the controller.

7. Select "Move device up" and press the con- troller.

The selected mobile phone is moved upward by one position.

Unpairing mobile phone from vehicle If you no longer want to operate a mobile phone via the vehicle, you can delete the pairing data of the mobile phone.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Switch off the mobile phone.

2. Press the button to open the start menu.

3. Press the controller to open the menu.

4. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

5. Select "Bluetooth" and press the controller. "Bluetooth" is selected.

6. Change into the second field from the top, select "Phone" and press the controller.

7. Select the desired mobile phone.

With two drives:

> Move the controller to the rear to change to the bottom field.

> Select the desired mobile phone and press the controller.

225

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

With a single drive:

> Select the desired mobile phone and press the controller.

8. Select "Delete device" and press the con- troller.

The unpaired mobile phone is deleted from the list. The phone book entries and the lists of stored phone numbers are also deleted.

Activating/deactivating Bluetooth link Bluetooth technology is not approved in all countries. Observe the applicable local

regulations. Temporarily deactivate the Blue- tooth link between the vehicle and the mobile phone if necessary. If the Bluetooth link is deactivated, you cannot operate your mobile phone via the vehicle and other devices with a Bluetooth interface can be used via the mobile phone, e.g. a laptop com- puter.<

To temporarily deactivate the Bluetooth link between your vehicle and your mobile phone:

1. Press the button to open the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Bluetooth" and press the controller.

5. Change into the second field from the top, select "Settings" and press the controller.

6. Select "Bluetooth communication active" and press the controller to activate or deac- tivate the link.

The Bluetooth link is activated.

The Bluetooth link is deactivated.

T el

ep h

o n

in g

226

Adjusting volume

Turn the knob during a call to select the desired volume.

This volume for the hands-free system is main- tained, even if the other audio sources are set to minimum volume.

You can also adjust the volume with buttons on the steering wheel, refer to page 10.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Operation via iDrive You can operate the following functions via iDrive:

> Accepting/refusing a call

> Dialing phone numbers

> Dialing phone numbers from the phone book

> Dialing stored phone numbers, e.g. from the list of accepted calls

> Ending a call

When the ignition and radio readiness are switched off, e.g. after removing the remote control from the ignition lock, you can continue an ongoing call via the hands-free system for no more than 25 minutes.

Speech quality If the person you are talking to cannot under- stand you well, this may be due to excessively loud background noises. The full mobile phone preparation package can compensate for these noises to a certain degree.

To optimize the speech quality during a call, we recommend that you:

> Reduce background noises, e.g. by closing the windows, reducing the air volume of the automatic climate control or pointing the opened front air vents downward

> Reduce volume of hands-free system

Requirements > The pairing data of the mobile phone are

stored in the vehicle and the mobile phone is ready to operate.

> The engine is running or the ignition is switched on.

> The mobile phone is detected by the vehi- cle.

Opening Communication You operate many of the functions described in the following via the "Communication" menu.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button to open the start menu.

2. Move the controller forward to open "Com- munication".

Receiving calls If you have the phone number of the caller stored in the phone book and the phone num- ber has been transmitted, the name of the entry is displayed.

227

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

Accepting a call Press the button on the steering wheel.

Alternative:

"Accept" is selected. Press the controller.

Rejecting a call Select "Reject" and press the controller. The caller is diverted to your mailbox if it has been activated.

Calling

Dialing phone numbers 1. Select "Phone" and press the controller.

2. Select "Dial" and press the controller.

3. Enter the desired phone number by dialing the individual digits and pressing the con- troller. Always enter the complete phone number consisting of national dialing code, area code, and phone number. The letters correspond to the digits on the keypad of the mobile phone.

To delete the last digit: Move the controller toward the right to select the arrow and press the con- troller.

4. Select "Dial number" and press the control- ler. Alternative: press the button on the steering wheel.

For your phone number to be displayed to the person you are calling, the display of phone numbers must be enabled by your service pro- vider.

Via programmable memory buttons You can store phone numbers on the program- mable memory buttons to call them directly, refer to page 21.

Ending a call Press the button on the steering wheel.

Alternative:

1. Select the phone number and press the controller.

T el

ep h

o n

in g

228

2. "End call" is selected. Press the controller.

Dialing a phone number from phone book or a phone number stored in a list Phone numbers you have called, incoming calls and the entries of the phone book are stored in lists when the mobile phone is connected to the vehicle via Bluetooth. If the caller is entered in the phone book, the name of the entry is dis- played instead of the phone number.

You can select the desired subscriber from the list and establish the connection.

Five lists are available:

> "A - Z" The entries of the mobile-phone phone book, consisting of the name and phone number, are sorted alphabetically.

> "Top 8" The eight numbers called most frequently from the phone book "A - Z" are automati- cally stored in the Top 8 list.

> "Redial" The last eight phone numbers you have dialed are automatically stored. The last number dialed is at the top of the list.

> "Missed calls" The phone numbers of the last eight calls which were not accepted are stored. This requires the telephone number of the caller to have been sent.

> "Received calls" The phone numbers of the last eight accepted calls are stored. This requires the telephone number of the caller to have been sent.

Dialing phone numbers from phone book The list "A - Z" is available for your phone book entries. The phone book entries appear on the Control Display.

1. Select "Phone" and press the controller.

2. Select "A - Z" and press the controller.

3. To limit the number of displayed entries, select the first letter of the desired entry and press the controller.

4. Select the desired entry and press the con- troller.

5. Select "Call" and press the controller. The system dials the number.

If different phone numbers are stored in the mobile phone under one name, e.g. office and home, the name is shown once for each phone number.

You can change a phone number stored in the phone book, e.g. to call a specific extension:

1. Select "Phone" and press the controller.

2. Select "A - Z" and press the controller.

3. Select the desired entry and press the con- troller.

4. Select "Add digits" and press the controller.

229

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

5. Change the phone number.

6. Select "Dial number" and press the control- ler.

Dialing a phone number stored in a list To select an entry and establish a connection:

1. Select "Phone" and press the controller.

2. Select list and press the controller:

> "Top 8"

> "Redial"

> "Missed calls"

> "Received calls"

3. Select the desired entry and press the con- troller.

4. Select "Call" and press the controller. The system dials the number.

Deleting individual entries 1. Select the desired entry from the list and

press the controller.

2. Select "Delete" and press the controller. The entry is deleted.

Deleting entire list 1. Select an entry from the list and press the

controller.

2. Select "Delete all numbers" and press the controller.

3. Select "Yes" and press the controller. The list is deleted.

BMW Contact* If you are not enabled for BMW Assist, you can have several service phone numbers displayed:

> Roadside Assistance* of the BMW Group when you require breakdown assistance

> BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center, e.g. when you want to make an appointment for service

> BMW Customer Relations* for information on all aspects of your vehicle

If BMW Assist is enabled, refer to page 235.

T el

ep h

o n

in g

230

You can select the displayed service phone number if your mobile phone is paired in the vehicle:

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller forward to select "Communication".

3. Select "BMW Contact" and press the con- troller.

4. Select "BMW Contact Numbers" and press the controller.

5. Select one of the following menu items and press the controller:

> "Roadside Assistance"

> "Customer Relations"

> "Service Request"

6. Select "Call" and press the controller.

Contact is established.

Transferring phone number via tone dialing method The tone dialing method is required for access to network services or for controlling devices, e.g. remote checking of an answering machine.

This function is available when a connection has been established.

1. Establish connection.

2. With a single drive: Press the controller. Select "Keypad" and press the controller. With two drives: Move the controller backwards until the bottom field is selected.

3. Select the desired characterand press the controller. Each character is sent immediately and confirmed by a tone depending on the mobile phone model.

Changing between mobile phone and hands-free system

From mobile phone to hands-free system* You can continue calls begun outside the Blue- tooth range of the vehicle via the handsfree sys- tem when the engine is running or the ignition is switched on. Depending on your mobile phone, the system automatically switches over to the handsfree mode.

231

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

For mobile phones that do not automatically switch over to the handsfree mode:

> Depending on the mobile phone model used, the conversation can be continued via the hands-free system if necessary. Act according to what is shown on the mobile phone display, refer to the operating instructions of your mobile phone.

> Press the button above the storage compartment.

From handsfree system to mobile phone When you telephone via the handsfree system, you can also continue the call via the mobile phone if necessary, depending on the mobile phone model. Act according to what is shown on the mobile phone display, refer to the oper- ating instructions of your mobile phone.

As an alternative, you can deactivate the Blue- tooth link.

Depending on your mobile phone model, poor reception of the wireless communications net- work can result in the system changing from the hands-free system to the mobile phone.

Operation by voice*

The concept You can operate your mobile phone without having to remove your hands from the steering wheel. When making your entries, you will be supported by announcements or questions in many cases.

The same prerequisites as for operation via iDrive apply, refer to page 226.

Symbols in Owner's Manual

Voice commands

Activating system 1. Briefly press the button on the steering

wheel.

An acoustic signal indicates that you can say commands.

2. Say the command.

Ending/canceling operation by voice Press the button on the steering wheel or

In dialogs where text is spoken, e.g. a name rather than a command, canceling is only possi- ble using the button on the steering wheel.

Having possible commands read aloud The system understands default commands that must be spoken word for word. You can have the possible commands spoken by the system at any point:

Using alternative commands There are often a number of commands to run a function, e.g.:

The system recognizes digits from zero to nine.

You can say each digit individually or group them into a sequence to accelerate the input.

{...} Say the specified commands word for word. {{...}} Indicates responses of the system.

{Cancel}.

{Help}

{Dial name} or {Name}.

T el

ep h

o n

in g

232

Example: dialing phone numbers To start the dialog:

Press the button on the steering wheel.

Adjusting volume of instructions You can adjust the volume for the instructions from the system:

Turn the knob during instructions.

This volume for the instructions is maintained, even if the other audio sources are set to mini- mum volume.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Calling

Dialing phone numbers

The connection to the desired subscriber is established.

Correcting phone number After the last spoken sequence of digits has been repeated by the system, you can delete this sequence of digits.

The command {Correct number} can be repeated as often as you like.

Deleting phone number

All digits entered up to this point are deleted.

Voice phone book Operating by voice command requires a per- sonal voice phone book.

> With separate drives for audio CDs and nav- igation DVDs, the entries are automatically applied from your mobile phone's memory.

> With a single drive, the entries must be entered by voice and are independent of your mobile phone's memory. In this case, it is not possible to use voice command either to call phone numbers stored in the mobile phone or to store new numbers. Up to 50 entries can be input. An entry always con- sists of a name and phone number.

Command The voice control answers

{Dial number} {{Please say the number}}

e.g. {123 456 7890} Depending on equipment: {{123 456 7890. Continue?}} or {{123 456 7890. And next?}}

{Dial} {{Dialing number}}

1. {Dial number}.

2. Say the phone number. For telephone calls abroad, say {Plus} and then the country code.

3. {Dial}.

{Correct number}. The digits are deleted.

{Delete}.

233

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

Creating and editing voice phone book* Store entry:

An entry always consists of a name and phone number.

Delete entry:

You can delete any entry from the voice phone book.

Delete all entries:

{Delete phone book} deletes all entries in the phone book.

Have entries read aloud and select:

You can have all the entries of your voice phone book read aloud in the order of input and select a certain entry to establish a connection:

Selecting an entry The connection to the phone number of the selected entry is established.

Redialing The {Redial} command opens "Redial".

Notes

Important for voice commands For voice commands, keep the following in mind:

> Issue the commands smoothly and at nor- mal volume, avoiding excessive emphases and pauses.

> Keep the doors, windows and glass sunroof closed to prevent interference from ambi- ent noise.

> Avoid making other noise in the vehicle while speaking.

Inserting/removing snap-in adapter* 1. Press the area 1 around the button and

remove the cover*.

1. {Save name}. The dialog for storing a name is opened.

2. Speak the name. The spoken length of the names in the phone book must not exceed approx. 2 seconds.

3. Say the phone number when prompted.

4. To store the phone number: {Save}.

1. {Delete name}. The dialog for deleting an entry is opened.

2. Say the name when prompted.

3. Confirm the prompt with {Yes}.

1. {Delete phone book}. The dialog for deleting phone book is opened.

2. Confirm the prompt with {Yes}.

3. Confirm the repeated prompt with {Yes}.

1. {Read phone book}. The dialog for reading phone book is opened.

2. {Dial number} when the desired entry is read aloud.

1. {Dial name}. The dialog for selecting an entry is opened.

2. Say the name when prompted.

3. Confirm the prompt with {Yes}.

T el

ep h

o n

in g

234

2. Insert the snap-in adapter in the front and press it downward until it engages.

To remove the snap-in adapter: Press down on region 1.

Inserting mobile phone 1. Remove the protective cap from the mobile

phone's antenna connector if necessary, so that the mobile phone can engage in the snap-in adapter.

2. Push the mobile phone with the buttons facing upward toward the electrical connec- tions and press down until it engages.

The mobile phone battery is charged from the radio readiness position.

To protect the vehicle's batteries, avoid using the phone when the ignition is

switched off.<

Removing mobile phone

Press the button.

235

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

BMW Assist

BMW Assist provides you with various services. For example, the position data of your vehicle can be transferred to the BMW Assist Response Center if an emergency request* has been initiated.

Many BMW Assist services depend on the indi- vidually agreed contract.

After your contract has expired, the BMW Assist system will be deactivated by the BMW Assist Response Center without you having to visit a BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center. After the BMW Assist system has been deacti- vated, no BMW Assist service will be available. The BMW Assist system can be reactivated by a BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center after signing a new contract.

Requirements If the following requirements are met, you can use BMW Assist:

> The installed BMW Assist system is logged in on a wireless communications network. This network must be capable of transmit- ting the services.

> To transmit position data, the vehicle must be able to determine the current position.

> To activate and update BMW Assist, a GPS signal must be available.

> You have subscribed to BMW Assist with your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center or with the BMW Assist Response Center. Enabling must have been completed.

> BMW Assist is activated, refer to page 240.

Offered services The following services are available via BMW Assist:

> Emergency request, refer to page 279: When you press the SOS button, a connec- tion is established to the BMW Assist Response Center. The BMW Assist Response Center contacts you and takes further steps to help you.

> Automatic collision notification: Under certain conditions, a connection is established to the BMW Assist Response Center after a serious accident. If possible, the BMW Assist Response Center contacts you and takes further steps to help you.

> Enhanced roadside assistance: You can call BMW Roadside Assistance* should you require help in the event of a breakdown. If possible, the vehicle and position data are transmitted in the process.

> BMW Customer Relations: For information on all aspects of your vehi- cle, you can be connected to BMW Cus- tomer Relations.

> BMW TeleServices*: The data on the service status of your vehi- cle or on required inspections are transmit- ted to your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center either automatically prior to the due date or when you request a BMW service appointment.

> Unlocking and locking the vehicle: Inform the BMW Assist Response Center, e.g. if your remote control is not available and you want to have the vehicle opened or closed.

> Stolen vehicle recovery: After your vehicle has been reported to the police as stolen, the BMW Assist Response Center can locate its position.

In addition, you can be provided with other ser- vices, e.g. the concierge service or information

*

B M

W A

ss is

t

236

on route planning, traffic conditions, and the weather. With Critical Calling, you can make a limited number of calls via the BMW Assist Response Center, e.g. if you do not have your mobile phone with you. Press the SOS button to contact the BMW Assist Response Center, see below.

You also have access to the BMW Assist con- cierge service via the Internet.

Characteristics of offered services The following special aspects apply to the ser- vices:

> The services offered are country-specific.

> Voice contact is established or data are transferred, depending on the equipment and the country. In some countries, it is possible to do both.

> The data transferred can, for example, be the vehicle data, your current position or the data of the CBS Condition Based Service.

Using services

Contact to the BMW Assist Response Center You can contact the BMW Assist Response Center via the SOS button.

1. Briefly press protective cover to open. Depending on the vehicle's equipment, the arrangement of the switches and indicator lamps may differ somewhat.

2. Press the button for at least 2 seconds.

The BMW Assist Response Center is con- tacted.

Roadside assistance iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller forward to select "Communication".

3. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "BMW Assist" is selected and press the controller.

4. Select "Roadside Assistance" and press the controller.

If the current position can be determined, the current vehicle location is displayed.

5. Select "Start service" and press the con- troller.

The BMW Assist Response Center will connect you to the BMW Roadside Assistance.

237

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

BMW TeleServices*

Automatic BMW Teleservice call* The data on the service status of your vehicle or on required inspections are transmitted auto- matically directly to your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center prior to the due date. You can check when the BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center was notified.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Info sources" and press the control- ler.

4. Select "Service Info" and press the control- ler.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Service requirements" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Auto Request" and press the con- troller.

Manual BMW Teleservice call You can transmit data regarding your vehicle's service status to your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center when you wish to arrange a ser- vice appointment.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller forward to select "Communication".

3. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "BMW Assist" is selected and press the controller.

4. Select "Service Request" and press the controller.

B M

W A

ss is

t

238

5. Select "Start service" and press the con- troller.

The data relevant for service are transmitted. Your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center will contact you to set up an appointment for ser- vice.

Displaying and updating BMW TeleServices services* 1. Press the button.

This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "BMW Service settings" and press the controller.

5. Select "Enabled TeleServices" and press the controller.

The activated BMW TeleServices services are displayed.

6. "Options" is selected: press the controller.

7. Select "Update services" and press the controller.

Contacting BMW Customer Relations For information on all aspects of your vehicle, you can contact BMW Customer Relations.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller forward to select "Communication".

3. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "BMW Assist" is selected and press the controller.

4. Select "Customer Relations".

5. Press the controller.

6. Select "Start service" and press the con- troller.

You are connected to BMW Customer Rela- tions by the BMW Assist Response Center.

239

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

Concierge service* When you call the BMW Assist concierge ser- vice, you can, for example, obtain information on current events, filling stations or hotels and have their phone numbers and addresses transmitted. Many hotels can be booked directly through the BMW concierge service.

The concierge service must be enabled sepa- rately by the BMW Assist Response Center.

Calling up information 1. Press the button.

This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller forward to select "Communication".

3. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "BMW Assist" is selected and press the controller.

4. Select "Concierge" and press the control- ler.

5. Select "Start service" and press the con- troller.

The BMW Assist Response Center will connect you with a BMW Assist concierge.

Displaying transferred data Select the received message if necessary and press the controller.

Dialing a phone number or transferring an address for destination guidance 1. Select "Options" and press the controller.

2. Select a menu item:

> With "Call" you can establish a telephone connection. A prerequisite for this is that your Bluetooth mobile phone has been paired in the vehicle.

> Press "Select as destination" to transfer the address to the navigation system for desti- nation guidance.

Customizing BMW Assist

Displaying and updating services You will be notified of any changes in the ser- vices offered by BMW Assist. In this case you should update the service functions.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

B M

W A

ss is

t

240

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

4. Turn the controller until "BMW Service set- tings" is selected and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Enabled Assist services" is selected and press the controller. The currently available BMW Assist ser- vices are displayed.

6. Select "Options" and press the controller.

7. Select "Update services" and press the controller.

Activating BMW Assist BMW Assist must be activated to use the ser- vices.

Requirements > Make sure that the vehicle can determine its

current position. Reception is best when you have an unobstructed view to the sky.

> Leave vehicle ignition switched on during the activation process.

Activating 1. Press the button.

This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

4. Turn the controller until "BMW Service set- tings" is selected and press the controller.

241

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Enabled Assist services" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Enable services" and press the con- troller. BMW Assist is enabled and the data exchange with the BMW Assist Response Center begins.

Activation takes a few minutes. The status is displayed on the Control Display. If you open another menu, the activation process continues to run in the background.

Displaying vehicle data With BMW Assist activated, you can have the Telematics ID displayed. The Telematics ID is used to identify your vehicle. These data are transmitted to the service.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

4. Select "BMW Service settings" and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Assist profile" is selected and press the controller.

Mobility This section helps you maintain your

mobility by supplying important information on vital topics including fuels and lubricants,

wheels and tires, service, maintenance and roadside assistance.

R ef

u el

in g

244

Refueling

Switch off the engine before refueling. When handling fuel, always observe all

applicable precautionary measures and regula- tions. Never transport reserve fuel containers in the vehicle. These could become leaky and cause an explosion or a fire in an accident.<

Fuel filler door

Opening

1. Open the fuel filler door. To do this, briefly press the lower edge.

2. Turn the fuel filler cap counterclockwise.

3. Place the fuel filler cap in the bracket attached to the fuel filler door.

Closing Fit the cap and turn it clockwise until you clearly hear a click.

Do not crush the band attached to the cap; otherwise, the cap may not properly

seal and fuel vapors can escape.<

A message* is displayed if the cap is loose or missing.

Releasing manually If an electrical malfunction should occur, you can unlock the fuel filler door manually.

1. Open the right-hand side panel in the cargo bay.

2. Pull the knob with the gas pump symbol.

Observe the following when refueling When handling fuels, follow the safety precautions posted at the filling station.

Otherwise, there is a danger of personal injury or property damage.<

When refueling, insert the filler nozzle com- pletely into the filler pipe. Avoid raising the filler nozzle during refueling, otherwise this leads to

> premature pump shutoff

> a reduced efficiency of the fuel-vapor recovery system

The fuel tank is full when the filler nozzle clicks off the first time.

Fuel tank capacity Approx. 22.5 US gal/85 liters, including the reserve capacity of approx. 2.1 US gal/8 liters X5 xDrive48i: approx. 2.6 US gal/10 liters reserve X6 xDrive50i: approx. 3.2 US gal/12 liters reserve

Refuel as soon as possible once your cruising range falls below 30 miles/

50 km, otherwise engine functions are not ensured and damage can occur.<

M o

b il

it y

245

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Fuel specifications

Gasoline engine: required fuel Do not use leaded gasoline, otherwise damage to the catalytic converter will

result. Do not use E85, i.e. fuel that consists of 85% ethanol, or Flex Fuel, otherwise permanent damage to the engine and the fuel supply sys- tem will result.<

Super Premium Gasoline/AKI 91 This gasoline is highly recommended.

However, you may also use gasoline with less AKI. The minimum AKI Rating is 87.

If you use gasoline with this minimum AKI Rat- ing, the engine may produce knocking sounds when starting at high outside temperatures. This has no affect on the engine life.

Do not use gasoline below the specified minimum quality, otherwise engine dam-

age can result.<

Use high-quality brands Field experience has indicated significant dif- ferences in fuel quality: volatility, composition, additives, etc., among gasolines offered for sale in the United States and Canada. Fuels contain- ing up to and including 10% ethanol or other oxygenates with up to 2.8% oxygen by weight, that is, 15% MTBE or 3% methanol plus an equivalent amount of co-solvent, will not void the applicable warranties with respect to defects in materials or workmanship.

The use of poor-quality fuels may result in drivability, starting and stalling problems

especially under certain environmental condi- tions such as high ambient temperature and high altitude. Should you encounter drivability problems which you suspect could be related to the fuel you are using, we recommend that you respond by switching to a recognized high-quality brand such as gasoline that is advertised as Top Tier Detergent Gasoline. Failure to comply with these recommendations may also result in unscheduled maintenance.<

BMW X5 with BMW Advanced Diesel: Required fuel

Ultra-low sulfur diesel The engine of your BMW is designed for diesel with a low sulfur content: Ultra-low sulfur diesel ASTM D 975-07a.

Refuel only with ultra-low sulfur diesel. The percentage of biodiesel in the fuel

must not exceed 5, referred to as B5. Do not refuel with gasoline. If the vehicle has been refueled with incorrect fuel such as gasoline, do not start the engine; otherwise, there is a dan- ger of engine damage.<

After incorrect refueling, contact a BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center.

The fuel filling neck is designed for refuel- ing with diesel nozzles.

If the nozzle cannot be inserted into the fuel filler pipe of your BMW, please check to make sure that you are refueling with a diesel fuel pump and whether this is equipped with a diesel nozzle.<

Winter diesel In order to assure the operational reliability of the diesel engine, during cold seasons, please refuel with winter diesel, which is sold at fuel stations during this time of year. The standard fuel filter heating prevents the supply of fuel from stalling during driving.

Do not mix in any additives or gasoline; otherwise, there is the risk of engine dam-

age.<

BMW X5 with BMW Advanced Diesel

The concept BMW Advanced Diesel reduces nitrogen oxides in the diesel exhaust of your vehicle by injecting the reducing agent diesel exhaust fluid into the exhaust line. In the catalytic converter, a chem- ical reaction occurs that minimizes nitrogen oxides.

R ef

u el

in g

246

In order to be able to start the engine in the usual way, there must be a sufficient supply of diesel exhaust fluid in the separate reservoir.

System heating In order to bring the system to operating tem- perature after a cold start of the engine, the automatic transmission shifts into the next higher gear at a later point.

Reserve display A display in the instrument panel informs you about the remaining distance can be covered with the amount of fuel currently in the tank.

The reserve display appears approx. 1,000 miles/1,600 km before the end of the tank.

As soon as the reserve display has appeared in the instrument panel, have

the diesel exhaust fluid refilled to prevent the engine from being unable to restart.<

Diesel exhaust fluid at minimum

Even with a display of -- mls, the engine will continue to run, provided that it is not switched off, and all other operating requirements are met, e.g. sufficient fuel.

Do not drive until the displayed remaining distance runs out. Otherwise, it may not

be possible to restart the engine.<

Incorrect fueling The warning lamp lights up: The reservoir has been filled with an incorrect fluid.

Please contact your BMW Sports Activity Vehi- cle Center.

Have diesel exhaust fluid refilled Your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center refills the diesel exhaust fluid as part of the regular maintenance. If you adhere to this maintenance schedule, it is usually not necessary to refill any fluids between the maintenance dates.

Under certain circumstances, e.g. due to a par- ticularly sporty driving style or operation of the vehicle at high altitudes, it may be necessary to refill fluids between maintenance dates.

As soon as the reserve display has appeared in the instrument panel, have the diesel exhaust fluid refilled to prevent the engine from being unable to restart.

You can have the fluid refilled by a BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center.

Diesel exhaust fluid at low temperatures

Due to its physical properties, at temper- atures below +237/56, it may also be

necessary to refill the diesel exhaust fluid between the regular maintenance dates. If the fluid needs to be refilled, this will be indi- cated with the reserve display in the instrument panel, refer to page 246.<

M o

b il

it y

247

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Only refill the diesel exhaust fluid yourself in exceptional circumstances In order to get your vehicle to reach the nearest BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center, you may refill the diesel exhaust fluid yourself, making sure to heed the warning notices.

Do not allow diesel exhaust fluid to come into contact with you. This can lead to

skin and eye irritation. Wear protective goggles and gloves as needed. Follow the safety instructions on the bottle. When opening the bottle or reservoir, pungent smelling vapors can escape. Before refilling, close the vehicle completely so that the vapors do not get into the interior of the vehicle. When handling diesel exhaust fluid in enclosed spaces, make sure to have sufficient ventilation. After handling diesel exhaust fluid, wash hands thoroughly. Failure to do so may lead to irrita- tion, e.g. due to inadvertent contact with the eyes. If eye irritation occurs, immediately rinse eyes with ample water and contact a doctor if neces- sary. If diesel exhaust fluid comes into contact with surfaces of your vehicle, rinse the affected sur- faces with water or else damage may occur. Keep diesel exhaust fluid out of reach of chil- dren.<

Suitable diesel exhaust fluid > Preferred: BMW Diesel Exhaust Fluid.

This bottle and its special adapter permit convenient refilling with diesel exhaust fluid.

> Alternative: NOx reduction agent AUS 32

You can get diesel exhaust fluid at your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center.

Refilling quantity Refilling quantity at the start of the reserve dis- play: approx. 0.75 US gal/2.7 Liter

Open reservoir for diesel exhaust fluid 1. Open hood, refer to page 258.

2. Fit releasing tool from onboard tool kit, refer to page 269 into place and open the lock, refer to arrow.

Refilling BMW diesel exhaust fluid 1. Set bottle into place and rotate until it

comes into contact with the stop, refer to arrow.

2. Press bottle down, refer to arrow. The reservoir of the vehicle is filled.

3. The reservoir is full when the fill level in the bottle stops changing. It is not possible to overfill.

R ef

u el

in g

248

Pull bottle back, refer to arrow, and unscrew it.

Closing reservoir After the reservoir is filled, close it again with the releasing tool.

After refilling diesel exhaust fluid

Incorrect fluid After refilling with the incorrect fluid, e.g. antifreeze for windshield wiper fluid, do

not start the engine because this could result in a fire hazard.<

Contact your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center.

Bottle disposal You can have bottles for diesel exhaust fluid properly disposed of at your BMW

Sports Activity Vehicle Center. Only dispose of empty bottles in your house- hold garbage if the local legal regulations permit it.<

Reserve display

After refilling, the reserve continues to appear after the engine is restarted. After the vehicle

has been driven for a few more minutes, this display will disappear.

M o

b il

it y

249

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Wheels and tires

Tire inflation pressure

Information for your safety The condition of the tires and the maintenance of the specified tire pressure are crucial not only to the tire's service life, but also to driving com- fort and most importantly, driving safety.

Checking pressure Only check tire inflation pressure when the tires are cold. This means after a maximum of 1.25 miles/2 km driving or when the vehicle has been parked for at least 2 hours. When tires are warm, the tire inflation pressure increases.

Check the tire inflation pressure regularly and correct it as needed, even on the

compact tire*: at least twice a month and before starting long trips. If you fail to observe this pre- caution, you may be driving on tires with incor- rect tire pressures, a condition that can not only compromise your vehicle's driving stability, but also lead to tire damage and the risk of an acci- dent. Do not drive with depressurized, i.e. flat tires, except run-flat tires. A flat tire will seri- ously impair your vehicle's handling and braking response. Attempts to drive on a flat tire can lead to a loss of control over the vehicle.<

After correcting the tire inflation pressure, reinitialize the Flat Tire Monitor, refer to

page 100, or reset the Tire Pressure Monitor, refer to page 102.<

Pressure specifications The tables below provide all the correct inflation pressures for the specified tire sizes at ambient temperature.

The inflation pressures apply to the tire sizes and tire brands respectively

approved and recommended by BMW; a list of these is available from your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center.<

For correct identification of the right tire infla- tion pressure for your tires, observe the follow- ing:

> Tire sizes of your vehicle

> Load conditions

> Maximum allowable driving speed

Tire inflation pressures for speeds up to 100 mph/160 km/h For normal driving up to 100 mph/160 km/h, adjust pressures to the respective tire inflation pressures listed on the following pages in the column Traveling speeds up to max. of 100 mph/160 km/h to achieve optimum driving comfort.

These pressure specifications can be found on the door post when you open the driver's door.

The permissible top speed for these tire inflation pressures is 100 mph/160 km/h.

Do not exceed this speed, otherwise tire dam- age and accidents may result.<

W h

ee ls

a n

d ti

re s

250

Tire inflation pressures for speeds above 100 mph/160 km/h

In order to drive at maximum speeds in excess of 100 mph/160 km/h, please

observe, and, if necessary, adjust tire pressures for speeds exceeding 100 mph/160 km/h from the relevant table on the following pages. Oth- erwise tire damage and accidents could occur.<

Observe all national and local maximum speed limits, otherwise violations of the law could occur.

M o

b il

it y

251

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Tire inflation pressures X5 xDrive30i/X5 xDrive48i/X5 xDrive35d with two rows of seats

Tire size Pressure specifications in psi/kPa

Traveling speeds up to a max. of

100 mph/160 km/h

Traveling speeds including those exceeding

100 mph/160 km/h

All pressure specifications in the table are indicated in psi/ kilopascal with cold tires. Cold = ambient temperature

Compact wheel*: T 155/90 D 18 113 M T 155/80 R 19 114 M

60/420 60/420 60/420 60/420 60/420 60/420

without sport package:

255/55 R 18 109 H M+S XL 32/220 32/220 32/220 32/220 32/220 38/260

255/50 R 19 107 H M+S XL 32/220 35/240 32/220 32/220 32/220 38/260

Front: 255/50 R 19 107 V XL 32/220 - 32/220 - 32/220 -

Rear: 285/45 R 19 111 V XL - 32/220 - 32/220 - 35/240

Front: 275/40 R 20 106 W XL 32/220 - 32/220 - 32/220 -

Rear: 315/35 R 20 110 W XL - 32/220 - 32/220 - 35/240

Front: 285/35 R 21 105 W XL 32/220 - 32/220 - 32/220 -

Rear: 325/30 R 21 108 W XL - 32/220 - 32/220 - 38/260

with sport package:

255/55 R 18 109 H M+S XL 32/220 32/220 32/220 32/220 32/220 38/260

255/50 R 19 107 H M+S XL 32/220 35/240 32/220 32/220 32/220 38/260

Front: 255/50 R 19 107 V XL 32/220 - 32/220 - 35/240 -

Rear: 285/45 R 19 111 V XL - 32/220 - 32/220 - 38/260

Front: 275/40 R 20 106 W XL 32/220 - 32/220 - 35/240 -

Rear: 315/35 R 20 110 W XL - 32/220 - 32/220 - 38/260

Front: 285/35 R 21 105 W XL 32/220 - 32/220 - 35/240 -

Rear: 325/30 R 21 108 W XL - 32/220 - 35/240 - 41/280

More details on the permissible load and weights can be found on page 289.

W h

ee ls

a n

d ti

re s

252

Tire inflation pressures X5 xDrive30i/X5 xDrive48i/X5 xDrive35d with two rows of seats

Tire size Pressure specifications in psi/kPa

Traveling speeds up to a max. of

100 mph/160 km/h

Traveling speeds including those exceeding

100 mph/160 km/h

All pressure specifications in the table are indicated in psi/ kilopascal with cold tires. Cold = ambient temperature

without sport package:

255/55 R 18 109 H M+S XL 32/220 35/240 32/220 32/220 32/220 39/270

255/50 R 19 107 H M+S XL 32/220 38/260 32/220 35/240 35/240 42/290

Front: 255/50 R 19 107 V XL 32/220 - 32/220 - 32/220 -

Rear: 285/45 R 19 111 V XL - 35/240 - 32/220 - 36/250

Front: 275/40 R 20 106 W XL 32/220 - 32/220 - 32/220 -

Rear: 315/35 R 20 110 W XL - 35/240 - 32/220 - 36/250

Front: 285/35 R 21 105 W XL 32/220 - 32/220 - 32/220 -

Rear: 325/30 R 21 108 W XL - 36/250 - 32/220 - 39/270

with sport package:

255/55 R 18 109 H M+S XL 32/220 35/240 32/220 32/220 32/220 39/270

255/50 R 19 107 H M+S XL 32/220 38/260 32/220 35/240 35/240 42/290

Front: 255/50 R 19 107 V XL 32/220 - 32/220 - 35/240 -

Rear: 285/45 R 19 111 V XL - 35/240 - 35/240 - 41/280

Front: 275/40 R 20 106 W XL 32/220 - 32/220 - 35/240 -

Rear: 315/35 R 20 110 W XL - 35/240 - 35/240 - 39/270

Front: 285/35 R 21 105 W XL 32/220 - 32/220 - 35/240 -

Rear: 325/30 R 21 108 W XL - 36/250 - 35/240 - 42/290

More details on the permissible load and weights can be found on page 289.

M o

b il

it y

253

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Tire inflation pressure X6 xDrive35i

Tire inflation pressures for X6 xDrive50i

Tire size Pressure specifications in psi/kPa

Traveling speeds up to a max. of

100 mph/160 km/h

Traveling speeds including those exceeding

100 mph/160 km/h

All pressure specifications in the table are indicated in psi/ kilopascal with cold tires. Cold = ambient temperature

255/50 R 19 107 H M+S XL 255/50 R 19 107 V M+S XL

32/220 32/220 32/220 32/220 33/230 39/270

Front: 275/40 R 20 106 W XL 32/220 - 32/220 - 33/230 -

Rear: 315/35 R 20 110 W XL - 32/220 - 32/220 - 36/250

Front: 285/35 R 21 105 W XL 32/220 - 32/220 - 33/230 -

Rear: 325/30 R 21 108 W XL - 32/220 - 32/220 - 36/250

Compact wheel*: T 155/90 D 18 113 M T 155/80 R 19 114 M

60/420 60/420 60/420 60/420 60/420 60/420

More details on the permissible load and weights can be found on page 289.

Tire size Pressure specifications in psi/kPa

Traveling speeds up to a max. of

100 mph/160 km/h

Traveling speeds including those exceeding

100 mph/160 km/h

All pressure specifications in the table are indicated in psi/ kilopascal with cold tires. Cold = ambient temperature

255/50 R 19 107 H M+S XL 255/50 R 19 107 V M+S XL

33/230 33/230 33/230 33/230 36/250 39/270

Front: 275/40 R 20 106 W XL 36/250 - 36/250 - 39/270 -

Rear: 315/35 R 20 110 W XL - 36/250 - 36/250 - 39/270

Front: 285/35 R 21 105 W XL 36/250 - 36/250 - 42/290 -

Rear: 325/30 R 21 108 W XL - 36/250 - 36/250 - 42/290

Compact wheel*: T 155/90 D 18 113 M T 155/80 R 19 114 M

60/420 60/420 60/420 60/420 60/420 60/420

More details on the permissible load and weights can be found on page 289.

W h

ee ls

a n

d ti

re s

254

Tire identification marks Knowledge of the labeling on the side of the tire makes it easier to identify and choose the right tires.

Tire size

Speed letter Q = up to 100 mph/160 km/h

T = up to 118 mph/190 km/h

H = up to 131 mph/210 km/h

V = up to 150 mph/240 km/h

W = up to 167 mph/270 km/h

Y = up to 186 mph/300 km/h

Tire Identification Number Tires with DOT codes meet the guidelines of the US Department of Transportation.

DOT code:

Tire age The manufacturing date of tires is contained in the tire coding: DOT ... 3008 indicates that the tire was manufactured in week 30 of 2008.

BMW recommends that you replace all tires after 6 years at most, even if some tires may last for 10 years.

Uniform Tire Quality Grading Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and maximum section width. For example:

Tread wear 200 Traction AA Temperature A

DOT Quality Grades Tread wear Traction AA A B C Temperature A B C

All passenger car tires must conform to Federal Safety Requirements in addition

to these grades.<

Tread wear The tread wear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified gov- ernment test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half (1) times as well on the government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, how- ever, and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices and differences in road characteris- tics and climate.

Traction The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C. These grades represent the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement, as measured under con- trolled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction performance.

The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on straight-ahead braking traction

tests, and does not include acceleration, cor- nering, hydroplaning, or peak traction charac- teristics.<

e.g.

Nominal width in mm Aspect ratio in Belted construction radial Rim diameter in inches Carrying capacity ID-code (not in ZR tires) Speed code letter (in ZR tires before the R)

255/55 R 18 109 H

e.g.

Manufacturer code for tire make Tire size and tire design Tire age

DOT xxxx xxx 0806

M o

b il

it y

255

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Temperature The temperature grades are A, the highest, B, and C, representing the tire's resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehi- cle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law.

The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is properly

inflated and not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either sep- arately or in combination, can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure.<

RSC run-flat tires You will recognize run-flat tires by a circular symbol containing the letters RSC on the side of the tire, refer to page 256.

M+S Winter and all-season tires. These have better winter properties than sum- mer tires.

XL Indicates specially reinforced tires.

Tire condition Inspect your tires frequently for tread wear, signs of damage and for foreign objects lodged in the tread. Check the tread depth.

Minimum tread depth The tread depth should not drop below 0.12 in/ 3 mm, although, for example, European legisla- tion only specifies a minimum tread depth of

0.063 in/1.6 mm. At tread depths below 0.12 in/ 3 mm there is an increased risk of high-speed hydroplaning, even when only small amounts of water are present on the road surface. When winter tires wear down past a tread depth of 0.16 in/4 mm, they become perceptibly less suitable for winter conditions. For the sake of safety, new tires should be installed.

Wear indicators at the tread-groove base are distributed over the tire's circumference and are marked on the side of the tire with TWI Tread Wear Indicator. If the tire tread has been driven down to the wear indicators, a tread depth of 0.063 in/1.6 mm has been reached.

Wheel/tire damage Please note that low-profile tires cause wheels, tires and suspension parts to be more suscep- tible to road hazards and consequential dam- ages. Unusual vibrations encountered during normal vehicle operation can indicate tire failure or some other vehicle defect. This can, for exam- ple, be caused by driving over curbs. These kinds of problems may also be signaled by other changes in vehicle response, such as a strong tendency to pull to the left or right.

In these cases, reduce speed immedi- ately and have wheels and tires thor-

oughly checked. To do so, drive carefully to the nearest BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center or tire shop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained per- sonnel. If necessary, have the vehicle towed there. Otherwise, tire damage can be extremely dangerous to vehicle occupants and other road users.<

W h

ee ls

a n

d ti

re s

256

Run-flat tires

You will recognize run-flat tires by the circular symbol containing the letters RSC on the side of the tire. Run-flat tires consist of partially self-contained tires and special rims. The sidewall reinforce- ment ensures that the tire retains some residual safety in the event of pressure drop and driving remains possible to a restricted degree.

To continue driving with a damaged tire:

> With Flat Tire Monitor, refer to Indication of a flat tire page 101

> With Tire Pressure Monitor, refer to Mes- sage with low tire inflation pressure page 103

New wheels and tires Have new wheels and tires installed only by your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle

Center or a tire shop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained personnel. If this work is not carried out properly, there is a danger of subsequent dam- age and related safety hazards. Make sure that the new wheels are balanced.<

Retreaded tires BMW does not recommend that you use retreaded tires, as driving safety may be

impaired. The causes for this include the possi- bly different tire casing structures and the often wide variations in their age, which can result in a limited service life.<

The right wheels and tires When mounting new tires or changing over from summer to winter tires and vice versa, mount Run-Flat Tires for your own safety. Your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center will be happy to advise you.

BMW recommends that you use only wheel and tire combinations that BMW

has tested and approved for your particular vehicle. Variations in factors such as manufac- turing tolerances mean that even wheels and tires with identical official size ratings could actually have different dimensions than the approved units these differences could lead to body contact, and with it the risk of severe acci- dents. If non-approved wheels and tires are used, BMW cannot evaluate their suitability, and therefore cannot be held liable for driving safety.<

When changing to larger wheels and tires, it may be necessary to make changes to

the wheel-well trim piece, as otherwise road users could be endangered or the vehicle could be damaged. Only have this work carried out by a BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center or a workshop that works in accordance with BMW guidelines and uses appropriately trained per- sonnel.<

You can ask your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center for the correct wheel/tire combination.

The correct wheel/tire combination also affects various systems whose function would other- wise be impaired, e.g. ABS, DSC, xDrive, Dynamic Performance Control in the BMW X6, or Flat Tire Monitor.

To maintain good handling and vehicle response, use only tires of a single tread config- uration from a single manufacturer. Following tire damage, have the original wheel and tire combination remounted on the vehicle as soon as possible.

Wheels with electronics for TPM Tire Pressure Monitor When mounting new tires or changing from summer to winter tires or vice versa, only use wheels with TPM electronics, otherwise the

M o

b il

it y

257

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Tire Pressure Monitor cannot detect a flat tire, refer to page 101. Your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center will be happy to advise you on this subject.

Recommended tire brands

Certain tire makes are recommended by BMW depending on the tire size. You can recognize these from the clearly visible BMW marking on the tire sidewall.

When used properly, these tires comply with the most demanding standards for safety and vehicle response.

Special characteristics of winter tires BMW recommends using winter tires for opera- tion on winter road or at temperatures below +457/+76. Although all-season M+S tires provide better winter traction than summer tires, they generally fail to provide the same lev- els of cold-weather performance as winter tires.

Paying attention to speed Always observe the maximum permissi- ble speed for the winter tires, otherwise

tire damage may occur, which can result in acci- dents.<

Storage Store wheels and tires in a cool, dry place with as little exposure to light as possible. Always protect tires against all contact with oil, grease and fuels. Do not exceed the maximum tire inflation pressure indicated on the side wall of the tire.

Rotating wheels between axles Even with tires of the same size, BMW recommends that you not rotate the front

tires to the rear or vice versa as this can nega- tively affect handling characteristics. When the vehicle is equipped with different tires sizes*, rotating tires from one axle to the other is not permitted.<

Snow chains* BMW only tests certain fine-link snow chains, classifies them as road-safe and recommends them. Your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center can provide you with this information.

BMW X5: use is only permitted in pairs on the rear wheels with tires of the size:

> 255/55 R 18

> 255/50 R 19

BMW X6: it is only permissible to use snow chains in pairs, on the 255/50 R 19 rear wheels.

Observe the manufacturer's instructions when mounting snow chains. Do not exceed a speed of 30 mph/50 km/h with the chains mounted.

After mounting snow chains, do not ini- tialize the Flat Tire Monitor*, as otherwise

incorrect displays can occur. When you are driving with snow chains, it can be beneficial to activate DTC briefly, refer to page 97.<

U n

d er

th e

h o

o d

258

Under the hood

Never attempt to perform any service or repair operations on your vehicle without

the required professional technical training. If you do not know what repair procedures to fol- low, have work on your vehicle done only by your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained per- sonnel. If this work is not carried out properly, there is a danger of subsequent damage and related safety hazards.<

Hood

Releasing

Pull lever.

Opening

Press the release handle and open the hood.

Closing

Close the hood from a height of approx. 16 in/ 40 cm with momentum. It must be clearly heard to engage.

Make sure that the closing path of the hood is clear, otherwise injuries may

result. If you see any signs that the hood is not com- pletely closed while driving your vehicle, you should stop at once and close it securely.<

M o

b il

it y

259

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Engine compartment

BMW X5

1 Filler neck for washer fluid of the headlamp and windshield cleaning systems, refer to page 75

2 Starting-aid terminal, refer to page 280

3 Expansion tank for coolant, refer to page 262

4 Filler neck for engine oil, refer to Adding engine oil on page 261

U n

d er

th e

h o

o d

260

BMW X6

1 Filler neck for washer fluid of the headlamp and windshield cleaning systems, refer to page 75

2 Filler neck for engine oil, refer to Adding engine oil on page 261

3 Starting-aid terminal, refer to page 280

4 Expansion tank for coolant, refer to page 262

Engine oil The engine oil consumption is dependent on driving style and driving conditions.

Checking engine oil level Your vehicle is equipped with an electronic oil level check.

The condition for the most accurate indication of the oil level possible is measurement with the engine at operating temperature, i.e. following an uninterrupted drive of at least 6 miles/10 km. You can display the oil level while driving or when stopped on a level surface with the engine running.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Info sources" and press the control- ler.

4. Select "Service Info" and press the control- ler.

M o

b il

it y

261

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Service requirements" is selected and press the controller.

6. Change to the second field from the top if necessary. Turn the controller until "Engine oil level" is selected and press the control- ler. The oil level is displayed.

Possible messages > "Engine oil level O.K."

> "No measurement available: Updating engine oil level measurement...": Engine oil level is being measured. This process can take approx. 3 minutes when stopped on a level surface and approx. 5 minutes while driving.

> "Oil level at the minimum! Refill with 1 quart of engine oil.": Add 1 US quart/liter of engine oil at the next opportunity.

If the oil level displayed is below mini- mum, add engine oil immediately.

Failure to do so may lead to engine dam- age.<

> "Engine oil level too high":

Have the vehicle checked immedi- ately, otherwise engine damage may

result if too much oil has been added.<

> "Please observe recalculated service inter- val for engine oil": Do not add engine oil. Before continuing to drive, note the recalculated remaining mile- age until the next oil change service, refer to Service requirements on page 82. Have the system checked as soon as possible.

Adding engine oil

BMW X5

BMW X6

Do not add 1 US quart/liter of oil until a corre- sponding message is shown on the Control Dis- play.

Add oil within the next 125 miles/200 km, otherwise the engine could be dam-

aged.<

Continuous exposure to used oil has caused cancer in laboratory testing.

For this reason, any skin areas that come into contact with oil should be thoroughly washed with soap and water. Keep oil, grease etc. out of reach of children and observe the warnings on the containers to pre- vent health risks.<

Oil change Only have an oil change carried out by a BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center or a workshop that works in accordance with BMW guidelines and uses appropriately trained personnel.

U n

d er

th e

h o

o d

262

Approved engine oils The quality of the engine oil has critical signifi- cance for the operation and service life of an engine. BMW continuously approves specific oils after confirming their suitability for use in its vehicles with extensive testing.

Your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center will be happy to answer detailed ques-

tions on approved oils.<

You can also call BMW of North America at 1-800-831-1117 or visit the website at www.bmwusa.com to obtain this information.

Do not use oil additives, as these may result in engine damage.<

Alternative oil types If none of the approved oils is available, you can also use other oils for adding small amounts between oil changes. One of the following oil specifications must be indicated on the pack- aging:

Gasoline engines > preferably: BMW Longlife-01,

BMW Longlife-01 FE, or BMW Longlife-04

> alternatively: BMW Longlife-98, API SM or higher

Diesel engines > BMW Longlife-04

Viscosity grades Viscosity is a measure of an oil's flow rating and is specified in SAE grades.

The choice of the right SAE grade is based on the climatic conditions in the region in which you normally drive your BMW.

Approved oils belong to the SAE classifi- cations 0W-40, 0W-30, 5W-40 and

5W-30.<

These oils can be used for driving at all outside temperatures.

Coolant Do not add coolant to the cooling system when the engine is hot. Escaping coolant

can cause burns.<

Coolant is composed of equal parts water and a coolant additive. Not all commercially available additives are suitable for your BMW. Your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center can recommend suitable additives.

Only use suitable additives, otherwise engine damage may result. The additives

present a health hazard; observe the instruc- tions on the containers.<

Comply with the appropriate environ- mental protection regulations when dis-

posing of coolant additives.<

Checking coolant level 1. Do not open the hood until the engine has

cooled down.

2. Turn the cap of the expansion tank counter- clockwise to allow any accumulated pres- sure to escape, then continue turning to open.

3. The coolant level is correct when the cool- ant level is between the MIN and MAX marks, refer to the diagram adjacent to the filler neck.

4. If the coolant is low, slowly add coolant up to the specified level; do not overfill.

5. Turn the cap until there is an audible click.

6. Have the reason for the coolant loss elimi- nated as soon as possible.

M o

b il

it y

263

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Maintenance

BMW maintenance system

The BMW maintenance system supports the preservation of the traffic and operating safety of your BMW. The service schedule also includes operations related to the vehicle's comfort and convenience features, such as replacement of the filters for the inside air. The ultimate objective is to ensure economical maintenance by providing the ideal service for your vehicle.

Should the day come when you decide to sell your BMW, a complete dealer service history will prove to be an asset of inestimable value.

CBS Condition Based Service Sensors and special algorithms take the differ- ent driving conditions of your BMW into account. Condition Based Service uses this to determine the current and future service requirements. By letting you define a service and maintenance regimen that reflects your own individual requirements, the system builds the basis for trouble-free driving.

You can set the Control Display to show remaining distances and times of selected maintenance intervals and legally mandated deadlines, refer to page 82:

> Engine oil

> Brake pads, front and rear separately

> Brake fluid

> Vehicle check

> Legally mandated inspections depending on local regulations

Service data in remote control Your vehicle stores the information required for maintenance continuously in the remote con- trol during driving. After accessing the data stored in the remote control, your BMW Service Advisor can suggest precisely the right array of service procedures for your own individual vehi- cle. You should therefore hand over the remote control you last used to drive to the BMW Ser- vice Advisor when you take your vehicle in for service.

Make sure the date is set correctly, refer to page 89, otherwise the effectiveness

of CBS Condition Based Service is not ensured.<

Service and Warranty Information Booklet for US models and Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models Please consult your Service and Warranty Infor- mation Booklet for US models and Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models for additional information on service require- ments.

BMW recommends that you have service and repair operations performed at your

BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center. Take the time to ensure that these service pro- cedures are confirmed by entries in your vehi- cle's Service and Warranty Information Booklet for US models and Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models. These entries verify that your vehicle has received the speci- fied regular maintenance.<

M ai

n te

n an

ce

264

Socket for OBD Onboard Diagnostics interface

Components which are decisive for the exhaust-gas composition can be checked via the OBD socket with a device.

This socket is located to the left on the driver's side, on the underside of the instrument cluster under a cover.

Exhaust-gas values The warning lamp lights up: The vehicle is producing an elevated amount of exhaust emissions. Contin-

ued driving is possible. Have it checked at your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center as soon as possible.

Display of the previously described malfunction in Canadian models.

The lamp flashes under certain conditions. This is a sign of excessive misfiring of the engine. In this case, you should reduce your speed and proceed to the nearest BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center. Heavy engine misfiring causes serious damage to the emission-relevant com- ponents, especially the catalytic converter, within a short time.

If the fuel filler cap is not properly tight- ened, the OBD system will assume that

fuel vapor escapes. Then a display lights up. If the cap is then tightened, the display will go out within a few days.<

Event Data Recorders Your vehicle may be equipped with one or sev- eral measuring and diagnosis modules, or with a device for recording or transmitting certain vehicle data or information. If you have also sub- scribed to BMW Assist, certain vehicle data can be transmitted or recorded to enable corre- sponding services.

M o

b il

it y

265

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Care

Car-care products For the cleaning and care of your vehicle, BMW recommends using only products that BMW has approved for this purpose.

Regular cleaning and care make a significant contribution to retaining your BMW's value.

The BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center will be happy to consult you on products and services for the cleaning and care of your BMW.

Genuine BMW Care Products are materi- als tested, laboratory tested, and tested in

actual use. They offer optimum care and pro- tection for your vehicle.<

Do not use cleaners that contain alcohol or solvents; they can damage your vehi-

cle.<

Cleaning agents can contain substances that are dangerous or pose health risks.

You should therefore heed the warnings and hazard indications on the packaging. Open the doors or windows on your vehicle whenever cleaning the interior. Make sure there is suffi- cient ventilation in enclosed spaces. Use only products that are formulated for vehicle clean- ing.<

Exterior care

Washing your vehicle In the winter months, it is especially important to ensure that the vehicle is

washed on a regular basis. Otherwise, signifi- cant soiling and road salt can cause damage to the vehicle.<

After washing the vehicle, apply the brakes briefly to dry them. Failure to do so

may lead to a reduction in braking efficiency and also to corrosion of the brake rotors.<

Car washes Give preference to cloth car washes.

Before driving into the car wash, make sure that it is suitable for your BMW. Pay attention to the following points:

> Dimensions of your vehicle, refer to page 287.

> If necessary: fold in door mirror, refer to page 57.

> Maximum permissible tire width.

Preparations for driving into the car wash:

> Deactivate rain sensor* to prevent unwanted wiper activation.

> BMW X5: deactivate rear window wiper and protect it from damage. Take appropriate protective measures; inquiring with the car wash operator as needed.

> Remove additional add-on parts, e.g. spoil- ers or phone antennas, if they could be damaged.

Automatic transmission with Steptronic Before driving into the car wash, observe the following so that the vehicle is able to roll:

1. Insert the remote control into the ignition lock, even with comfort access.

2. Shift into transmission position N.

3. Release the parking brake.

4. Deactivate Automatic Hold, refer to page 68.

5. Switch off the engine.

6. Leave the remote control in the ignition lock so that the vehicle can roll.

C ar

e

266

Steam cleaners/high-pressure cleaning jets

When using steam cleaners or high-pres- sure cleaning jets, make sure to maintain

a sufficient distance and stay below a maximum temperature of 1407/606. Insufficient distance or excessive pressure or temperature can damage parts of the vehicle or can result in water penetration. Follow the oper- ating instructions for the high-pressure clean- ing jets.<

When using high-pressure cleaning jets, do not remain in one place for a long time

and be sure to maintain a distance of at least 12 in/30 cm from sensors and cameras, e.g. Park Distance Control sensors or rear view camera.<

Hand washing When washing the vehicle by hand, use plenty of water and car washing shampoo. Clean the vehicle with gentle pressure using a sponge or a washing brush.

Before cleaning the windshield, deacti- vate the rain sensor or switch off the igni-

tion to prevent unwanted wiper operation.<

Follow local guidelines for washing vehi- cles by hand.<

Headlamps Do not rub dry and never use abrasives or strong solvents to clean the covers.

Loosen dirt, e.g. insects, with shampoo or insect remover and wash away with plenty of water.

Use a window de-icer to remove accumulated ice and snow, not a scraper.

Windows Use a glass cleaner to clean the inside and out- side surfaces of the windows and the glass sur- faces of the mirrors.

Do not use quartz-containing cleansers to clean glass surfaces of the mirrors.<

Wiper blades Clean with soapy water and replace regularly to prevent streaking.

The presence of wax and sealant residues and dirt on the windows leads to streaking

during wiper operation and results in premature wear on wiper blades as well as interference with the rain sensor.<

Caring for the vehicle finish Regular care helps your vehicle retain its value and protects the paint from the long-term effects of aggressive substances.

Regionally occurring environmental factors can affect and damage vehicle finish. It is therefore important to tailor the frequency and extent of your car care accordingly.

Immediately remove particularly aggressive substances such as spilled fuel, oil, grease, brake fluid, tree resin, or bird droppings; other- wise, they may damage your paint.

Repairing paint damage Repair stone damage or scratches imme- diately, depending on the severity of the

damage, to prevent the formation of rust.<

BMW recommends having paint damage pro- fessionally repaired using Genuine BMW finish materials in accordance with factory guidelines.

Waxing Sealant is required when water no longer beads on the clean surface of the paint. Use only prod- ucts that contain carnauba wax or synthetic wax to seal your finish.

Rubber gaskets Treat only with water or a rubber care product.

To avoid noise or damage, do not use products that contain silicone to care for

rubber gaskets.<

Chrome components Particularly after exposure to road salt, thor- oughly cleanse parts like the radiator grille, door handles, or window frames with plenty of water

M o

b il

it y

267

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

with shampoo added to it. For additional treat- ment, use chrome polish.

Alloy wheels Depending on your system, braking can gener- ate dust, which settles on the light-alloy wheels. Remove this dust regularly with acid-free wheel cleaner.

Do not use aggressive, acid-containing, strongly alkaline, or coarse cleansers and

do not use steam cleaners at temperatures greater than 1407/606; otherwise you may damage your vehicle.<

Aluminum running boards A rust film on the aluminum running boards can be removed with a special cleaning agent.

Outside sensors/cameras Keep the sensors and cameras outside the vehicle, e.g. the Park Distance Control

or rear view camera, clean and free of ice to ensure their full operability.<

Interior care

Upholstery materials/cloth-covered paneling Clean regularly with a vacuum cleaner in order to remove surface dirt.

In the event of more serious soiling such as bev- erage stains, use a soft sponge or a lint-free microfiber cloth in combination with suitable interior cleaners. Follow the instructions on the packaging.

Clean upholstery material over a large area extending out to the seams. Avoid

intense friction.<

Open Velcro fasteners on pants or other items of clothing can cause damage to

the seat covering. Make sure that the Velcro fasteners are closed.<

Leather/leather-covered paneling The leather used by BMW is a high quality natural product. Slight patterns in the

grain are part of the typical properties of a natu- ral leather.<

Dust and dirt from the road chafe in pores and folds and result in considerable wear and cause the leather surface to become prematurely brit- tle. We therefore suggest that you clean the leather with a dust cloth or vacuum cleaner at regular intervals.

Particularly with light-colored leather, make sure to clean it regularly since it has a greater tendency to become soiled.

Treat the leather twice a year with a leather lotion since dirt and grease harm the protective layer of the leather.

Carpets/cargo bay Floor carpets and floor mats can be vacuumed or cleaned with interior cleaner when they are more heavily soiled.

Floor mats can be removed for cleaning. When inserting into place, make sure that the seat rails do not protrude over the floor mats; other- wise floor mats can be damaged.

Fluff on new floor mats is a result of the produc- tion process and can be removed by repeated vacuuming.

Plastic components inside > Vinyl upholstery surfaces

> Lamp lenses

> Cover glass of instrument cluster

> Matt parts

should be cleaned with water and, if necessary, solvent-free plastic cleaner.

Fine wooden components Use a damp cloth to clean fine wooden trim panels and components. Follow up by drying with a soft cloth.

C ar

e

268

Safety belts Do not use cleansers to clean the safety belts since this can destroy the web-

bing.<

Inside sensors/cameras Clean inside sensors and cameras, such as those of the high-beam assistant, using a lint- free cloth moistened with glass cleaner.

Displays Clean displays like the radio or the instrument cluster using a display-cleaning cloth or a soft, nonabrasive lint-free cloth.

Avoid using excessive pressure when cleaning displays; otherwise, you could

damage them.<

Never use chemical-based cleansers or household scouring products. Keep all

liquids away from the equipment. Otherwise surfaces or electrical components could be attacked or damaged.<

CD/DVD-player Do not use cleaning CDs; they can dam- age parts of the player.<

Storing your vehicle When storing your vehicle for longer than three months, please seek the advice of your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center or a workshop that works in accordance with BMW guidelines.

M o

b il

it y

269

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Replacing components

Onboard toolkit

The onboard toolkit is located in the cargo bay under the floor panel.

Replacing wiper blades

Front

1. Fold down the wiper arm.

2. Swing the wiper blade upward.

3. Remove the wiper blade toward the wind- shield, refer to arrow.

BMW X5: rear

1. Lift off the wiper arm completely and pull off the wiper blade, refer to arrow.

2. Mount the new wiper blade and press on until it is heard to engage.

Lamps and bulbs Lamps and bulbs make an essential contribu- tion to vehicle safety. You must be duly diligent in replacing them. BMW recommends having your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center per- form any work that you do not feel competent to perform yourself or that is not described here.

Never touch the glass of new bulbs with your bare fingers, as even minute

amounts of contamination will burn into the bulb's surface and reduce its service life. Use a clean cloth, napkin, etc., or hold the bulb by its metal socket.<

A replacement bulb set is available from your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center.

Only replace bulbs when cool, as other- wise you may be burned.<

Whenever you perform any work on the electrical system, turn off the systems/

consumers involved to prevent short circuits from occurring. To avoid possible injury or equipment damage when replacing bulbs, observe any instructions provided by the bulb manufacturer.<

R ep

la ci

n g

c o

m p

o n

en ts

270

When performing care and maintenance on the headlamps, please observe the information on page 266.

For bulbs for which replacement is not described and for checking and adjusting

headlamp aim, please contact your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center.<

Light-emitting diodes LEDs Light-emitting diodes installed behind translu- cent lenses serve as the light source for many of the controls and displays in your vehicle. These light-emitting diodes, which operate using a concept similar to that applied in conventional lasers, are officially designated as Class 1 light- emitting diodes.

Do not remove the covers, and never stare into the unfiltered light for several

hours, as irritation of the retina could result.<

BMW X5: changing lamps

Xenon light These bulbs have a very long service life and the probability of a failure is very low. If one of these bulbs should nevertheless fail, it is possi- ble to continue driving with great caution using the fog lamps, provided traffic laws in your area do not prohibit this.

Have work on the xenon light unit includ- ing changing the bulb carried out only by

your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained per- sonnel. Due to the high voltage present in the system, there is a danger of fatal injuries when work is carried out improperly.<

Halogen bulbs: Parking lamps and roadside parking lamps, daytime driving lamps 35-Watt bulb, H8

The bulb is pressurized. Therefore, wear safety glasses and protective gloves.

Otherwise there is a danger of injuries if the

bulb is accidentally damaged during replace- ment.<

1. Turn the cover to the left and remove.

2. Turn the bulbs to the left, pull off the con- nector and replace.

3. Install in the reverse order.

Turn signals, front 24-Watt bulb, PY24W

1. Unscrew bulb holder with bulb to the left, refer to arrow, and replace.

2. Install in the reverse order.

Side marker lamps, rear To replace, please go to a BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with cor- respondingly trained personnel.

Tail lamps > Turn signals, brake lamps: 21-watt bulb,

P21W

> Backup lamps and brake force display: 16- watt bulb, W16W

> Rear lamp: LED technology. In case of a defect, please go to a BMW

M o

b il

it y

271

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Sports Activity Vehicle Center or a work- shop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained personnel.

Arrangement of tail lamps

1 Rear lamp

2 Brake force display

3 Turn signal

4 Brake lamp/rear lamp/side marker lamp

5 Backup lamp

6 Brake lamp

Brake lamp 1. Open the side panel in the cargo bay.

2. Remove the first-aid kit* and warning trian- gle* if necessary. Fold up the insulation.

3. Rotate the relevant bulb socket to the left and remove.

4. Remove the upper bulb for replacement. Apply gentle pressure to the lower bulb while turning it to the left for removal and replacement.

5. Remount the side panel.

Turn signal 1. Open the side panel in the cargo bay.

2. Remove the first-aid kit* and warning trian- gle* if necessary. Fold up the insulation.

3. Rotate the bulb socket to the left and remove.

4. Apply gentle pressure to the bulb while turning it to the left for removal and replace- ment.

5. Remount the side panel.

Backup lamp 1. Open the side panel in the cargo bay.

2. Remove the first-aid kit* and warning trian- gle* if necessary. Fold up the insulation.

3. Rotate the bulb socket to the left and remove.

4. Remove the bulb for replacement.

5. Remount the side panel.

R ep

la ci

n g

c o

m p

o n

en ts

272

Brake force display 1. Carefully remove the cover in the liftgate

panel with a screwdriver.

2. Rotate the bulb socket to the left and remove.

3. Apply gentle pressure to the bulb while turning it to the left for removal and replace- ment.

4. Insert the bulb socket in the liftgate and engage it.

5. Before installing the cap, unclip the cargo bay lamp. Then lay the cap on its upper side and close it, refer to arrow.

6. Position the cargo bay lamp and clip it in, refer to arrow.

License plate lamp 5-watt bulb, C11 12W

1. Slide the lamp to the right with a screw- driver, refer to arrow 1.

2. Remove the lamp, arrow 2.

3. Replace the bulb.

4. Reinstall the lamp.

Center brake lamp This lamp uses LED technology for operation. In case of a defect, please go to a BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained personnel.

BMW X6: changing lamps

Xenon lamps These bulbs have a very long service life and the probability of a failure is very low. If one of these bulbs should nevertheless fail, it is possi- ble to continue driving with great caution using

M o

b il

it y

273

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

the fog lamps, provided traffic laws in your area do not prohibit this.

Have work on the xenon light unit includ- ing changing the bulb carried out only by

your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained per- sonnel. Due to the high voltage present in the system, there is a danger of fatal injuries when work is carried out improperly.<

Parking lamps and roadside parking lamps, daytime driving lamps 35-Watt bulb, H8

The bulb is pressurized. Therefore, wear safety glasses and protective gloves.

Otherwise there is a danger of injuries if the bulb is accidentally damaged during replace- ment.<

1. Turn the cover to the left and remove.

2. Left side of vehicle: Rotate the bulb holder to the right, refer to arrow, and remove. Right side of vehicle: Rotate the bulb holder to the left and remove.

3. Disconnect plug and replace bulb.

4. Install in the reverse order.

Side marker lamps 5-Watt bulb, WY5W XLL

1. Rotate the bulb holder to the left and remove.

2. Pull the bulb out of the bulb holder and replace.

3. Install in the reverse order.

Turn signals, front 24-Watt bulb, PY24W

1. Rotate bulb holder to the left and remove it along with the bulb.

2. Rotate the bulb to the right along with the socket and replace.

3. Install in the reverse order.

Tail lamps > Turn signal, backup lamps: 21-watt bulb,

H21W

> Brake lamps, brake force display: 21-watt bulb, P21W

> Rear lamp: LED technology. In case of a defect, please go to a BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center or a work-

R ep

la ci

n g

c o

m p

o n

en ts

274

shop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained personnel.

Arrangement of tail lamps

1 Brake force display/rear lamps

2 Brake lamp/rear lamp

3 Backup lamp

4 Turn signal

Brake lamp 1. Open the side panel in the cargo bay.

2. Remove the first-aid kit* and warning trian- gle* if necessary.

3. Rotate the relevant bulb socket to the left and remove.

4. Apply gentle pressure to the bulb while turning it to the left for removal and replace- ment.

5. Install in the reverse order.

Turn signal 1. Open the side panel in the cargo bay.

2. Remove the first-aid kit* and warning trian- gle* if necessary.

3. Remove bulb holder along with bulb and replace.

4. Install in the reverse order.

Backup lamp 1. Open the side panel in the cargo bay.

2. Remove the first-aid kit* and warning trian- gle* if necessary.

3. Remove bulb holder along with bulb and replace.

4. Install in the reverse order.

Brake force display 1. Carefully remove the cover in the liftgate

panel with a screwdriver.

2. Rotate the bulb socket to the left and remove.

M o

b il

it y

275

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

3. Apply gentle pressure to the bulb while turning it to the left for removal and replace- ment.

4. Insert the bulb socket in the liftgate and engage it.

5. Replace the cover.

License plate lamp 5-Watt bulb, C5W

1. Slide the lamp to the right with a screw- driver, refer to arrow 1.

2. Remove the lamp, arrow 2.

3. Replace the bulb.

4. Reinstall the lamp.

Center brake lamp This lamp uses LED technology for operation. In case of a defect, please go to a BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained personnel.

Changing wheels Your BMW is equipped with run-flat tires as standard. As a result, it is not necessary to change the wheel immediately in the case of air loss in the event of a breakdown.

To continue driving with a damaged tire:

> With Flat Tire Monitor, refer to Indication of a flat tire page 101

> With Tire Pressure Monitor, refer to Mes- sage with low tire inflation pressure page 103

You will recognize run-flat tires by a circular symbol containing the letters RSC on the side of the tire, refer to Run-flat tires, page 256.

When mounting new tires, or changing from summer to winter tires or vice versa, use run-flat tires for your own safety. No spare tire is avail- able in case of a flat tire. Your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center will be happy to advise you. Also refer to New wheels and tires, page 256.

BMW X6: do not rotate the front wheels to the rear or vice versa, as otherwise the

handling characteristics will be negatively affected.<

Suitable tools for changing tires are avail- able as accessories at your BMW Sports

Activity Vehicle Center.<

Jacking points for vehicle jack

The jacking points for the vehicle jack are located in the positions shown.

Compact wheel* Safety precautions in the event of a flat tire or wheel change: park the vehicle as

R ep

la ci

n g

c o

m p

o n

en ts

276

far as possible from passing traffic and on solid ground. Switch on the hazard warning flashers. Set the parking brake and engage transmission position P. Have all vehicle occupants get out of the vehicle and ensure that they remain outside the imme- diate area in a safe place, such as behind a guardrail. If a warning triangle* or portable hazard warning lamp* is required, set it up on the roadside at an appropriate distance from the rear of the vehi- cle. Comply with all safety guidelines and regu- lations. Change the wheel only on a level, firm surface which is not slippery. The vehicle or the jack could slip to the side if you attempt to raise the vehicle on a soft or slippery surface such as snow, ice, tiles, etc. Position the jack on a firm support surface. Do not use a wooden block or similar object as a support base for the jack, as this would prevent it from extending to its full support height and reduce its load-carrying capacity. To avoid serious or fatal injury: never lie under the vehicle, and never start the engine while it is supported by the jack.<

What you will need To avoid rattling noises later on, note the posi- tions of the tools before removing them, then return them to their initial positions after com- pleting work. The tools are located in the mount under the floor panel flap.

1 Vehicle jack* 2 Vehicle jack crank* 3 Lug wrench*

Removing compact wheel The compact wheel is located in the cargo bay under the floor panel.

1. Remove the tool mount.

2. Unscrew the wing nut 1.

3. Remove the washer 2 laterally.

4. Remove the compact wheel.

Preparing wheel change 1. Observe the safety precautions above.

2. Loosen the lug bolts a half turn.

Jacking up vehicle 1. Position the vehicle jack at the jacking point

closest to the wheel so that the entire sur- face of the jack base rests on the ground perpendicularly beneath the jacking point.

The vehicle jack is designed for changing wheels only. Do not attempt

to raise another vehicle model with it or to raise any load of any kind. To do so could cause accidents and personal injury.<

M o

b il

it y

277

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

2. Guide the jack head into the rectangular recess of the jacking point when cranking up, refer to illustration detail.

3. Jack the vehicle up until the wheel you are changing is raised from the ground.

Mounting a wheel 1. Unscrew the lug bolts and remove the

wheel.

2. Remove accumulations of mud or dirt from the mounting surfaces of the wheel and hub. Also clean the lug bolts.

3. Position the new wheel or compact wheel. Secure the wheel by screwing at least two lug bolts into opposite bolt holes. When you mount wheels other than Genu- ine BMW light-alloy wheels, different lug bolts may also be required.

4. Screw in the remaining lug bolts. Tighten all the bolts securely in a diagonal pattern.

5. Lower the vehicle and remove the jack from beneath the vehicle.

After mounting 1. Tighten the lug bolts in a diagonal pattern.

To ensure safety, always have the lug bolts checked with a calibrated

torque wrench as soon as possible to ensure that they are tightened to the speci- fied torque. Otherwise, incorrectly tight- ened lug bolts are a hidden safety risk. The tightening torque is 101 lb ft/140 Nm.<

2. Stow the defective wheel in the cargo bay.

The defective wheel cannot be stored under the floor panel flap due to its

size.<

3. Check and correct the tire inflation pressure at the earliest opportunity.

Protect valve stems with valve screw caps against dirt and contamination.

Dirt in valve stems is a frequent source of gradual air loss.<

4. Initialize the Flat Tire Monitor, refer to page 100, or reset the Tire Pressure Moni- tor, refer to page 102.

5. Replace the damaged tire as soon as possi- ble and have the new wheel/tire balanced.

Driving with compact wheel Drive reservedly and do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h. Otherwise,

changes in the driving characteristics could result, for example reduced track stability on braking, extended braking distance, and altered self-steering characteristics in the limit range. In conjunction with winter tires, these charac- teristics are more pronounced.<

Only one compact wheel may be mounted. Restore the wheels and tires to

their original size as quickly as possible. Failure to do so is a safety risk.<

Vehicle battery

Battery care The battery is 100% maintenance-free, i.e., the electrolyte will last for the life of the battery when the vehicle is operated in a temperate cli- mate. Your BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center will be glad to advise in all matters concerning the battery.

Charging battery Only charge the battery in the vehicle via the terminals in the engine compartment with the engine switched off. Connections, refer to Jump starting on page 280.

Disposal Have old batteries disposed of following replacement at your BMW Sports Activity

R ep

la ci

n g

c o

m p

o n

en ts

278

Vehicle Center or bring them to a collection point. Maintain the battery in an upright position for transport and storage. Always restrain the battery to prevent it from tipping over during transport.<

Power failure Following a temporary power failure, e.g. due to a discharged battery, the use of some equip- ment will be restricted, requiring its reinitializa- tion. In the same way, individual settings are lost and must be updated again:

> Seat, mirror and steering wheel memory The positions must be stored again, refer to page 50.

> Time and Date The values must be updated again, refer to pages 88, 89.

> Radio Radio stations must be stored again, refer to page 180.

> Navigation system You must wait until the system becomes functional again, refer to page 170.

> Glass sunroof/panorama glass sunroof It may only be possible to raise the glass sunroof/panorama glass sunroof The sys- tem must be initialized, refer to page 46.

> Digital compass The system must be calibrated, refer to page 126.

Before removing the vehicle from stor- age, consult your BMW Sports Activity

Vehicle Center.<

Fuses Never attempt to repair a blown fuse and do not replace a defective fuse with a sub-

stitute of another color or amperage rating, as this could lead to a circuit overload, ultimately resulting in a fire in the vehicle.<

Spare fuses, a pair of plastic tweezers and infor- mation on the fuse assignment are located near the fuses in the cargo bay.

In interior The fuses are located in the front passenger footwell on the underside of the instrument cluster.

1. Unscrew screws, refer to arrows, of footwell trim panel.

2. Lay the trim panel in the footwell.

3. Unscrew the screw, arrow 1, and fold down the fuse carrier, arrow 2.

4. Replace the fuse concerned.

5. Installation is carried out in the reverse order of removal. Ensure correct and secure attachment of the footwell trim panel in the process.

In cargo bay

Open the right-hand side panel in the cargo bay.

M o

b il

it y

279

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Giving and receiving assistance

Emergency request Conditions for an emergency request:

> Full preparation package mobile phone. With this equipment, an emergency request is still possible when no mobile phone is paired in the vehicle.

> BMW Assist is activated. Activating BMW Assist, refer to page 240.

> Radio readiness is switched on.

> The BMW Assist system is logged in on a wireless communications network.

> The emergency request system is opera- ble.

When the contract of participation with BMW Assist expires, the BMW Assist system can be deactivated by a BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center without having to visit a workshop. Once the BMW Assist system has been deactivated, emergency requests are not possible. The BMW Assist system be reactivated by a BMW Sports Activity Vehicle Center after signing a new contract.

Initiating an emergency request 1. Briefly press protective cover to open.

Depending on the vehicle's equipment, the arrangement of the switches and indicator lamps may differ somewhat.

2. Press the SOS button until the LED in the button lights up.

As soon as the voice connection to the BMW Assist Response Center has been established, the LED flashes.

When the emergency request is received at the BMW Assist Response Center, the BMW Assist Response Center contacts you and takes fur- ther steps to help you. Even if you are unable to answer, the BMW Assist Response Center can take further steps to help you under certain conditions.

If conditions allow, remain in the vehicle until the connection has been established. You will then be able to provide a detailed description of the situation.

Information for determining the required rescue measures is transmitted to the BMW Assist Response Center, e.g. the current position of your vehicle, if this can be determined.

If the LED flashes, but you are unable to hear the BMW Assist Response Center through the hands-free system, this could indicate, for instance, that the hands-free system is no longer operational. The BMW Assist Response Center may still be able to hear you, however.

Under certain conditions, an emergency request is automatically initiated immediately after a severe accident. An automatic collision notification is not affected by the button being pressed.

For technical reasons, the emergency request cannot be guaranteed under

unfavorable conditions.<

Warning triangle* The warning triangle is located in the cargo bay.

First-aid kit* Some of the articles contained in the first-aid kit have a limited service life. Therefore, check the expiration dates of the contents regularly and

G iv

in g

a n

d re

ce iv

in g

a ss

is ta

n ce

280

replace the contents concerned in good time if necessary.

BMW X5

BMW X6

The first aid kit is stored in the cargo bay, behind the left side panel.

Roadside Assistance* The BMW Roadside Assistance offers you assistance in the event of a breakdown around the clock, including on weekends and public holidays.

The phone numbers of the Roadside Assis- tance in your home country can be found in the Contact brochure.

With BMW Assist or BMW TeleServices, you can contact BMW Roadside Assistance for assistance in the event of a breakdown directly via iDrive, refer to page 236.

Jump starting When your battery is discharged, you can use two jumper cables to start your BMW with power from the battery in a second vehicle. You

can also use the same method to help start another vehicle. Use only jumper cables with fully-insulated clamp handles.

To avoid the risk of potentially fatal injury, always avoid all contact with electrical

components while the engine is running. Care- fully adhere to the following sequence, both to prevent damage to one or both vehicles, and to guard against possible personal injuries.<

Preparation 1. Check whether the battery of the other

vehicle has a voltage of 12 Volts and approximately the same capacitance in Ah. This information can be found on the bat- tery.

2. Switch off the engine of the assisting vehi- cle.

3. Switch off any electrical systems and com- ponents in both vehicles.

There must not be any contact between the bodies of the two vehicles, otherwise

there is a danger of shorting.<

Connecting jumper cables To avoid personal injury from sparks, fol- low this sequence when connecting

jumper cables.<

On your BMW the so-called starting-aid termi- nal in the engine compartment acts as the bat- tery positive terminal, also refer to the engine compartment overview on page 259. The cover cap is marked with +.

1. Fold open the cover of the BMW starting- aid terminal. To do so, pull the tab.

M o

b il

it y

281

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

2. Attach one end of the jumper cable plus/+ to the positive terminal of the battery or a starting-aid terminal of the vehicle provid- ing assistance.

3. Attach the second end of the cable to the positive terminal of the battery or to a start- ing-aid terminal of the vehicle to be started.

4. Attach one end of the jumper cable minus/ to the negative terminal of the battery or to an engine or body ground of the assisting vehicle. Your BMW has a special nut as body ground or negative pole.

5. Attach the second end of the cable to the negative terminal of the battery or to the engine or body ground of the vehicle to be started.

Starting engine 1. Start the engine on the assisting vehicle

and allow it to run at idle for several minutes at slightly increased speed.

2. Start the engine on the other vehicle in the usual way. If the first starting attempt is not successful, wait a few minutes before another attempt in order to allow the discharged battery to recharge.

3. Let the engines run for a few minutes.

4. Disconnect the jumper cables by reversing the connection sequence.

Check the battery and recharge if necessary.

Never use spray fluids to start the engine.<

Tow-starting and towing Observe applicable laws and regulations for tow-starting and towing.<

Do not transport any passengers other than the driver in a vehicle that is being

towed.<

Using tow fitting The screw-on tow-fitting must always be car- ried in the vehicle. It can be screwed in at the front or rear of the BMW.

It is located in the toolkit under the floor panel flap in the cargo bay, refer to page 269.

Use only the tow fitting provided with the vehicle and screw it all the way in. Use the

tow fitting for towing only on roads. Avoid lateral loading of the tow fitting, e.g. do not lift the vehi- cle by the tow fitting. Otherwise damage to the tow fitting and the vehicle can occur.<

Access to screw thread Cover panel on left and right side of bumper: press on the arrow symbol on the cover panel.

Front

Rear

G iv

in g

a n

d re

ce iv

in g

a ss

is ta

n ce

282

Being towed Make sure that the ignition is switched on, refer to page 65, otherwise the low

beams, tail lamps, turn signals and windshield wipers would not be available. When the engine is stopped, there is no power assist. This then requires increased effort for braking and steer- ing. Active steering is deactivated and larger steering wheel movements are required.<

Switch on the hazard warning flashers depend- ing on the local regulations. If the electrical sys- tem fails, mark the vehicle to be towed, e.g. with a sign or warning triangle in the rear window.

Before towing, manually unlock the trans- mission lock, refer to page 72; failure to

do so can result in damage to the transmis- sion.<

Do not exceed a towing speed of 45 mph/ 70 km/h and a towing distance of

90 miles/150 km, otherwise the automatic transmission may be damaged.<

Towing methods Do not lift vehicle by tow fitting or body and chassis parts, otherwise damage may

result.<

In some countries, towing with tow bars or ropes in public traffic is not permitted. Familiar- ize yourself with the regulations on towing in the respective country.

With tow bar The towing vehicle may not be lighter than the vehicle to be towed, otherwise it

will not be possible to reliably control vehicle response.<

The tow fittings used should be on the same side on both vehicles. Should it prove impossi- ble to avoid mounting the tow bar at an offset angle, observe the following:

> Clearance and maneuvering capability will be sharply limited during cornering.

> When mounted at an angle, the tow bar will exert lateral forces, tending to push the vehicle sideways.

Only attach the tow bar to the tow fittings, as attachment to other vehicle parts can

lead to damage.<

With tow rope When starting off in the towing vehicle, make sure that the tow rope is taut.

To avoid jerking and the associated stresses on vehicle components when

towing, always use nylon ropes or nylon straps. Only attach tow ropes to the tow fittings, as attachment to other vehicle parts can lead to damage.<

With tow truck Do not tow your BMW with the front or rear axle raised individually; otherwise,

the wheels may lock and the transfer case may be damaged.<

Have the BMW transported only on a flatbed surface.

Tow-starting The engine cannot be started by tow-starting. Start the engine by jump starting it, refer to page 280. Have the cause of the starting difficulties elimi- nated.

M o

b il

it y

283

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Reference This chapter contains the technical data,

the short commands of the voice activation system, and the index that will direct you as quickly as possible to the information

you are looking for.

f r

T ec

h n

ic al

d at

a

286

Technical data

Engine data

BMW X5 X5 xDrive30i X5 xDrive48i X5 xDrive35d

Displacement cu in/cm 182.8/2,996 292.9/4,799 182.6/2,993

No. of cylinders 6 8 6

Maximum output hp 260 350 265

at engine speed rpm 6,600 6,300 4,200

Maximum torque lb ft/Nm 225/305 350/475 425/580

at engine speed rpm 2,750 3,400-3,800 1,750-2,250

BMW X6 X6 xDrive35i X6 xDrive50i

Displacement cu in/cm 181.8/2,979 268.2/4,395

No. of cylinders 6 8

Maximum output hp 300 400

at engine speed rpm 5,800-6,250 5,500-6,400

Maximum torque lb ft/Nm 300/407 450/610

at engine speed rpm 1,400-5,000 1,800-4,500

R e

fe re

n ce

287

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Dimensions

BMW X5

All dimensions given in inches/mm. Smallest turning circle diam.: 42.0 ft/12.8 m

With mixed tires* the vehicle width may exceed the specified dimension.

T ec

h n

ic al

d at

a

288

BMW X6

All dimensions given in inches/mm. Smallest turning circle diam.: 42.0 ft/12.8 m Height with roof rack*: 66.9 in/1,699 mm

With mixed tires* the vehicle width may exceed the specified dimension.

R e

fe re

n ce

289

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Weights

Never exceed either the approved axle loads or the gross vehicle weight.

Never exceed either the approved axle loads or the gross vehicle weight.

BMW X5 X5 xDrive30i X5 xDrive48i X5 xDrive35d

Approved gross vehicle weight

without 3rd row seats

lbs./kg

lbs./kg

6,327/2,870

6,008/2,725

6,537/2,965

6,173/2,800

6,614/3,000

6,294/2,855

Load

without 3rd row seats

lbs./kg

lbs./kg

1,290/585

1,102/500

1,290/585

1,102/500

1,290/585

1,102/500

Approved front axle weight

without 3rd row seats

lbs./kg

lbs./kg

2,767/1,255

2,778/1,260

3,020/1,370

3,020/1,370

3,064/1,390

3,064/1,390

Approved rear axle weight

without 3rd row seats

lbs./kg

lbs./kg

3,803/1,725

3,395/1,540

3,869/1,755

3,395/1,540

3,858/1,750

3,395/1,540

Approved roof load capacity lbs./kg 220/100 220/100 220/100

Cargo bay capacity cu ft/l 21.9-61.8/ 620-1,750

21.9-61.8/ 620-1,750

21.9-61.8/ 620-1,750

BMW X6 X6 xDrive35i X6 xDrive50i

Approved gross vehicle weight lbs./kg 6,085/2,760 6,294/2,855

Load lbs./kg 937/425 937/425

Approved front axle weight lbs./kg 2,910/1,320 3,175/1,440

Approved rear axle weight lbs./kg 3,241/1,470 3,219/1,460

Approved roof load capacity lbs./kg 220/100 220/100

Cargo bay capacity cu ft/l 25.6-59.7/ 570-1,450

25.6-59.7/ 570-1,450

T ec

h n

ic al

d at

a

290

Capacities

BMW X5 Notes

Fuel tank US gal/liters approx. 22.5/85 Fuel grade: page 245

of that reserve

X5 xDrive30i, X5 xDrive35d

X5 xDrive48i

US gal/liters

US gal/liters

approx. 2.1/8

approx. 2.6/10

Windshield washer with headlamp washer system US quarts/liters approx. 6.9/6.5

For more details: page 75

BMW X6 Notes

Fuel tank US gal/liters approx. 22.5/85 Fuel grade: page 245

of that reserve

X6 xDrive35i

X6 xDrive50i

US gal/liters

US gal/liters

approx. 2.1/8

approx. 3.2/12

Windshield washer with headlamp washer system US quarts/liters approx. 6.9/6.5

For more details: page 75

R e

fe re

n ce

291

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Short commands of voice activation system

With short commands you can carry out certain functions directly, regardless of which menu

item is selected. Here are the important short commands for the voice activation system.

Assistance window

Communication

*

Function Command

To open assistance window 20 {Assistance window}

To select display in assistance window 20 {Assistance window map facing north}, {Assistance window map direction of travel}, {Assistance window arrow display}, {Assistance window perspective}, {Assistance window current position}, {Assistance window trip computer} or {Assistance window onboard info}

To change scale in assistance window 164 {Assistance window scale ... feet} or {Assistance window scale ... miles}

Function Command

To open phone 221 {Phone}

To dial phone number 227 {Dial number}

To display phone book 228 {A to Z}

To select from the phone book 228 {Call ...} or {Dial name}

To display "Top 8" 229 {Top 8}

To redial 228 {Redial}

To display "Received calls" 229 {Received calls}

To display "Missed calls" 229 {Missed calls}

To display "Bluetooth" 224 {Bluetooth}

To open "BMW Service" 236 {BMW Service}

S h

o rt

c o

m m

an d

s o

f v o

ic e

ac ti

va ti

o n

s ys

te m

292

Navigation

Onboard info

Function Command

To open navigation system 150 {Navigation}

To open "Enter address" 151 {Enter address}

To open "New destination" 151 {New destination}

To display "Input map" 155 {Input map}

To display destination list 157 {Destination list}

To display address book 158 {Address book}

To display route criteria 160 {Route preference}

To start destination guidance 162 {Start guidance}

To end destination guidance 162 {Stop guidance}

To display arrow display 163 {Arrow display}

To display map display 164 {Map}, {Map facing north}, {Map direction of travel} or {Perspective}

To change scale 164 {Scale ... miles} or {Scale ... feet}

To display roads or towns/cities along route 164 {Route list}

To switch on voice instructions 165 {Navigation info on}

To switch off voice instructions 165 {Navigation info off}

To repeat voice instructions 165 {Repeat navigation info}

To open route 160, 164 {Route menu}

To open "New route" 166 {New route}

To display current position 169 {Current position}

Function Command

To open "Car Data" 80 {Car data}

To display computer 80 {Onboard info}

To display trip computer 81 {Trip computer}

To open stopwatch 87 {Stopwatch}

To open speed limit 87 {Limit}

To activate speed limit 87 {Limit on}

To deactivate speed limit 87 {Limit off}

R e

fe re

n ce

293

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Entertainment

Function Command

Tone control 175 {Audio}

To switch on radio 178 {Radio on}, {FM} or {AM}

To open "FM" 178 {FM menu}

To open "AM" 178 {AM menu}

To open "All stations" 178 {FM All stations}

To select radio station 178 {Station ...}, e.g. {Station WNYC} or {Choose station}

To open "Presets" 178 {FM presets} or {AM presets}

To select stored radio station 178 {Preset ...}, e.g. {Preset 1}

To open "Manual" 179 {FM manual}, {AM manual} or {Choose frequency}, {Frequency ... Megahertz}

To open strongest radio stations 179 {AM Autostore}

To open "WB" 183 {Weatherband menu}

To switch on weatherband 183 {Weatherband on}

To select a weatherband station 183 {Choose weatherband station}

To open "SAT" 184 {SAT radio menu}

To switch on satellite radio 184 {SAT radio}

To open "Presets" of satellite radio 185 {SAT radio presets}

To open "All channels" of satellite radio 185 {SAT radio all channels}

To open "Categories" of satellite radio 185 {SAT radio categories}

To open CD player 187 {CD menu}

To switch on CD player 187 {CD}

To open CD changer 187 {CD-changer menu}

To switch on CD changer 187 {CD-changer}

To select CD 187 {CD 1...6}

To select music track 188 {CD track ...}

To select CD and music track 188 {CD 1...6 track ...}

To switch on audio playback with external audio device 200

{Audio Aux}

S h

o rt

c o

m m

an d

s o

f v o

ic e

ac ti

va ti

o n

s ys

te m

294

Climate

menu

Function Command

To adjust temperature distribution for front seat heating 56

{Seat heater distribution}

To open "Vent settings" 117 {Vent settings}

To open "Automatic programs" 115 {Automatic programs}

To open "Parked car ventilation" 121 {Parked car operation}

To open "Automatic ventilation" 121 {Automatic ventilation}

To display activation times 122 {Activation time}

Function Command

To open the menu {Settings menu}

"Display off" 21 {Display off}

To open "Info sources" {Info sources}

To open "Settings" {Settings}

To open "Door locks" 29 {Door locks}

To open "Steering wheel buttons" 59 {Steering wheel buttons}

To open "Lighting" 73 {Lighting}

To open "Service requirements" 82 {Service requirements}

To open "Service" 82 {Service}

To open "BMW Service" 236 {BMW service settings}

To display "Check Control messages" 86 {Check Control messages}

To open "Head-Up Display" 107 {Head-up display}

To set brightness of Control Display 89 {Brightness}

To open "Units" 89 {Units}

To open "Language" 90, 165 {Language}

To open "Time" 89 {Time}

To open "Date" 89 {Date}

To open "PDC" 91 {PDC}

To open "FTM" 100 {FTM}

To open "TPM" 102 {TPM}

To display "Bluetooth" 225 {Bluetooth}

To open "HDC" 98 {HDC}

R e

fe re

n ce

295

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

296

Everything from A to Z

Index

"..." Identifies Control Display texts used to select individual functions, and indicates where to find them in the text.

A ABS Antilock Brake

System 96 Accessories 6 Access to 3rd row seats 54 Acoustic signal, refer to Check

Control 85 Activated-charcoal filter 119 "Activation time" for parked-

car ventilation 122 Active seat 57 Active seat ventilation 56 Active steering 104 malfunction 104 warning lamp 104 Adaptive brake lamp, brake

force display 105 Adaptive Drive 99 Adaptive fixing system 133 Adaptive Head Light 112 "Add digits" for mobile

phone 228 Address for navigation deleting 159 entering 151, 158 selecting 159 storing 158 storing current position 158 "Add to destination list" 153 Adjusting confirmation signals

for locking and unlocking 31 Adjusting opening

height 34, 36, 37

Adjusting temperature with expanded-scope automatic climate control 116

Adjusting the tone during audio operation, refer to Tone control 175

Adjusting thigh support 49, 50

"After door opened" 51 "After unlocking" 51 Airbags 105 sitting safely 48 warning lamp 107 Air distribution automatic 115, 120 manual 116 Airing, refer to Ventilation 118 Air recirculation 117 AUC Automatic

recirculated-air control 117 recirculated-air mode 117 "Air recirculation on / off" 59 Air vents 114 refer to Ventilation 118 Air vents of automatic climate

control 114 Air volume 116, 120 AKI, refer to Fuel

specifications 245 Alarm system 38 avoiding unintentional

alarms 39 interior motion sensor 39 switching off alarm 38 switching off tilt alarm

sensor and interior motion sensor 39

tilt alarm sensor 39 "All channels" in Satellite

radio 185 "All doors" 30 Alloy wheels 267

All-season tires, refer to Winter tires 257

"All stations" displaying in radio mode, 178

All-wheel drive, refer to xDrive 97

Alterations, technical, refer to For your own safety 5

"AM", reception range 175, 178

"Angle of view" DVD changer 197 DVD system in rear 209 Antenna for mobile phone 220 Antifreeze coolant 262 washer fluid 75 Antilock Brake System

ABS 96 Anti-theft system refer to Alarm system 38 refer to Central locking

system 29 Approved axle weights, refer

to Weights 289 Approved engine oils 262 Approved gross vehicle

weight, refer to Weights 289 Armrest, refer to Center

armrest, front 127 Around the center console 14 Around the steering wheel 10 Arrival time refer to Computer 80 refer to Starting destination

guidance 162 "Arrow display" in

navigation 163 "Arrow display pop-up

instructions" 149 Arrow view for navigation

system 163

R e

fe re

n ce

297

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Ashtray front 128 rear 129 Assist 235 refer to separate operating

instructions Assistance systems, refer to

Driving stability control systems 96

Assistance window 20 "Assist profile" 241 "Assist. window off" 21 AUC Automatic recirculated-

air control 117 "Audio" 177, 181 for DVD system in rear 216 Audio 174 controls 174 switching on/off 174 tone control 175 volume 175 Audio CD for DVD system in

rear 210 Audio device, external 127 Automatic air distribution 115, 120 air volume 115, 120 BMW Teleservice call 237 headlamp control 110 liftgate operation 34, 37 steering wheel adjustment,

refer to Easy entry/exit 58 storing stations 179 Automatic car washes 140 Automatic climate control automatic air

distribution 115, 120 in rear 119 in rear, activating on Control

Display 120 switching off 118, 120 ventilation in rear 119 with 2-zone control 115 with 4-zone control 119 Automatic closing of doors,

refer to Automatic soft closing 33

Automatic curb monitor 58 Automatic garage door

opener 123 Automatic Hold 67 activating 68 deactivating 68 parking 68 Automatic lighting refer to Automatic headlamp

control 110 refer to Daytime driving

lamps 111 refer to Interior lamps 113 refer to Pathway lighting 111 "Automatic programs" 116 Automatic recirculated-air

control AUC 117 Automatic soft closing 33 Automatic station search 179 Automatic transmission with

Steptronic 70 deactivating selector lever

interlock 71 kick-down 71 manually releasing

transmission lock 72 tow-starting 282 with comfort access 40 "Automatic ventilation" 121 AUTO program for automatic

climate control 115, 120 "Auto Request" 237 "Autostore" on the radio 180 "AUX" 175, 200, 202 AUX-In connection 200 for DVD system in rear 215 USB audio interface 201 "AUX / Rear" 206 AUX-In connection 127, 200 Average fuel consumption 80 setting units 89 Average speed, refer to

Computer 80 "Avoid ferries" in

navigation 161 "Avoid highways" in

navigation 160

Avoiding highways for navigation 160

Avoiding unintentional alarms 39

"Avoid tollroads" in navigation 161

Axle weights, refer to Weights 289

"A - Z" 228

B Backrest contour, refer to

Lumbar support 50 Backrests, refer to Seats 49 Backrest width adjustment 50 Backup lamps, replacing

bulbs 270, 273 Balance, refer to Tone

control 176 "Balance" for DVD system in

rear 209 Band-aids, refer to First-aid

kit 279 Bass, refer to Tone

control 175 Battery charging 277 jump starting 280 power failure 278 refer to Vehicle battery 277 Battery disposal remote control with comfort

access 41 vehicle battery 277 Battery replacement remote control for DVD

system in rear 206 remote control with comfort

access 41 Being towed 282 Belts, refer to Safety belts 54 Beverage holder, refer to Cup

holders 127 Blower, refer to Air

volume 116, 120 BMW Advanced Diesel 245

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

298

"BMW Assist" 236, 237, 238, 239

BMW Assist activating 240 concierge service 239 contacting BMW Customer

Relations 238 offered services 235 roadside assistance 236 TeleServices 237 "BMW Contact" 230 "BMW Contact

Numbers" 230 BMW homepage 4 BMW maintenance

system 263 "BMW Service settings" 241 BMW Teleservice call automatic 237 manual 237 BMW TeleServices 237 BMW TeleServices services displaying 238 updating 238 BMW website 4 Bottle holder, refer to Cup

holders 127 Brake assistant 96 Brake force display 105 Brake lamps brake force display 105 replacing bulbs 270, 273 Brake rotors 140 Brakes ABS Antilock Brake

System 96 brake assistant 96 brake force display 105 breaking-in 138 CBC Cornering Brake

Control 96 electronic brake-force

distribution 96 parking brake 67 refer to Braking safely 140 warning lamp 13

Brake system 138 brake pads 138 breaking-in 138 disk brakes 140 Braking safely 140 Breakdown, Flat Tire

Monitor 100 Breakdown services, refer to

Roadside Assistance 280 Breaking-in brake pads 138 Breaking-in differential 138 Break-in period 138 "Brightness" 89 DVD changer 196 DVD system in rear 208 Brightness of Control Display 89 of the rear view camera 95 on Head-Up Display 108 "Brightness / Position" 108 Button for starting engine 65 Buttons on steering wheel 11 Bypassing traffic

congestion 169

C Calibrating driver's seat 55 California Proposition 65

Warning 6 "Call" 228, 239 Call accepting 226 displaying accepted 229 ending 227 in absence 229 starting 227 Calling from phone book 228 from Top 8 list 229 redialing 229 refer to telephone operating

instructions Camera, refer to Rear view

camera 93 "Camera picture and PDC" 95

"Camera view full screen" 95 main window" 95 Can holder, refer to Cup

holders 127 Capacities 290 Capacity of cargo bay 289 Car battery, refer to Vehicle

battery 277 "Car Data" 81 Care 265 car-care products 265 carpets 267 car washes 265 CD/DVD-player 268 chrome components 266 displays 268 exterior 265 fine wooden

components 267 hand washing 266 headlamps 266 high-pressure cleaning

jets 266 interior 267 leather 267 light-alloy wheels 267 paint 266 plastic components 267 rubber gaskets 266 running boards 267 safety belts 268 sensors and

cameras 267, 268 upholstery materials and

cloth-covered paneling 267 windows 266 wiper blades 266 Cargo refer to Loading 141 securing 143 securing with ski bag 134 Cargo area, refer to Cargo

bay 130 Cargo area cover, refer to Roll-

up cover 130

R e

fe re

n ce

299

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Cargo bay capacity 289 emergency operation, refer

to Opening manually 33, 36 expanding 132 opening/closing, refer to

Liftgate 33, 35 opening/closing, refer to

Tailgate 35 opening from inside 33, 36 opening from outside 33, 36 opening with remote

control 30 Cargo bay cover, refer to Roll-

up cover 130 Caring for the vehicle

finish 266 Car key, refer to Keys/remote

control 28 Car phone 220 installation location, refer to

Center armrest, front 127 refer to Mobile phone 220 refer to separate operating

instructions Car radio, refer to Radio 178 Car wash 140, 265 before driving in 66 with comfort access 41 Catalytic converter, refer to

Hot exhaust system 139 "Categories" in Satellite

radio 185 CBC Cornering Brake

Control 96 CBS Condition Based

Service 263 "CD" 175, 187 for DVD system in rear 206 CD, refer to Playing audio

tracks, DVD system in rear 210

CD/DVD player, DVD system in rear 205

CD changer 187 compressed audio files 187 controls 174 fast forward/reverse 190 random sequence 190 repeating a track 189 sampling tracks 189 selecting a CD 187 selecting a track 188 switching on/off 174 tone control 175 volume 175 CD player 187 compressed audio files 187 controls 174 fast forward/reverse 190 random sequence 190 repeating a track 189 sampling tracks 189 selecting a track 188 switching on/off 174 tone control 175 volume 175 Cell phone refer to Mobile phone Center armrest front 127 rear 130 Center brake lamp 272, 275 Center console 14 Central locking system 29 comfort access 39 from inside vehicle 32 Changes, technical refer to For your own

safety 5 refer to Parts and

accessories 6 Changing gears using shift

paddles 71 Changing language on

Control Display 90 Changing tires 256 Changing units of measure on

Control Display 89 Changing wheels 275 Check Control 85 "Check Control

messages" 86

Checking the air pressure, refer to Tire inflation pressure 249

Children, transporting 61 Child restraint devices 61 Child restraint fixing system

LATCH 62 Child restraint systems 61 Child-safety locks 64 Child seats 61 Chime, refer to Check

Control 85 Cigarette lighter, refer to

Lighter 129 Cleaning your BMW, refer to

Care 265 "Climate" 56 Clock 78 12h/24h mode 89 setting time 88 Closing from inside 32 using remote control 29 Closing fuel filler cap 244 Clothes hooks 127 Cockpit 10 Cold start, refer to Starting

engine 66 "Color" in DVD system in

rear 208 Comfort access 39 observe in car wash 41 replacing battery 41 Comfort area, refer to Around

the center console 14 Comfort start, refer to Starting

engine 66 "Communication"

226, 236, 237, 238, 239 Compact Disc refer to CD changer 187 refer to CD player 187 Compact wheel inflation pressure 251 wheel change 275 Compartment for remote

control, refer to Ignition lock 65

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

300

Compartments, refer to Storage compartments 127

Compass, digital 124 Computer 80 displays in instrument

panel 80 displays on Control

Display 80 trip computer 81 "Concierge" 239 Concierge service 239 Condition Based Service

CBS 263 "Confirmation" 31 Connecting car vacuum

cleaner, refer to Connecting electrical devices 129

Connecting headphones 205 Consumption, refer to

Average fuel consumption 80

Consumption indicator, energy control 79

Consumption statistics, refer to Average fuel consumption 80

"Contrast" DVD changer 196 DVD system in rear 208 Control Center, refer to

iDrive 16 Control Display, refer to

iDrive 16 setting brightness 89 Controller, refer to iDrive 16 Controls DVD changer 193 DVD system in rear 204 refer to Cockpit 10 Convenience operation glass sunroof 30, 32 glass sunroof with comfort

access 40 windows 30, 32 windows with comfort

access 40 with comfort access 40

Coolant 262 checking level 262 temperature 79 Cooling, maximum 117 Cornering Brake Control

CBC 96 Courtesy lamps, refer to

Interior lamps 113 Cradle for telephone or mobile

phone 127 Cruise control 75 Cruising range 80 Cup holders 127 Curb weight, refer to

Weights 289 "Current position" 169 Current position displaying 169 entering 158 storing 158 "Customer

Relations" 230, 238 Cylinders, refer to Engine

data 286

D Data 286 capacities 290 dimensions 287 engine 286 technical data 286 weights 289 "Date" 89 Date 78 display format 89 retrieving 78 setting 89 "Date format" 89 Daytime driving lamps 111 "Deactivated" 51 Defrosting windows 116 Defrosting windows and

removing condensation 116 Defrost position, refer to

Defrosting windows 116 "Delete all numbers" on the

mobile phone 229

"Delete data" for navigation 159

"Delete" for mobile phone 229

Destination address deleting 159 entering 151, 153 Destination for navigation destination list 157 entering 150 selecting from address

book 159 selecting using

information 156 selecting using voice 153 storing 158 Destination guidance 162 canceling voice

instructions 60 changing specified

route 160 displaying route 163 distance and arrival 162 ending/continuing 162 starting 162 voice instructions 165 volume of voice

instructions 166 Destination list for navigation

system 157 Destinations recently driven

to 157 "Details" DVD system in the rear 212 in audio mode 202 "Dial" for mobile phone 227 "Dial number" 227 "Diamond button" 59 Diesel exhaust fluid at low temperatures 246 at minimum 246 refilling yourself 247 Diesel particulate filter 139 Digital clock 78 Digital compass 124 Digital radio, refer to High

Definition Radio 181

R e

fe re

n ce

301

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Digital Versatile Disc, refer to DVD changer 193 Player for navigation

DVD 174 Dimensions 287 Directional indicators, refer to

Turn signals 73 Direction announcements,

refer to Voice instructions 165

Direction instructions, refer to Voice instructions 165

Directory for navigation, refer to Address book 158

Displacement, refer to Engine data 286

Display, refer to iDrive 16 Displaying images 212 Display lighting, refer to

Instrument lighting 113 "Display off" 21 Displays, refer to Instrument

panel 12 "Display settings" 89, 107 Displays on the windshield,

refer to Head-Up Display 107

Disposal battery of remote control

with comfort access 41 remote control battery 206 vehicle battery 277 Distance, refer to

Computer 80 "Distance to dest." 81 Distance to destination, refer

to Computer 80 Distance warning, refer to

PDC Park Distance Control 91

Door entry lighting 113 Door key, refer to Keys/

remote control 28 Door lock 32 Door locking, confirmation

signals 31

"Door locks" 30, 31, 83 Doors manual operation 32 remote control 29 DOT Quality Grades 254 Downhill driving assistance,

refer to HDC 98 Draft-free ventilation 118 Drinks holder, refer to Cup

holders 127 Drive for navigation DVDs 174 "Driver's door only" 30 Driver's seat, calibrating 55 "Driver's seat climate" 56 Driving lamps, refer to Parking

lamps/low beams 110 Driving on poor roads 144 Driving route, refer to

Displaying route 163 Driving stability control

systems 96 Driving through water 140 Driving tips, refer to General

driving notes 138 Dry air, refer to Cooling

function 117 Drying the air, refer to Cooling

function 117 DSC Dynamic Stability

Control 96 indicator lamp 13, 97 DTC Dynamic Traction

Control 97 activating 97 indicator lamp 97 "DVD" for DVD system in rear 206 in DVD changer 194 DVD DVD changer 193 DVD system in rear 204 player for navigation

DVD 174

DVD changer 193 adjusting brightness 196 adjusting contrast 196 audio and video

playback 194 audio playback 197 chapter selection 198 controls 193 DVD audio content 198 DVD control 194 DVD country codes 194 DVD-specific menu 197 fast forward 195 filling 193 installation position 193 malfunctions 194 removing DVDs 193 reverse 195 selecting audio

language 198 selecting language 196 selecting subtitles 196 selecting title 197 selecting viewing angle 197 skip chapter 195 tone control 195, 198 zoom 196 "DVD format" for DVD system in rear 209 in DVD changer 196 DVD for navigation 148 DVD system in rear 204 CD/DVD player 205 connecting headphones 205 controls 204 displaying images from CD/

DVD 212 DVD country codes 206 external device 215 information on CD/DVD

player 214 playing audio tracks from

CD/DVD 210 playing video from CD/

DVD 206 remote control 205 switching on/off 206

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

302

Dynamic Performance Control 97

"Dynamic route" in navigation 161

Dynamic Stability Control DSC 96

Dynamic Traction Control DTC 97

E Easy entry/exit 58 Eject button, refer to Buttons

on the CD player 174 Electrical malfunction automatic transmission with

Steptronic 72 door lock 32 driver's door 32 fuel filler door 244 glass sunroof, electric 46 liftgate 33 panorama glass sunroof 44 parking brake 69 Electric seat 49 Electronic brake-force

distribution 96 Electronic oil level check 260 Emergency operation, refer to

Manual operation door lock 32 driver's door 32 fuel filler door 244 liftgate 33 transmission lock, automatic

transmission 72 Emergency request 279 Emergency services, refer to

Roadside Assistance 280 "Enabled services" 241 "Enabled TeleServices" 238 "End call" 228

Engine breaking-in 138 data 286 oil temperature 79 overheated, refer to Coolant

temperature 79 speed 286 starting 66 starting, with comfort

access 40 switching off 66 Engine compartment 259 Engine coolant 262 Engine oil adding 261 additives, refer to Approved

engine oils 262 approved engine oil 262 checking oil level 260 electronic oil level check 260 temperature 79 Engine oil temperature 79 Engine output, refer to Engine

data 286 Engine overheating, refer to

Coolant temperature 79 Engine speed 286 Engine starting, refer to

Starting engine 66 Entering country of

destination 151 Entering destination 151 Entering house number or

intersection 152 Entering intersection 152 Entering street 152 "Entertainment" 174 Entertainment sound output

on/off 175 "Equalizer", refer to Tone

control 177 Equalizer, refer to Tone

control 177 "ESN" 184 ESP Electronic Stability

Program, refer to DSC Dynamic Stability Control 96

Event Data Recorders 264 Exhaust system, refer to Hot

exhaust system 139 Exterior mirrors 57 adjusting 57 automatic dimming

feature 58 automatic heating 58 folding in and out 57 tilting down passenger-side

exterior mirror 58 External audio device 127 refer to AUX-In

connection 200 Eye for tow-starting and

towing, refer to Tow fitting 281

F Fader, refer to Tone

control 176 Failure messages, refer to

Check Control 85 False alarm, refer to Avoiding

unintentional alarms 39 Fastening safety belts, refer to

Safety belts 54 warning lamp 55 Fastest route for

navigation 160 Fast forward CD changer 190 CD player 190 DVD changer 195 "Fast route" in navigation 160 Fault displays, refer to Check

Control 85 Filler neck for washer fluid 75 First aid, refer to First-aid

kit 279 First-aid kit 279 Fixing system, adaptive 133 Flashing during locking/

unlocking, refer to Setting confirmation signals 31

R e

fe re

n ce

303

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Flat tire changing wheels 275 compact wheel 275 Flat Tire Monitor 100 run-flat tires 101, 103, 256 TPM Tire Pressure

Monitor 101 Flat Tire Monitor FTM 100 Fluid reservoir, refer to Filler

neck for washer fluid 75 "FM", reception

range 175, 178 FM, waveband 178 Fog lamps 112 indicator lamp 13, 112 Folding display screen open/

closed, DVD system in rear 204

Folding rear seat backrest 132 Footbrake, refer to Braking

safely 140 Footwell lamps 113 For your own safety 5 4-wheel drive system, refer to

xDrive 97 Front airbags 105 Front passenger airbags 105 deactivating 106 refer to Exception of front

passenger seat 61 Front seat adjustment 49 FTM Flat Tire Monitor 100 false alarms 100 indicating a flat tire 101 initializing the system 100 snow chains 257 system limits 100 warning lamp 101 Fuel 245 capacity 290 display 80 high-quality brands 245 quality 245 saving 138 specifications 245 Fuel clock, refer to Fuel

gauge 80

Fuel consumption display computer, average fuel

consumption 80 Fuel display, refer to Fuel

gauge 80 Fuel filler door 244 closing 244 opening 244 releasing manually 244 Fuses 278

G Garage door opener, refer to

Integrated universal remote control 123

Gasoline, refer to Required fuel 245

Gasoline display, refer to Fuel gauge 80

Gearshifts, automatic transmission with Steptronic 71

General driving notes 138, 139

Glass sunroof convenience operation from

outside 32 convenience operation with

comfort access 40 remote control 30 Glass sunroof, electric 45 moving manually 46 opening, closing 45 power interruption 46 raising 45 Glove compartment 126 lighting 126 GPS navigation, refer to

Navigation system 148 Grills, refer to Ventilation 118 Grills of the automatic climate

control 114 Gross vehicle weight, refer to

Weights 289

H Handbrake, refer to Parking

brake 67 Hands-free system, refer to

Microphone 14 Hand washing 266 Have diesel exhaust fluid

refilled 246 Hazard warning flashers 15 HDC Hill Descent Control 98 "HD radio" 181 HD radio, refer to High

Definition Radio 181 Head airbags 105 Headlamp control,

automatic 110 Headlamp flasher 73 Headlamps 110 cleaning, refer to Washer/

wiper system 74 replacing bulbs 269 Head Light, refer to Adaptive

Head Light 112 Head restraints 52 sitting safely 48 "Head-Up Display" 108 Head-Up Display 107 Heated mirrors 58 rear window 116 seats 55, 56 steering wheel 59 Heating 114 exterior mirrors 58 interior 114 rear window 116 residual heat 118 seats 55, 56 steering wheel 59 Heating with engine switched

off, refer to Residual heat 118

Heavy cargo, refer to Securing cargo 143

Height, refer to Dimensions 287

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

304

Height adjustment seats 49 steering wheel 58 High beams 73, 112 headlamp flasher 73 indicator lamp 13 High Definition Radio 181 High-pressure cleaning

jets 266 Highs, refer to Treble and

bass 175 High water, refer to Driving

through water 140 Highway, refer to Route

criteria 160 Hill Descent Control HDC 98 Hills 140 Holder for cups 127 Home address 160 "Home address" in

navigation 160 Homepage 4 Hood 258 Horn 10 Hot exhaust system 139 "Hour memo" 88 "House number" for

destination entry 153 Hydraulic brake assistant,

refer to Brake assistant 96 Hydroplaning 139

I IBOC, refer to High Definition

Radio 181 Ice, refer to Outside

temperature warning 78 Ice warning, refer to Outside

temperature warning 78 ID3 tag, refer to Information on

track 188 Identification, tire 257 Identification mark, run-flat

tires 256

iDrive 16 assistance window 20 changing language 90 changing menu page 19 changing settings 88 changing units of measure

and display type 89 confirming selection or

entry 19 controller 16 controls 16 displays, menus 17 selecting menu item 19 setting brightness 89 setting date 89 setting time 88 start menu 17 status information 20 symbols 18 Ignition 65 switched off 65 switched on 65 Ignition key, refer to Keys/

remote control 28 Ignition key position 1, refer to

Radio readiness 65 Ignition key position 2, refer to

Ignition on 65 Ignition lock 65 starting engine with comfort

access 40 Indicator/warning lamps 13 active steering 104 airbags 107 DSC 13, 97 DTC 97 fasten safety belt 55 Flat Tire Monitor 101 fog lamps 13 TPM Tire Pressure

Monitor 103 Individual air distribution 117 Individually programmable

buttons on steering wheel 59

Individual settings, refer to Personal Profile 28

Inflation pressure, refer to Tire inflation pressure 249

Inflation pressure monitoring refer to FTM Flat Tire

Monitor 100 refer to TPM Tire Pressure

Monitor 101 Information on another location 156 on country 156 on current position 156 on destination location 156 "Information on

destination" 157 "Info sources" 83 Initializing Flat Tire Monitor 100 refer to Power failure 278 refer to Setting date 89 refer to Setting time 88 seat, mirror and steering

wheel memory 50 Installation location drive for navigation DVD 148 DVD changer 193 mobile phone 127 Instructions for navigation

system, refer to Voice instructions 165

Instrument cluster refer to Cockpit 10 refer to Instrument panel 12 Instrument illumination, refer

to Instrument lighting 113 Instrument lighting 113 Instrument panel 12 refer to Cockpit 10 Integrated key 28 Integrated universal remote

control 123 Interesting destination for

navigation 156 "Interim time" 87 Interior lamps 113 switching on with remote

control 30 Interior motion sensor 39 switching off 39

R e

fe re

n ce

305

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Interior rearview mirror 58 automatic dimming

feature 58 compass 124 Intermittent mode of the

wipers 74

J Jacking points 276 Joystick refer to iDrive 16 refer to Selector lever,

selecting transmission positions 70

Jump starting 280

K Keyless-Go, refer to Comfort

access 39 Keyless opening and closing,

refer to Comfort access 39 Key Memory, refer to Personal

Profile 28 "Keypad" 230 Keys 28 key-related settings, refer to

Personal Profile 28 Kick-down, automatic

transmission with Steptronic 71

Knock control 245

L Lamps, refer to Parking lamps/

low beams 110 Lamps and bulbs 269 "Language / Units" 89, 90 for navigation 149 "Language" for DVD system

in rear 208, 209 "Languages" 90 for navigation 149, 165 Lashing eyes, refer to

Securing cargo 143 Last destinations, refer to

Destination list 157

"Last seat pos." 51 LATCH child restraint fixing

system 62 Leather care 267 LEDs light-emitting

diodes 270 Length, refer to

Dimensions 287 License plate lamp, replacing

bulbs 272, 275 Liftgate 33, 35 adjusting opening

height 34, 36, 37 automatic operation 34, 37 closing 34, 37 locking and unlocking from

inside 32 opening from inside 33, 36 opening from outside 33, 36 opening manually 33, 36 Light-emitting diodes

LEDs 270 Lighter 129 Lighter socket 129 "Lighting" 73, 111 Lighting instruments 113 lamps and bulbs 269 of the vehicle, refer to

Lamps 110 Light switch 110 "Limit" 87 Load 141 Loading 141 securing cargo 143 stowing cargo 142 vehicle 141 Load securing equipment,

refer to Securing cargo 143 "Lock after driving" 33 Lock buttons in the doors,

refer to Locking 33 Locking from inside 32 setting confirmation

signals 31 using remote control 29 without key, refer to Comfort

access 39

Locking and unlocking doors from inside 32 setting confirmation

signals 31 Locking without key, refer to

Comfort access 39 Low beams 110 automatic 110 Lower back support, refer to

Lumbar support 50 Lows, refer to Treble and

bass 175 Lug bolts 276 tightening torque, refer to

After mounting 277 wrench 276 Luggage compartment

capacity, refer to Cargo bay capacity 289

Luggage rack, refer to Roof- mounted luggage rack 143

Lumbar support 50

M M+S tires, refer to Winter

tires 257 "Main menu" for DVD system

in rear 209 Maintenance refer to Service and

Warranty Information Booklet for US models 263

refer to Service requirements 82

refer to Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models 263

Maintenance system 263 Malfunction door lock 32 driver's door 32 fuel filler door 244 glass sunroof, electric 46 liftgate 33 panorama glass sunroof 44 parking brake 69

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

306

Malfunction warnings, refer to Check Control 85

Manual air distribution 116 Manual BMW Teleservice

call 237 "Manual" in radio mode 179 Manually releasing

transmission lock 72 Manual mode, automatic

transmission with Steptronic 71

Manual operation door lock 32 driver's door 32 fuel filler door 244 transmission lock, automatic

transmission 72 Map changing scale 164 destination entry 155 "Map direction of travel" 164 "Map facing north" 164 Map facing north 164 Master key, refer to Keys/

remote control 28 Maximum cooling 117 Maximum speed for winter tires 257 with compact wheel 277 Memory, refer to Seat, mirror

and steering wheel memory 50

"Menu" for DVD system in

rear 207, 209 in DVD changer 195, 197 Menus, refer to iDrive 16 Message list for traffic

information 167 Microfilter 119 Microphone for mobile phone 14 for telephone 14 for voice activation

system 14 Mirror dimming feature 58

Mirrors 57 automatic curb monitor 58 exterior mirrors 57 folding in and out 57 heating 58 interior rearview mirror 58 memory, refer to Seat, mirror

and steering wheel memory 50

"Missed calls" 228 Missed calls 229 Mobile phone accepted calls 229 adjusting volume 226 calling 227 ending call 227 installation location, refer to

Center armrest, front 127 missed calls 229 operation via iDrive 226 redialing 229 refer to separate operating

instructions Top 8 229 touch tone dialing 230 Monitor, refer to iDrive 16 Monitoring tire pressure, refer

to FTM Flat Tire Monitor 100

"Monitor on / off" 59 MP3, refer to Compressed

audio files 187 Multifunction steering wheel,

refer to Buttons on steering wheel 11

Multifunction switch refer to Turn signals/

headlamp flasher/high beams 73

refer to Washer/wiper system 74

Music track, refer to Tracks 188

"Mute on / off" 59

N "Navigation" 80, 156 Navigation destination entering manually 151, 153 home address 160 selecting via map 155 Navigation drive, installation

location 148 Navigation DVD 148 player 174 Navigation instructions, refer

to Switching voice instructions on/off 165

Navigation system 148 address book 158 changing route 166 destination entry 150 destination guidance in

assistance window 148 destination list 157 displaying current

position 169 displaying route 163 ending/continuing

destination guidance 162 entering a destination

manually 151, 153 last destinations 157 navigation DVD 148 opening 150 route list 164 searching for a special

destination 156 selecting destination using

information 156 selecting destination via

map 155 selecting route criteria 160 starting destination

guidance 162 switching off, refer to

Ending/continuing destination guidance 162

voice instructions 165 volume adjustment 166 "Navigation voice

instructions" 59

R e

fe re

n ce

307

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Neck support, refer to Head restraints 52

"New address" for navigation 158

"New destination" 151, 155 New remote control 28 "New route" 166 New wheels and tires 256 "Next entertainment

source" 59 Nozzles, refer to Windshield

washer nozzles 75 "NTSC color" for DVD system

in rear 216 Nylon rope, refer to Tow-

starting and towing 281

O OBD socket 264 Octane ratings, refer to Fuel

specifications 245 Odometer 78 Oil additives, refer to Approved

engine oils 262 approved engine oils 262 consumption, refer to

Checking engine oil level 260

level 260 refilling, refer to Adding

engine oil 261 Oil change interval, refer to

Service requirements 82 "On a new destination" for

navigation 156 Onboard computer, refer to

iDrive 16 Onboard toolkit 269 "On destination" 156 "On location" 156 Opening and closing comfort access 39 from inside 32 panorama glass sunroof 43 using remote control 29 using the door lock 32

Operation by voice for mobile phone 231

adjusting volume 232 canceling 231 correcting phone

number 232 dialing phone number 232 placing a call 232 redialing 233 voice commands 231 voice phone book 232 Operation on poor roads 144 "Options" 239, 240 Orientation menu, refer to

Start menu 17 Output, refer to Engine

data 286 Outside air, refer to AUC

Automatic recirculated-air control 117

Outside temperature display 78

changing unit of measure 89 Outside temperature

warning 78 "Overview" for DVD system in

rear 213

P Panic mode 30 Panorama glass sunroof 42 moving manually 44 power failure 44 raising, opening, closing 43 Park Distance Control PDC 91 "Parked car operation" 121 "Parked car ventilation" 121 Parked-car ventilation 121 activating activation

time 122 preselecting activation

times 122 switching on and off

directly 121 Parking, vehicle 66

Parking aid refer to PDC Park Distance

Control 91 refer to Rear view camera 93 Parking assistant, refer to

PDC Park Distance Control 91

Parking brake 67 Automatic Hold 67 indicator lamp 13 releasing manually 67 releasing manually in case of

an electrical malfunction 69 setting manually 67 Parking lamps 110 Parking with Automatic

Hold 68 Parts and accessories 6 "Passenger's seat climate" 56 Passenger-side exterior

mirror, tilting down 58 Pathway lighting 111 "Pause" for DVD system in

rear 210 Paying attention to speed 257 "PDC" 92 PDC Park Distance Control 91 Personal Profile 28 "Perspective" 164 Phone book 226 creating and editing voice

phone book 232 Phone numbers deleting from phone

book 229 dialing 227 most recent numbers 229 selecting in phone book 229 Top 8 229 "Photo" for DVD-System in

rear 206, 212 Pinch protection system glass sunroof, electric 45 panorama glass sunroof 43 power windows 42 Plasters, refer to First-aid

kit 279

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

308

"Play" for DVD system in rear 210 in Satellite radio mode 185 Playing videos, DVD system in

rear 206 Plug-in unit for remote

control, refer to Ignition lock 65

Position displaying 169 storing, refer to Storing

current position 158 Power failure 278 Power windows, refer to

Windows 41 Preselecting activation times

of parked-car ventilation 122

"Presets" displaying in radio mode 178 in Satellite radio 185 Pressure, tires 249 Pressure monitoring of tires,

refer to TPM Tire Pressure Monitor 101

Programmable buttons on steering wheel 59

Programmable memory buttons 21

Protective function, refer to Pinch protection system

glass sunroof, electric 45 panorama glass sunroof 43 windows 42

R Radio autostore 179 controls 174 High Definition Radio 181 listen to station 178 sampling stations 179 satellite radio 184 selecting frequency

manually 179 selecting

waveband 174, 178 station search 179 station with the best

reception 179 storing stations 180 switching on/off 174 tone control 175 volume 175 Weather Band 183 Radio key, refer to Keys/

remote control 28 Radio position, refer to Radio

readiness 65 Radio readiness 65 switched off 65 switched on 65 with comfort access 40 Rain sensor 74 "Random" for DVD system in rear 211 refer to Random

sequence 190 "Random all" for DVD system in rear 212 in audio mode 190 "Random directory" for DVD system in rear 212 in audio mode 190 Random sequence 190 "RDS" Radio Data

System 181 Reading lamps 113 Rear automatic climate

control air flow 120 switching off 120 "Rear climate control" 120

"Rear enabled" 204 Rear entertainment, refer to

DVD system in rear 204 Rear lamps, refer to Tail

lamps 270, 273 replacing bulbs 270, 273 Rear seat backrest,

folding 132 Rear seats adjusting 53 adjusting head restraints 53 folding over backrest 132 head restraint adjustment 53 heating 56, 57 Rear socket 130 Rear ventilation 119 automatic climate control in

rear 119 3rd row seats 119 Rear view camera 93 cleaning 96 displays on Control

Display 95 driver assistance

functions 93 switching off 93 switching on 93 Rearview mirror 57 Rear window heating 116 replacing wiper blade 269 windshield wiper 75, 141 Rear window safety switch 42 Rear window wiper, replacing

wiper blade 269 "Received calls" 228 Recent numbers in mobile

phone 229 Reception level of mobile

phone, refer to Status information 20

Recirculated-air mode 117 air recirculation 117 AUC Automatic

recirculated-air control 117 Reclining seat, refer to

Seats 49 Recording times, refer to

Stopwatch 87

R e

fe re

n ce

309

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

"Redial" for mobile phone 228 Reflectors, refer to Tail

lamps 270, 273 Refueling 244 Releasing hood 258 refer to Unlocking 40 "Relock door if not

opened" 32 Remaining distance, refer to

Cruising range 80 Remaining distance to

destination, refer to Computer 80

Remote control 28 comfort access 39 DVD system in rear 205 garage door opener 123 liftgate 30 malfunction 31, 41 replacing battery 41 Removing condensation on

the windows 116 "Repeat directory" for DVD system in

rear 210, 212 in audio mode 190 "Repeat" for DVD system in

rear 211 "Repeat track" for DVD system in

rear 210, 212 in audio mode 190 Replacement fuses 278 Replacement of tires 256 changing wheels 275 new wheels and tires 256 Replacing bulbs, refer to

Lamps and bulbs 269 Replacing wheels/tires, refer

to New wheels and tires 256 Replacing wiper blades 269 Reporting an accident, refer to

Initiating an emergency request 279

Reporting safety defects 7 Reserve warning, refer to Fuel

gauge 80

"Reset" 101, 103 DVD changer 196 DVD system in rear 209 the stopwatch 87 tone settings 177 Reset, refer to Resetting tone

settings 177 Residual heat 118 Restraint systems for children 61 refer to Safety belts 54 Retreaded tires 256 "Return" DVD changer 197 DVD system in rear 209 Reverse CD changer 190 CD player 190 DVD changer 195 Reverse gear, automatic

transmission with Steptronic 71

Road map 164 "Roadside Assistance" 236 Roadside Assistance 280 Roadside assistance 236 Roadside parking lamps 112 Roller sun blinds 126 Roll-up cover 130 Roof load capacity 289 Roof-mounted luggage

rack 143 Rope, refer to Tow-starting

and towing 281 Rotary pushbutton, refer to

iDrive 16 Route 160 changing 166 displaying 163 displaying arrow display 163 displaying map view 164 displaying roads and towns/

cities 164 displaying towns/cities 164 list 164 selecting 160 selecting criteria 160

RSC Runflat System Component, refer to Run- flat tires 256

Runflat System Component RSC, refer to Run-Flat Tires 256

Run-flat tires 256 continuing driving with a

damaged tire 101, 103 flat tire 101, 103 new wheels and tires 256 tire inflation

pressure 101, 103, 249 tire replacement 256

S Safety 5 Safety belts 54 damage 55 sitting safely 48 warning lamp 55 Safety belt tensioners refer to Airbags 105 refer to Safety belts 54 Safety systems ABS Antilock Brake

System 96 airbags 105 driving stability control

systems 96 DSC Dynamic Stability

Control 96 safety belts 54 Safety tires, refer to Run-flat

tires 256 "SAT" 175, 184 Satellite radio 184 displaying additional

information 185 enabling 184 selecting channel 185 storing channel 185 "Scan" for DVD system in rear 211 sampling stations in radio

mode 179

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

310

Scan CD changer 189 CD player 189 radio 179 "Scan all" for DVD system in rear 212 in audio mode 189 "Scan directory" for DVD system in rear 212 in audio mode 189 Screen, refer to iDrive 16 Screw thread for tow

fitting 281 SDARS, refer to Satellite

radio 184 "Seat heater distribution" 56 Seat heating 55, 56 Seats 49 adjusting 49 adjusting electrically 49 adjusting manually 49 backrest width 50 heating 55, 56 in rear 53 lumbar support 50 memory, refer to Seat, mirror

and steering wheel memory 50

2nd row seats 53 shoulder support 50 sitting safely 48 storing the setting 50 thigh support 49, 50 3rd row seats 54 ventilation, refer to Active

seat ventilation and Seat heating 56

2nd row seats 53 Securing load refer to Securing cargo 143 with ski bag, refer to

Securing cargo 134 "Select as

destination" 156, 239 "Select current speed" 87 Selecting audio source 174 Selecting country for

navigation 151

Selecting frequency manually 179

Selecting menu items 19 Selecting new scale for

navigation 164 Selector lever, automatic

transmission with Steptronic 70

Selector lever lock, refer to Reverse gear 71

Self-leveling suspension 100 Service, refer to Roadside

Assistance 280 Service and Warranty

Information Booklet for US models 263

"Service Info" 83, 237 Service interval indicator, refer

to Service requirements 82 "Service Request" 230, 237 "Service

requirements" 83, 237, 261 Service requirements 82 also refer to CBS Condition

Based Service 263 "SET" DVD changer 195 rear seat entertainment 207 "Set" on trip computer 82 "Settings" 241 when unlocking 30 Settings changing on Control

Display 88 clock, 12h/24h mode 89 configuring, refer to

Personal Profile 28 Setting speed limit 87 Setting time, refer to

Preselecting activation times 122

Shifting, automatic transmission with Steptronic 71

Shift paddles 71 Short commands of voice

activation system 291 Shortest route in navigation,

refer to Selecting route 160

"Short route" in navigation 160

Shoulder support 50 "Show current position" 155 "Show destination

position" 155 Shuffled, refer to Random CD changer 190 CD player 190 Side airbags 105 Side marker lamps, replacing

bulbs 270 Signal horn, refer to Horn 10 Sitting safely 48 with airbags 48 with head restraint 48 with safety belts 48 Ski bag 134 Slide show, refer to Displaying

images 212 Sliding/tilt sunroof refer to Glass sunroof,

electric 45 refer to Panorama glass

sunroof 42 Slope assistant, refer to

Starting assistant 99 Smokers' package, refer to

Ashtray 128 Snap-in adapter 233 Snow chains 257 Socket for Onboard

Diagnostics interface 264 Socket for remote control,

refer to Ignition lock 65 Sockets, refer to Connecting

electrical devices 129 Soft closure aid, refer to

Automatic soft closing 33 Song search, refer to

Sampling tracks 189 SOS, refer to Initiating an

emergency request 279 Spare fuses 278 Spare remote control 28 Spare wheel refer to Changing

wheels 275 refer to Compact wheel 275

R e

fe re

n ce

311

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Special oils, refer to Approved engine oils 262

Specified oil grades, refer to Approved engine oils 262

Speed with compact wheel 277 with winter tires 257 Speed-dependent

volume 176 Speed limit warning, refer to

Speed limit 87 Speedometer 12 "Speed volume", refer to Tone

control 176 Sport program, automatic

transmission with Steptronic 71

Stability control, refer to Driving stability control systems 96

"Standard" for DVD system in rear 209, 216

"Star button" 59 Star button 59 Start/Stop button 65 "Start" for stopwatch 87 Starting, refer to Starting

engine 66 Starting assistance, refer to

Jump starting 280 Starting assistant 99 Starting difficulties, jump

starting 280 Starting off on slopes, refer to

Starting assistant 99 Start menu, iDrive 17 "Start service" 236 with BMW Assist 239 "State / Province" for

destination entry 151 "State inspection" 84 Station, refer to Radio 178 Status of this Owner's Manual

at time of printing 5 Steam cleaners 266

Steering wheel adjusting 58 automatic adjustment, refer

to Steering wheel memory 50

buttons on steering wheel 11

easy entry/exit 58 heating 59 memory 50 programmable buttons 59 Steering with variable ratio,

refer to Active steering 104 Steptronic, refer to Sport

program and manual mode M/S 71

"Stop" the stopwatch 87 "Stopwatch" 87 Stopwatch 87 Storage compartments 127 "Store" in Satellite radio 186 with the radio 180 "Store in address book" for

navigation 158 Storing current position 158 Storing radio stations 180 Storing sitting position, refer

to Seat, mirror and steering wheel memory 50

Storing tires 257 Storing vehicle 268 Storing your vehicle 268 "Street" for destination

entry 152 "Subtitles" in DVD system in

rear 209 Summer tires, refer to Wheels

and tires 249 Switches, refer to Cockpit 10 Switching cooling function on

and off 117 Switching off engine 66 Switching on audio 174 CD changer 174 CD player 174 radio 174 Switching on hour signal 88

Swiveling headlamps, refer to Adaptive Head Light 112

Symbols 4 indicator/warning lamps 13 navigation system 168 traffic information with

navigation system 166

T Tachometer 79 "Tailgate" 34, 37 Tailgate 35 Tail lamps 270, 273 replacing bulbs 270, 273 Tank contents, refer to

Capacities 290 Target cursor for

navigation 155 Technical alterations, refer to

For your own safety 5 Technical data 286 Telematics, refer to

BMW TeleServices, BMW Assist 235

Telephone refer to Mobile phone 220 refer to separate operating

instructions "Telephone list" 59 Temperature adjusting in upper body

region 116 adjusting with automatic

climate control 116, 120 changing units of

measure 89 refer to Coolant

temperature 79 Temperature display outside temperature 78 setting units 89 temperature warning 78 Temperature warning 78 Tempomat, refer to Cruise

control 75 The individual vehicle 5 Third brake lamp, refer to

Center brake lamp 272, 275

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

312

3rd row seats 54 Tightening torque of the lug

bolts, refer to After mounting 277

Tilt alarm sensor, switching off 39

Tilting down passenger-side exterior mirror 58

"Time / Date" 88 "Time format" 89 Timer, refer to Preselecting

activation times 122 "Timer 2" for parked-car

ventilation 122 "Timer 1" for parked-car

ventilation 122 Tire inflation pressures 249 checking 249 monitoring, refer to Flat Tire

Monitor 100 Tire Pressure Monitor

TPM 101 Tire Quality Grading 254 Tires age 254 air loss 101, 103 breaking-in 138 changing 256 condition 255 damage 255 flat tire, refer to Changing

wheels 275 inflation pressure 249 inflation pressure

monitoring, refer to FTM Flat Tire Monitor 100

new wheels and tires 256 pressure loss 101, 103 pressure monitoring, refer to

TPM Tire Pressure Monitor 101

replacing 275 retreaded tires 256 run-flat tires 256 size 254 tread 255 wear indicators 255 wheel/tire combination 256 winter tires 257

"Title" for DVD system in rear 209

TMC station, refer to Traffic information 166

Tone in audio mode adjusting 175 middle setting 177 "Tone" in DVD system in

rear 209 Tone on locking/unlocking 31 Tools, refer to Onboard

toolkit 269 "Top 8" for mobile phone 228 Torque engine 286 lug bolts, refer to After

mounting 277 Touch tone dialing 230 Tow fitting 281 Towing 281 tow fitting 281 "Town / City" for destination

entry 151 Town/city for destination

entry 151 Tow-starting 281, 282 "TPM" 102 TPM Tire Pressure

Monitor 101 resetting system 102 system limits 102 warning lamp 103 Tracks finding 189 random sequence 190 sampling, scan 189 Traction-assist feature, refer

to DSC Dynamic Stability Control 96

Traction control, refer to DSC Dynamic Stability Control 96

Traffic congestion bypassing 169 displaying traffic

information 166

Traffic information for navigation

depiction in route map 167 displaying 167 during destination

guidance 169 switching on/off 166 symbols 168 Transmission automatic transmission with

Steptronic 70 manually releasing

transmission lock on automatic transmission with Steptronic 72

Transmission positions, refer to Automatic transmission with Steptronic 70

Transporting children safely 61

Transport securing device, refer to Securing cargo 143

Tread depth, refer to Minimum tread depth 255

Treble, refer to Tone control 175

"Treble / Bass" for DVD system in rear 209

"Trip computer" 81 Trip computer 81 Trip-distance counter, refer to

Trip odometer 78 Trip odometer 78 Turning circle, refer to

Dimensions 287 Turn signals 73 indicator lamp 12 replacing bulbs 270, 273

U Ultra-low sulfur diesel 245 Uniform Tire Quality Grading/

UTQR 254 "Units" 89 Units average fuel

consumption 89 temperature 89

R e

fe re

n ce

313

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Universal garage-door opener, refer to Integrated universal remote control 123

Universal remote control 123 "Unlock button" 30 Unlocking from inside 33 liftgate 30 setting behavior 30 using remote control 30 without key, refer to Comfort

access 39 Unlocking and locking doors

using remote control 30 Unlocking without key, refer to

Comfort access 39 "Unlock rear menu" in DVD

system in the rear 204 "Update services" 238, 240 USB audio interface 201 Used batteries refer to Disposal 277 refer to Replacing battery 41

V Valve screw caps, refer to

After mounting 277 Vehicle battery 277 breaking-in 138 loading 141 measurements, refer to

Dimensions 287 parking 66 storing 268 weights 289 "Vehicle / Tires" when

unlocking 30 Vehicle care, refer to Care 265 Vehicle jack 276 jacking points 276 Vehicle position, refer to

Displaying current position 169

Ventilation 118 draft-free 118 in the rear 119 rear automatic climate

control 121 3rd row seats 119 while stationary 121 Vent outlets of automatic

climate control 114 Vents, refer to Ventilation 118 "Vent settings" 117 "Video settings" for DVD

system in rear 208 Voice, refer to Voice

instructions for navigation system 165

Voice activation system 23 short commands 291 Voice instructions for

navigation system 165 muting 60, 165 repeating 60, 165 switching on/off 60, 165 volume 166 Voice phone book 232 Volume 174 audio sources 174 mobile phone 226 setting speed-

dependent 176 voice instructions 166 Volume distribution in audio

mode front/rear 176 right/left 176 Volume of warning tones 90

W Warning lamps, refer to

Indicator and warning lamps 13

Warning messages, refer to Check Control 85

Warning tone, volume 90 Warning triangle 279 Warranty and Service Guide

Booklet for Canadian models 263

Washer/wiper system 74 rain sensor 74 washer fluid 75 windshield washer

nozzles 75 Washer fluid 75 capacity of the reservoir 75 Water on roads, refer to

Driving through water 140 Water penetration 266 Waveband for radio 178 "WB" 183 Wear indicators in tires, refer

to Minimum tread depth 255 Weather Band 183 Website 4 Weights 289 Wheel/tire combination, refer

to New wheels and tires 256 Wheel/tire damage 255 Wheelbase, refer to

Dimensions 287 Wheels and tires 249 Width, refer to

Dimensions 287 Windows 41 convenience operation 30 convenience operation from

outside 32 convenience operation with

comfort access 40 opening, closing 41 pinch protection system 42 safety switch 42 Windshield cleaning, refer to Washer/

wiper system 74 defrosting, refer to

Defrosting windows 116 displays, refer to Head-Up

Display 107 Windshield washer system refer to Washer/wiper

system 74 windshield washer

nozzles 75 Windshield wipers, refer to

Washer/wiper system 74 replacing wiper blades 269

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

314

Winter diesel 245 Winter tires 257 storage 257 "With highways" in

navigation 160 Word matching principle for

navigation 161 Working in the engine

compartment 258 Wrenches/screwdrivers, refer

to Onboard toolkit 269

X xDrive 97 Xenon lamps 272 bulb changing 272 Xenon light 270 bulb changing 270

Z "Zoom" for DVD system in

rear 209

Manualsnet FAQs

If you want to find out how the X5 Series BMW works, you can view and download the BMW X5 48i xDrive X5 Series 2009 Owner's Manual on the Manualsnet website.

Yes, we have the Owner's Manual for BMW X5 Series as well as other BMW manuals. All you need to do is to use our search bar and find the user manual that you are looking for.

The Owner's Manual should include all the details that are needed to use a BMW X5 Series. Full manuals and user guide PDFs can be downloaded from Manualsnet.com.

The best way to navigate the BMW X5 48i xDrive X5 Series 2009 Owner's Manual is by checking the Table of Contents at the top of the page where available. This allows you to navigate a manual by jumping to the section you are looking for.

This BMW X5 48i xDrive X5 Series 2009 Owner's Manual consists of sections like Table of Contents, to name a few. For easier navigation, use the Table of Contents in the upper left corner.

You can download BMW X5 48i xDrive X5 Series 2009 Owner's Manual free of charge simply by clicking the “download” button in the upper right corner of any manuals page. This feature allows you to download any manual in a couple of seconds and is generally in PDF format. You can also save a manual for later by adding it to your saved documents in the user profile.

To be able to print BMW X5 48i xDrive X5 Series 2009 Owner's Manual, simply download the document to your computer. Once downloaded, open the PDF file and print the BMW X5 48i xDrive X5 Series 2009 Owner's Manual as you would any other document. This can usually be achieved by clicking on “File” and then “Print” from the menu bar.